parent
4bc7e909f9
commit
c1a1b6eeec
@ -0,0 +1 @@
|
||||
<AVRStudio><MANAGEMENT><ProjectName>BootloaderCDC</ProjectName><Created>30-Sep-2008 14:20:09</Created><LastEdit>30-Sep-2008 14:20:30</LastEdit><ICON>241</ICON><ProjectType>0</ProjectType><Created>30-Sep-2008 14:20:09</Created><Version>4</Version><Build>4, 14, 0, 589</Build><ProjectTypeName>AVR GCC</ProjectTypeName></MANAGEMENT><CODE_CREATION><ObjectFile>BootloaderCDC.elf</ObjectFile><EntryFile></EntryFile><SaveFolder>C:\Users\Dean\Documents\Electronics\Projects\WORK\MyUSBWORK\Bootloaders\CDC\</SaveFolder></CODE_CREATION><DEBUG_TARGET><CURRENT_TARGET></CURRENT_TARGET><CURRENT_PART></CURRENT_PART><BREAKPOINTS></BREAKPOINTS><IO_EXPAND><HIDE>false</HIDE></IO_EXPAND><REGISTERNAMES><Register>R00</Register><Register>R01</Register><Register>R02</Register><Register>R03</Register><Register>R04</Register><Register>R05</Register><Register>R06</Register><Register>R07</Register><Register>R08</Register><Register>R09</Register><Register>R10</Register><Register>R11</Register><Register>R12</Register><Register>R13</Register><Register>R14</Register><Register>R15</Register><Register>R16</Register><Register>R17</Register><Register>R18</Register><Register>R19</Register><Register>R20</Register><Register>R21</Register><Register>R22</Register><Register>R23</Register><Register>R24</Register><Register>R25</Register><Register>R26</Register><Register>R27</Register><Register>R28</Register><Register>R29</Register><Register>R30</Register><Register>R31</Register></REGISTERNAMES><COM>Auto</COM><COMType>0</COMType><WATCHNUM>0</WATCHNUM><WATCHNAMES><Pane0></Pane0><Pane1></Pane1><Pane2></Pane2><Pane3></Pane3></WATCHNAMES><BreakOnTrcaeFull>0</BreakOnTrcaeFull></DEBUG_TARGET><Debugger><Triggers></Triggers></Debugger><AVRGCCPLUGIN><FILES><SOURCEFILE>BootloaderCDC.c</SOURCEFILE><SOURCEFILE>Descriptors.c</SOURCEFILE><HEADERFILE>BootloaderCDC.h</HEADERFILE><HEADERFILE>Descriptors.h</HEADERFILE><OTHERFILE>makefile</OTHERFILE></FILES><CONFIGS><CONFIG><NAME>default</NAME><USESEXTERNALMAKEFILE>YES</USESEXTERNALMAKEFILE><EXTERNALMAKEFILE>makefile</EXTERNALMAKEFILE><PART>atmega128</PART><HEX>1</HEX><LIST>1</LIST><MAP>1</MAP><OUTPUTFILENAME>BootloaderCDC.elf</OUTPUTFILENAME><OUTPUTDIR>default\</OUTPUTDIR><ISDIRTY>1</ISDIRTY><OPTIONS/><INCDIRS/><LIBDIRS/><LIBS/><LINKOBJECTS/><OPTIONSFORALL>-Wall -gdwarf-2 -std=gnu99 -Os -funsigned-char -funsigned-bitfields -fpack-struct -fshort-enums</OPTIONSFORALL><LINKEROPTIONS></LINKEROPTIONS><SEGMENTS/></CONFIG></CONFIGS><LASTCONFIG>default</LASTCONFIG><USES_WINAVR>1</USES_WINAVR><GCC_LOC>C:\WinAVR-20080512\bin\avr-gcc.exe</GCC_LOC><MAKE_LOC>C:\WinAVR-20080512\utils\bin\make.exe</MAKE_LOC></AVRGCCPLUGIN><ProjectFiles><Files><Name>C:\Users\Dean\Documents\Electronics\Projects\WORK\MyUSBWORK\Bootloaders\CDC\BootloaderCDC.h</Name><Name>C:\Users\Dean\Documents\Electronics\Projects\WORK\MyUSBWORK\Bootloaders\CDC\Descriptors.h</Name><Name>C:\Users\Dean\Documents\Electronics\Projects\WORK\MyUSBWORK\Bootloaders\CDC\BootloaderCDC.c</Name><Name>C:\Users\Dean\Documents\Electronics\Projects\WORK\MyUSBWORK\Bootloaders\CDC\Descriptors.c</Name></Files></ProjectFiles><IOView><usergroups/><sort sorted="0" column="0" ordername="0" orderaddress="0" ordergroup="0"/></IOView><Files></Files><Events><Bookmarks></Bookmarks></Events><Trace><Filters></Filters></Trace></AVRStudio>
|
@ -0,0 +1,570 @@
|
||||
/*
|
||||
LUFA Library
|
||||
Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2009.
|
||||
|
||||
dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com
|
||||
www.fourwalledcubicle.com
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
/*
|
||||
Copyright 2009 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com)
|
||||
|
||||
Permission to use, copy, modify, and distribute this software
|
||||
and its documentation for any purpose and without fee is hereby
|
||||
granted, provided that the above copyright notice appear in all
|
||||
copies and that both that the copyright notice and this
|
||||
permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting
|
||||
documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in
|
||||
advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the
|
||||
software without specific, written prior permission.
|
||||
|
||||
The author disclaim all warranties with regard to this
|
||||
software, including all implied warranties of merchantability
|
||||
and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any
|
||||
special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages
|
||||
whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether
|
||||
in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action,
|
||||
arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of
|
||||
this software.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
/** \file
|
||||
*
|
||||
* Main source file for the CDC class bootloader. This file contains the complete bootloader logic.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
#define INCLUDE_FROM_BOOTLOADERCDC_C
|
||||
#include "BootloaderCDC.h"
|
||||
|
||||
/* Globals: */
|
||||
/** Line coding options for the virtual serial port. Although the virtual serial port data is never
|
||||
* sent through a physical serial port, the line encoding data must still be read and preserved from
|
||||
* the host, or the host will detect a problem and fail to open the port. This structure contains the
|
||||
* current encoding options, including baud rate, character format, parity mode and total number of
|
||||
* bits in each data chunk.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
CDC_Line_Coding_t LineCoding = { BaudRateBPS: 9600,
|
||||
CharFormat: OneStopBit,
|
||||
ParityType: Parity_None,
|
||||
DataBits: 8 };
|
||||
|
||||
/** Current address counter. This stores the current address of the FLASH or EEPROM as set by the host,
|
||||
* and is used when reading or writing to the AVRs memory (either FLASH or EEPROM depending on the issued
|
||||
* command.)
|
||||
*/
|
||||
uint16_t CurrAddress;
|
||||
|
||||
/** Flag to indicate if the bootloader should be running, or should exit and allow the application code to run
|
||||
* via a soft reset. When cleared, the bootloader will abort, the USB interface will shut down and the application
|
||||
* jumped to via an indirect jump to location 0x0000.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
bool RunBootloader = true;
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/** Main program entry point. This routine configures the hardware required by the bootloader, then continuously
|
||||
* runs the bootloader processing routine until instructed to soft-exit, or hard-reset via the watchdog to start
|
||||
* the loaded application code.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
int main(void)
|
||||
{
|
||||
/* Disable watchdog if enabled by bootloader/fuses */
|
||||
MCUSR &= ~(1 << WDRF);
|
||||
wdt_disable();
|
||||
|
||||
/* Disable Clock Division */
|
||||
SetSystemClockPrescaler(0);
|
||||
|
||||
/* Relocate the interrupt vector table to the bootloader section */
|
||||
MCUCR = (1 << IVCE);
|
||||
MCUCR = (1 << IVSEL);
|
||||
|
||||
/* Initialize USB Subsystem */
|
||||
USB_Init();
|
||||
|
||||
while (RunBootloader)
|
||||
{
|
||||
USB_USBTask();
|
||||
CDC_Task();
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
Endpoint_SelectEndpoint(CDC_TX_EPNUM);
|
||||
|
||||
/* Wait until any pending transmissions have completed before shutting down */
|
||||
while (!(Endpoint_ReadWriteAllowed()));
|
||||
|
||||
/* Shut down the USB subsystem */
|
||||
USB_ShutDown();
|
||||
|
||||
/* Relocate the interrupt vector table back to the application section */
|
||||
MCUCR = (1 << IVCE);
|
||||
MCUCR = 0;
|
||||
|
||||
/* Reset any used hardware ports back to their defaults */
|
||||
PORTD = 0;
|
||||
DDRD = 0;
|
||||
|
||||
#if defined(PORTE)
|
||||
PORTE = 0;
|
||||
DDRE = 0;
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
/* Re-enable RWW section */
|
||||
boot_rww_enable();
|
||||
|
||||
/* Start the user application */
|
||||
AppPtr_t AppStartPtr = (AppPtr_t)0x0000;
|
||||
AppStartPtr();
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
/** Event handler for the USB_Disconnect event. This indicates that the bootloader should exit and the user
|
||||
* application started.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
EVENT_HANDLER(USB_Disconnect)
|
||||
{
|
||||
/* Upon disconnection, run user application */
|
||||
RunBootloader = false;
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
/** Event handler for the USB_ConfigurationChanged event. This configures the device's endpoints ready
|
||||
* to relay data to and from the attached USB host.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
EVENT_HANDLER(USB_ConfigurationChanged)
|
||||
{
|
||||
/* Setup CDC Notification, Rx and Tx Endpoints */
|
||||
Endpoint_ConfigureEndpoint(CDC_NOTIFICATION_EPNUM, EP_TYPE_INTERRUPT,
|
||||
ENDPOINT_DIR_IN, CDC_NOTIFICATION_EPSIZE,
|
||||
ENDPOINT_BANK_SINGLE);
|
||||
|
||||
Endpoint_ConfigureEndpoint(CDC_TX_EPNUM, EP_TYPE_BULK,
|
||||
ENDPOINT_DIR_IN, CDC_TXRX_EPSIZE,
|
||||
ENDPOINT_BANK_SINGLE);
|
||||
|
||||
Endpoint_ConfigureEndpoint(CDC_RX_EPNUM, EP_TYPE_BULK,
|
||||
ENDPOINT_DIR_OUT, CDC_TXRX_EPSIZE,
|
||||
ENDPOINT_BANK_SINGLE);
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
/** Event handler for the USB_UnhandledControlPacket event. This is used to catch standard and class specific
|
||||
* control requests that are not handled internally by the USB library, so that they can be handled appropriately
|
||||
* for the application.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
EVENT_HANDLER(USB_UnhandledControlPacket)
|
||||
{
|
||||
uint8_t* LineCodingData = (uint8_t*)&LineCoding;
|
||||
|
||||
Endpoint_Discard_Word();
|
||||
|
||||
/* Process CDC specific control requests */
|
||||
switch (bRequest)
|
||||
{
|
||||
case REQ_GetLineEncoding:
|
||||
if (bmRequestType == (REQDIR_DEVICETOHOST | REQTYPE_CLASS | REQREC_INTERFACE))
|
||||
{
|
||||
Endpoint_ClearSetupReceived();
|
||||
|
||||
for (uint8_t i = 0; i < sizeof(LineCoding); i++)
|
||||
Endpoint_Write_Byte(*(LineCodingData++));
|
||||
|
||||
Endpoint_ClearSetupIN();
|
||||
|
||||
while (!(Endpoint_IsSetupOUTReceived()));
|
||||
Endpoint_ClearSetupOUT();
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
break;
|
||||
case REQ_SetLineEncoding:
|
||||
if (bmRequestType == (REQDIR_HOSTTODEVICE | REQTYPE_CLASS | REQREC_INTERFACE))
|
||||
{
|
||||
Endpoint_ClearSetupReceived();
|
||||
|
||||
while (!(Endpoint_IsSetupOUTReceived()));
|
||||
|
||||
for (uint8_t i = 0; i < sizeof(LineCoding); i++)
|
||||
*(LineCodingData++) = Endpoint_Read_Byte();
|
||||
|
||||
Endpoint_ClearSetupOUT();
|
||||
|
||||
while (!(Endpoint_IsSetupINReady()));
|
||||
Endpoint_ClearSetupIN();
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
break;
|
||||
case REQ_SetControlLineState:
|
||||
if (bmRequestType == (REQDIR_HOSTTODEVICE | REQTYPE_CLASS | REQREC_INTERFACE))
|
||||
{
|
||||
Endpoint_ClearSetupReceived();
|
||||
|
||||
while (!(Endpoint_IsSetupINReady()));
|
||||
Endpoint_ClearSetupIN();
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
break;
|
||||
}
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
/** Reads or writes a block of EEPROM or FLASH memory to or from the appropriate CDC data endpoint, depending
|
||||
* on the AVR910 protocol command issued.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* \param Command Single character AVR910 protocol command indicating what memory operation to perform
|
||||
*/
|
||||
static void ProgramReadWriteMemoryBlock(const uint8_t Command)
|
||||
{
|
||||
uint16_t BlockSize;
|
||||
char MemoryType;
|
||||
|
||||
bool HighByte = false;
|
||||
uint8_t LowByte = 0;
|
||||
|
||||
BlockSize = (FetchNextCommandByte() << 8);
|
||||
BlockSize |= FetchNextCommandByte();
|
||||
|
||||
MemoryType = FetchNextCommandByte();
|
||||
|
||||
if ((MemoryType == 'E') || (MemoryType == 'F'))
|
||||
{
|
||||
/* Check if command is to read memory */
|
||||
if (Command == 'g')
|
||||
{
|
||||
/* Re-enable RWW section */
|
||||
boot_rww_enable();
|
||||
|
||||
while (BlockSize--)
|
||||
{
|
||||
if (MemoryType == 'E')
|
||||
{
|
||||
/* Read the next EEPROM byte into the endpoint */
|
||||
WriteNextResponseByte(eeprom_read_byte((uint8_t*)CurrAddress));
|
||||
|
||||
/* Increment the address counter after use */
|
||||
CurrAddress++;
|
||||
}
|
||||
else
|
||||
{
|
||||
/* Read the next FLASH byte from the current FLASH page */
|
||||
#if defined(RAMPZ)
|
||||
WriteNextResponseByte(pgm_read_byte_far(((uint32_t)CurrAddress << 1) + HighByte));
|
||||
#else
|
||||
WriteNextResponseByte(pgm_read_byte((CurrAddress << 1) + HighByte));
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
/* If both bytes in current word have been read, increment the address counter */
|
||||
if (HighByte)
|
||||
CurrAddress++;
|
||||
|
||||
HighByte ^= 1;
|
||||
}
|
||||
}
|
||||
}
|
||||
else
|
||||
{
|
||||
uint32_t PageStartAddress = ((uint32_t)CurrAddress << 1);
|
||||
|
||||
if (MemoryType == 'F')
|
||||
{
|
||||
boot_page_erase(PageStartAddress);
|
||||
boot_spm_busy_wait();
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
while (BlockSize--)
|
||||
{
|
||||
if (MemoryType == 'E')
|
||||
{
|
||||
/* Write the next EEPROM byte from the endpoint */
|
||||
eeprom_write_byte((uint8_t*)CurrAddress, FetchNextCommandByte());
|
||||
|
||||
/* Increment the address counter after use */
|
||||
CurrAddress++;
|
||||
}
|
||||
else
|
||||
{
|
||||
/* If both bytes in current word have been written, increment the address counter */
|
||||
if (HighByte)
|
||||
{
|
||||
/* Write the next FLASH word to the current FLASH page */
|
||||
boot_page_fill(((uint32_t)CurrAddress << 1), ((FetchNextCommandByte() << 8) | LowByte));
|
||||
|
||||
HighByte = false;
|
||||
|
||||
/* Increment the address counter after use */
|
||||
CurrAddress++;
|
||||
}
|
||||
else
|
||||
{
|
||||
LowByte = FetchNextCommandByte();
|
||||
|
||||
HighByte = true;
|
||||
}
|
||||
}
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
/* If in FLASH programming mode, commit the page after writing */
|
||||
if (MemoryType == 'F')
|
||||
{
|
||||
/* Commit the flash page to memory */
|
||||
boot_page_write(PageStartAddress);
|
||||
|
||||
/* Wait until write operation has completed */
|
||||
boot_spm_busy_wait();
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
/* Send response byte back to the host */
|
||||
WriteNextResponseByte('\r');
|
||||
}
|
||||
}
|
||||
else
|
||||
{
|
||||
/* Send error byte back to the host */
|
||||
WriteNextResponseByte('?');
|
||||
}
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
/** Retrieves the next byte from the host in the CDC data OUT endpoint, and clears the endpoint bank if needed
|
||||
* to allow reception of the next data packet from the host.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* \return Next received byte from the host in the CDC data OUT endpoint
|
||||
*/
|
||||
static uint8_t FetchNextCommandByte(void)
|
||||
{
|
||||
/* Select the OUT endpoint so that the next data byte can be read */
|
||||
Endpoint_SelectEndpoint(CDC_RX_EPNUM);
|
||||
|
||||
/* If OUT endpoint empty, clear it and wait for the next packet from the host */
|
||||
if (!(Endpoint_ReadWriteAllowed()))
|
||||
{
|
||||
Endpoint_ClearCurrentBank();
|
||||
while (!(Endpoint_ReadWriteAllowed()));
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
/* Fetch the next byte from the OUT endpoint */
|
||||
return Endpoint_Read_Byte();
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
/** Writes the next response byte to the CDC data IN endpoint, and sends the endpoint back if needed to free up the
|
||||
* bank when full ready for the next byte in the packet to the host.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* \param Response Next response byte to send to the host
|
||||
*/
|
||||
static void WriteNextResponseByte(const uint8_t Response)
|
||||
{
|
||||
/* Select the IN endpoint so that the next data byte can be written */
|
||||
Endpoint_SelectEndpoint(CDC_TX_EPNUM);
|
||||
|
||||
/* If OUT endpoint empty, clear it and wait for the next packet from the host */
|
||||
if (!(Endpoint_ReadWriteAllowed()))
|
||||
{
|
||||
Endpoint_ClearCurrentBank();
|
||||
while (!(Endpoint_ReadWriteAllowed()));
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
/* Write the next byte to the OUT endpoint */
|
||||
Endpoint_Write_Byte(Response);
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
/** Task to read in AVR910 commands from the CDC data OUT endpoint, process them, perform the required actions
|
||||
* and send the appropriate response back to the host.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
TASK(CDC_Task)
|
||||
{
|
||||
/* Select the OUT endpoint */
|
||||
Endpoint_SelectEndpoint(CDC_RX_EPNUM);
|
||||
|
||||
/* Check if endpoint has a command in it sent from the host */
|
||||
if (Endpoint_ReadWriteAllowed())
|
||||
{
|
||||
/* Read in the bootloader command (first byte sent from host) */
|
||||
uint8_t Command = FetchNextCommandByte();
|
||||
|
||||
if ((Command == 'L') || (Command == 'P') || (Command == 'T') || (Command == 'E'))
|
||||
{
|
||||
if (Command == 'E')
|
||||
RunBootloader = false;
|
||||
if (Command == 'T')
|
||||
FetchNextCommandByte();
|
||||
|
||||
/* Send confirmation byte back to the host */
|
||||
WriteNextResponseByte('\r');
|
||||
}
|
||||
else if (Command == 't')
|
||||
{
|
||||
/* Return ATMEGA128 part code - this is only to allow AVRProg to use the bootloader */
|
||||
WriteNextResponseByte(0x44);
|
||||
|
||||
WriteNextResponseByte(0x00);
|
||||
}
|
||||
else if (Command == 'a')
|
||||
{
|
||||
/* Indicate auto-address increment is supported */
|
||||
WriteNextResponseByte('Y');
|
||||
}
|
||||
else if (Command == 'A')
|
||||
{
|
||||
/* Set the current address to that given by the host */
|
||||
CurrAddress = (FetchNextCommandByte() << 8);
|
||||
CurrAddress |= FetchNextCommandByte();
|
||||
|
||||
/* Send confirmation byte back to the host */
|
||||
WriteNextResponseByte('\r');
|
||||
}
|
||||
else if (Command == 'p')
|
||||
{
|
||||
/* Indicate serial programmer back to the host */
|
||||
WriteNextResponseByte('S');
|
||||
}
|
||||
else if (Command == 'S')
|
||||
{
|
||||
/* Write the 7-byte software identifier to the endpoint */
|
||||
for (uint8_t CurrByte = 0; CurrByte < 7; CurrByte++)
|
||||
WriteNextResponseByte(SOFTWARE_IDENTIFIER[CurrByte]);
|
||||
}
|
||||
else if (Command == 'V')
|
||||
{
|
||||
WriteNextResponseByte('0' + BOOTLOADER_VERSION_MAJOR);
|
||||
WriteNextResponseByte('0' + BOOTLOADER_VERSION_MINOR);
|
||||
}
|
||||
else if (Command == 's')
|
||||
{
|
||||
WriteNextResponseByte(boot_signature_byte_get(4));
|
||||
WriteNextResponseByte(boot_signature_byte_get(2));
|
||||
WriteNextResponseByte(boot_signature_byte_get(0));
|
||||
}
|
||||
else if (Command == 'b')
|
||||
{
|
||||
WriteNextResponseByte('Y');
|
||||
|
||||
/* Send block size to the host */
|
||||
WriteNextResponseByte(SPM_PAGESIZE >> 8);
|
||||
WriteNextResponseByte(SPM_PAGESIZE & 0xFF);
|
||||
}
|
||||
else if (Command == 'e')
|
||||
{
|
||||
/* Clear the application section of flash */
|
||||
for (uint32_t CurrFlashAddress = 0; CurrFlashAddress < BOOT_START_ADDR; CurrFlashAddress++)
|
||||
{
|
||||
boot_page_erase(CurrFlashAddress);
|
||||
boot_spm_busy_wait();
|
||||
boot_page_write(CurrFlashAddress);
|
||||
boot_spm_busy_wait();
|
||||
|
||||
CurrFlashAddress += SPM_PAGESIZE;
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
/* Send confirmation byte back to the host */
|
||||
WriteNextResponseByte('\r');
|
||||
}
|
||||
else if (Command == 'l')
|
||||
{
|
||||
/* Set the lock bits to those given by the host */
|
||||
boot_lock_bits_set(FetchNextCommandByte());
|
||||
|
||||
/* Send confirmation byte back to the host */
|
||||
WriteNextResponseByte('\r');
|
||||
}
|
||||
else if (Command == 'r')
|
||||
{
|
||||
WriteNextResponseByte(boot_lock_fuse_bits_get(GET_LOCK_BITS));
|
||||
}
|
||||
else if (Command == 'F')
|
||||
{
|
||||
WriteNextResponseByte(boot_lock_fuse_bits_get(GET_LOW_FUSE_BITS));
|
||||
}
|
||||
else if (Command == 'N')
|
||||
{
|
||||
WriteNextResponseByte(boot_lock_fuse_bits_get(GET_HIGH_FUSE_BITS));
|
||||
}
|
||||
else if (Command == 'Q')
|
||||
{
|
||||
WriteNextResponseByte(boot_lock_fuse_bits_get(GET_EXTENDED_FUSE_BITS));
|
||||
}
|
||||
else if ((Command == 'C') || (Command == 'c'))
|
||||
{
|
||||
if (Command == 'c')
|
||||
{
|
||||
/* Increment the address if the second byte is being written */
|
||||
CurrAddress++;
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
/* Write the high byte to the current flash page */
|
||||
boot_page_fill(((uint32_t)CurrAddress << 1), FetchNextCommandByte());
|
||||
|
||||
/* Send confirmation byte back to the host */
|
||||
WriteNextResponseByte('\r');
|
||||
}
|
||||
else if (Command == 'm')
|
||||
{
|
||||
/* Commit the flash page to memory */
|
||||
boot_page_write((uint32_t)CurrAddress << 1);
|
||||
|
||||
/* Wait until write operation has completed */
|
||||
boot_spm_busy_wait();
|
||||
|
||||
/* Send confirmation byte back to the host */
|
||||
WriteNextResponseByte('\r');
|
||||
}
|
||||
else if ((Command == 'B') || (Command == 'g'))
|
||||
{
|
||||
/* Delegate the block write/read to a seperate function for clarity */
|
||||
ProgramReadWriteMemoryBlock(Command);
|
||||
}
|
||||
else if (Command == 'R')
|
||||
{
|
||||
#if defined(RAMPZ)
|
||||
uint16_t ProgramWord = pgm_read_word_far(((uint32_t)CurrAddress << 1));
|
||||
#else
|
||||
uint16_t ProgramWord = pgm_read_word(CurrAddress << 1);
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
WriteNextResponseByte(ProgramWord >> 8);
|
||||
WriteNextResponseByte(ProgramWord & 0xFF);
|
||||
}
|
||||
else if (Command == 'D')
|
||||
{
|
||||
/* Read the byte from the endpoint and write it to the EEPROM */
|
||||
eeprom_write_byte((uint8_t*)CurrAddress, FetchNextCommandByte());
|
||||
|
||||
/* Increment the address after use */
|
||||
CurrAddress++;
|
||||
|
||||
/* Send confirmation byte back to the host */
|
||||
WriteNextResponseByte('\r');
|
||||
}
|
||||
else if (Command == 'd')
|
||||
{
|
||||
/* Read the EEPROM byte and write it to the endpoint */
|
||||
WriteNextResponseByte(eeprom_read_byte((uint8_t*)CurrAddress));
|
||||
|
||||
/* Increment the address after use */
|
||||
CurrAddress++;
|
||||
}
|
||||
else if (Command == 27)
|
||||
{
|
||||
/* Escape is sync, ignore */
|
||||
}
|
||||
else
|
||||
{
|
||||
/* Unknown command, return fail code */
|
||||
WriteNextResponseByte('?');
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
/* Select the IN endpoint */
|
||||
Endpoint_SelectEndpoint(CDC_TX_EPNUM);
|
||||
|
||||
/* Remember if the endpoint is completely full before clearing it */
|
||||
bool IsEndpointFull = !(Endpoint_ReadWriteAllowed());
|
||||
|
||||
/* Send the endpoint data to the host */
|
||||
Endpoint_ClearCurrentBank();
|
||||
|
||||
/* If a full endpoint's worth of data was sent, we need to send an empty packet afterwards to signal end of transfer */
|
||||
if (IsEndpointFull)
|
||||
{
|
||||
while (!(Endpoint_ReadWriteAllowed()));
|
||||
Endpoint_ClearCurrentBank();
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
/* Select the OUT endpoint */
|
||||
Endpoint_SelectEndpoint(CDC_RX_EPNUM);
|
||||
|
||||
/* Acknowledge the command from the host */
|
||||
Endpoint_ClearCurrentBank();
|
||||
}
|
||||
}
|
@ -0,0 +1,135 @@
|
||||
/*
|
||||
LUFA Library
|
||||
Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2009.
|
||||
|
||||
dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com
|
||||
www.fourwalledcubicle.com
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
/*
|
||||
Copyright 2009 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com)
|
||||
|
||||
Permission to use, copy, modify, and distribute this software
|
||||
and its documentation for any purpose and without fee is hereby
|
||||
granted, provided that the above copyright notice appear in all
|
||||
copies and that both that the copyright notice and this
|
||||
permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting
|
||||
documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in
|
||||
advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the
|
||||
software without specific, written prior permission.
|
||||
|
||||
The author disclaim all warranties with regard to this
|
||||
software, including all implied warranties of merchantability
|
||||
and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any
|
||||
special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages
|
||||
whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether
|
||||
in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action,
|
||||
arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of
|
||||
this software.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
/** \file
|
||||
*
|
||||
* Header file for BootloaderCDC.c.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
#ifndef _CDC_H_
|
||||
#define _CDC_H_
|
||||
|
||||
/* Includes: */
|
||||
#include <avr/io.h>
|
||||
#include <avr/wdt.h>
|
||||
#include <avr/boot.h>
|
||||
#include <avr/eeprom.h>
|
||||
#include <stdbool.h>
|
||||
|
||||
#include "Descriptors.h"
|
||||
|
||||
#include <LUFA/Drivers/USB/USB.h> // USB Functionality
|
||||
|
||||
/* Macros: */
|
||||
/** CDC Class Specific request to get the line encoding on a CDC-ACM virtual serial port, including the
|
||||
* baud rate, parity, stop bits and data bits.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
#define REQ_GetLineEncoding 0x21
|
||||
|
||||
/** CDC Class Specific request to set the line encoding on a CDC-ACM virtual serial port, including the
|
||||
* baud rate, parity, stop bits and data bits.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
#define REQ_SetLineEncoding 0x20
|
||||
|
||||
/** CDC Class Specific request to set the state of the serial handshake lines (such as DCD and RTS) on
|
||||
* a CDC-ACM virtual serial port.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
#define REQ_SetControlLineState 0x22
|
||||
|
||||
/** Version major of the CDC bootloader. */
|
||||
#define BOOTLOADER_VERSION_MAJOR 0x01
|
||||
|
||||
/** Version minor of the CDC bootloader. */
|
||||
#define BOOTLOADER_VERSION_MINOR 0x00
|
||||
|
||||
/** Hardware version major of the CDC bootloader. */
|
||||
#define BOOTLOADER_HWVERSION_MAJOR 0x01
|
||||
|
||||
/** Hardware version minor of the CDC bootloader. */
|
||||
#define BOOTLOADER_HWVERSION_MINOR 0x00
|
||||
|
||||
/** Eight character bootloader firmware identifier reported to the host when requested */
|
||||
#define SOFTWARE_IDENTIFIER "LUFA-CDC"
|
||||
|
||||
/* Event Handlers: */
|
||||
/** Indicates that this module will catch the USB_Disconnect event when thrown by the library. */
|
||||
HANDLES_EVENT(USB_Disconnect);
|
||||
|
||||
/** Indicates that this module will catch the USB_ConfigurationChanged event when thrown by the library. */
|
||||
HANDLES_EVENT(USB_ConfigurationChanged);
|
||||
|
||||
/** Indicates that this module will catch the USB_UnhandledControlPacket event when thrown by the library. */
|
||||
HANDLES_EVENT(USB_UnhandledControlPacket);
|
||||
|
||||
/* Type Defines: */
|
||||
/** Type define for a non-returning pointer to the start of the loaded application in flash memory. */
|
||||
typedef void (*AppPtr_t)(void) ATTR_NO_RETURN;
|
||||
|
||||
/** Type define for the CDC-ACM virtual serial port line encoding options, including baud rate, format, parity
|
||||
* and size of each data chunk in bits.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
typedef struct
|
||||
{
|
||||
uint32_t BaudRateBPS; /**< Baud rate in BPS */
|
||||
uint8_t CharFormat; /**< Character format, an entry from the BootloaderCDC_CDC_LineCodingFormats_t enum */
|
||||
uint8_t ParityType; /**< Parity mode, an entry from the BootloaderCDC_CDC_LineCodeingParity_t enum */
|
||||
uint8_t DataBits; /**< Size of each data chunk, in bits */
|
||||
} CDC_Line_Coding_t;
|
||||
|
||||
/* Enums: */
|
||||
/** Enum for the possible line encoding formats on a CDC-ACM virtual serial port */
|
||||
enum BootloaderCDC_CDC_LineCodingFormats_t
|
||||
{
|
||||
OneStopBit = 0, /**< Single stop bit */
|
||||
OneAndAHalfStopBits = 1, /**< 1.5 stop bits */
|
||||
TwoStopBits = 2, /**< Two stop bits */
|
||||
};
|
||||
|
||||
/** Enum for the possible parity modes on a CDC-ACM virtual serial port */
|
||||
enum BootloaderCDC_CDC_LineCodeingParity_t
|
||||
{
|
||||
Parity_None = 0, /**< No data parity checking */
|
||||
Parity_Odd = 1, /**< Odd data parity checking */
|
||||
Parity_Even = 2, /**< Even data parity checking */
|
||||
Parity_Mark = 3, /**< Mark data parity checking */
|
||||
Parity_Space = 4, /**< Space data parity checking */
|
||||
};
|
||||
|
||||
/* Tasks: */
|
||||
TASK(CDC_Task);
|
||||
|
||||
/* Function Prototypes: */
|
||||
#if defined(INCLUDE_FROM_BOOTLOADERCDC_C) || defined(__DOXYGEN__)
|
||||
static void ProgramReadWriteMemoryBlock(const uint8_t Command);
|
||||
static uint8_t FetchNextCommandByte(void);
|
||||
static void WriteNextResponseByte(const uint8_t Response);
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
#endif
|
@ -0,0 +1,40 @@
|
||||
/** \file
|
||||
*
|
||||
* This file contains special DoxyGen information for the generation of the main page and other special
|
||||
* documentation pages. It is not a project source file.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
/** \mainpage CDC Class USB AVR Bootloader
|
||||
*
|
||||
* This bootloader enumerates to the host as a CDC Class device (virtual serial port), allowing for AVR109
|
||||
* protocol compatible programming software to load firmware onto the AVR.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* Out of the box this bootloader builds for the USB1287, and will fit into 4KB of bootloader space. If
|
||||
* you wish to enlarge this space and/or change the AVR model, you will need to edit the BOOT_START and MCU
|
||||
* values in the accompanying makefile.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* This bootloader is compatible with the open source application AVRDUDE, or Atmel's AVRPROG.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* <table>
|
||||
* <tr>
|
||||
* <td><b>USB Mode:</b></td>
|
||||
* <td>Device</td>
|
||||
* </tr>
|
||||
* <tr>
|
||||
* <td><b>USB Class:</b></td>
|
||||
* <td>Communications Device Class (CDC)</td>
|
||||
* </tr>
|
||||
* <tr>
|
||||
* <td><b>USB Subclass:</b></td>
|
||||
* <td>Abstract Control Model (ACM)</td>
|
||||
* </tr>
|
||||
* <tr>
|
||||
* <td><b>Relevant Standards:</b></td>
|
||||
* <td>USBIF CDC Class Standard</td>
|
||||
* </tr>
|
||||
* <tr>
|
||||
* <td><b>Usable Speeds:</b></td>
|
||||
* <td>Full Speed Mode</td>
|
||||
* </tr>
|
||||
* </table>
|
||||
*/
|
@ -0,0 +1,247 @@
|
||||
/*
|
||||
LUFA Library
|
||||
Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2009.
|
||||
|
||||
dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com
|
||||
www.fourwalledcubicle.com
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
/*
|
||||
Copyright 2009 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com)
|
||||
|
||||
Permission to use, copy, modify, and distribute this software
|
||||
and its documentation for any purpose and without fee is hereby
|
||||
granted, provided that the above copyright notice appear in all
|
||||
copies and that both that the copyright notice and this
|
||||
permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting
|
||||
documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in
|
||||
advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the
|
||||
software without specific, written prior permission.
|
||||
|
||||
The author disclaim all warranties with regard to this
|
||||
software, including all implied warranties of merchantability
|
||||
and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any
|
||||
special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages
|
||||
whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether
|
||||
in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action,
|
||||
arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of
|
||||
this software.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
/** \file
|
||||
*
|
||||
* USB Device Descriptors, for library use when in USB device mode. Descriptors are special
|
||||
* computer-readable structures which the host requests upon device enumeration, to determine
|
||||
* the device's capabilities and functions.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
#include "Descriptors.h"
|
||||
|
||||
/** Device descriptor structure. This descriptor, located in SRAM memory, describes the overall
|
||||
* device characteristics, including the supported USB version, control endpoint size and the
|
||||
* number of device configurations. The descriptor is read out by the USB host when the enumeration
|
||||
* process begins.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
USB_Descriptor_Device_t DeviceDescriptor =
|
||||
{
|
||||
Header: {Size: sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Device_t), Type: DTYPE_Device},
|
||||
|
||||
USBSpecification: VERSION_BCD(01.10),
|
||||
Class: 0x02,
|
||||
SubClass: 0x00,
|
||||
Protocol: 0x00,
|
||||
|
||||
Endpoint0Size: FIXED_CONTROL_ENDPOINT_SIZE,
|
||||
|
||||
VendorID: 0x03EB,
|
||||
ProductID: 0x204A,
|
||||
ReleaseNumber: 0x0000,
|
||||
|
||||
ManufacturerStrIndex: NO_DESCRIPTOR,
|
||||
ProductStrIndex: 0x01,
|
||||
SerialNumStrIndex: NO_DESCRIPTOR,
|
||||
|
||||
NumberOfConfigurations: 1
|
||||
};
|
||||
|
||||
/** Configuration descriptor structure. This descriptor, located in SRAM memory, describes the usage
|
||||
* of the device in one of its supported configurations, including information about any device interfaces
|
||||
* and endpoints. The descriptor is read out by the USB host during the enumeration process when selecting
|
||||
* a configuration so that the host may correctly communicate with the USB device.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
USB_Descriptor_Configuration_t ConfigurationDescriptor =
|
||||
{
|
||||
Config:
|
||||
{
|
||||
Header: {Size: sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Configuration_Header_t), Type: DTYPE_Configuration},
|
||||
|
||||
TotalConfigurationSize: sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Configuration_t),
|
||||
TotalInterfaces: 2,
|
||||
|
||||
ConfigurationNumber: 1,
|
||||
ConfigurationStrIndex: NO_DESCRIPTOR,
|
||||
|
||||
ConfigAttributes: (USB_CONFIG_ATTR_BUSPOWERED | USB_CONFIG_ATTR_SELFPOWERED),
|
||||
|
||||
MaxPowerConsumption: USB_CONFIG_POWER_MA(100)
|
||||
},
|
||||
|
||||
CCI_Interface:
|
||||
{
|
||||
Header: {Size: sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Interface_t), Type: DTYPE_Interface},
|
||||
|
||||
InterfaceNumber: 0,
|
||||
AlternateSetting: 0,
|
||||
|
||||
TotalEndpoints: 1,
|
||||
|
||||
Class: 0x02,
|
||||
SubClass: 0x02,
|
||||
Protocol: 0x01,
|
||||
|
||||
InterfaceStrIndex: NO_DESCRIPTOR
|
||||
},
|
||||
|
||||
CDC_Functional_IntHeader:
|
||||
{
|
||||
Header: {Size: sizeof(CDC_FUNCTIONAL_DESCRIPTOR(2)), Type: 0x24},
|
||||
SubType: 0x00,
|
||||
|
||||
Data: {0x10, 0x01}
|
||||
},
|
||||
|
||||
CDC_Functional_CallManagement:
|
||||
{
|
||||
Header: {Size: sizeof(CDC_FUNCTIONAL_DESCRIPTOR(2)), Type: 0x24},
|
||||
SubType: 0x01,
|
||||
|
||||
Data: {0x03, 0x01}
|
||||
},
|
||||
|
||||
CDC_Functional_AbstractControlManagement:
|
||||
{
|
||||
Header: {Size: sizeof(CDC_FUNCTIONAL_DESCRIPTOR(1)), Type: 0x24},
|
||||
SubType: 0x02,
|
||||
|
||||
Data: {0x06}
|
||||
},
|
||||
|
||||
CDC_Functional_Union:
|
||||
{
|
||||
Header: {Size: sizeof(CDC_FUNCTIONAL_DESCRIPTOR(2)), Type: 0x24},
|
||||
SubType: 0x06,
|
||||
|
||||
Data: {0x00, 0x01}
|
||||
},
|
||||
|
||||
ManagementEndpoint:
|
||||
{
|
||||
Header: {Size: sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t), Type: DTYPE_Endpoint},
|
||||
|
||||
EndpointAddress: (ENDPOINT_DESCRIPTOR_DIR_IN | CDC_NOTIFICATION_EPNUM),
|
||||
Attributes: EP_TYPE_INTERRUPT,
|
||||
EndpointSize: CDC_NOTIFICATION_EPSIZE,
|
||||
PollingIntervalMS: 0x02
|
||||
},
|
||||
|
||||
DCI_Interface:
|
||||
{
|
||||
Header: {Size: sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Interface_t), Type: DTYPE_Interface},
|
||||
|
||||
InterfaceNumber: 1,
|
||||
AlternateSetting: 0,
|
||||
|
||||
TotalEndpoints: 2,
|
||||
|
||||
Class: 0x0A,
|
||||
SubClass: 0x00,
|
||||
Protocol: 0x00,
|
||||
|
||||
InterfaceStrIndex: NO_DESCRIPTOR
|
||||
},
|
||||
|
||||
DataOutEndpoint:
|
||||
{
|
||||
Header: {Size: sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t), Type: DTYPE_Endpoint},
|
||||
|
||||
EndpointAddress: (ENDPOINT_DESCRIPTOR_DIR_OUT | CDC_RX_EPNUM),
|
||||
Attributes: EP_TYPE_BULK,
|
||||
EndpointSize: CDC_TXRX_EPSIZE,
|
||||
PollingIntervalMS: 0x00
|
||||
},
|
||||
|
||||
DataInEndpoint:
|
||||
{
|
||||
Header: {Size: sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t), Type: DTYPE_Endpoint},
|
||||
|
||||
EndpointAddress: (ENDPOINT_DESCRIPTOR_DIR_IN | CDC_TX_EPNUM),
|
||||
Attributes: EP_TYPE_BULK,
|
||||
EndpointSize: CDC_TXRX_EPSIZE,
|
||||
PollingIntervalMS: 0x00
|
||||
}
|
||||
};
|
||||
|
||||
/** Language descriptor structure. This descriptor, located in SRAM memory, is returned when the host requests
|
||||
* the string descriptor with index 0 (the first index). It is actually an array of 16-bit integers, which indicate
|
||||
* via the language ID table available at USB.org what languages the device supports for its string descriptors.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
USB_Descriptor_String_t LanguageString =
|
||||
{
|
||||
Header: {Size: USB_STRING_LEN(1), Type: DTYPE_String},
|
||||
|
||||
UnicodeString: {LANGUAGE_ID_ENG}
|
||||
};
|
||||
|
||||
/** Product descriptor string. This is a Unicode string containing the product's details in human readable form,
|
||||
* and is read out upon request by the host when the appropriate string ID is requested, listed in the Device
|
||||
* Descriptor.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
USB_Descriptor_String_t ProductString =
|
||||
{
|
||||
Header: {Size: USB_STRING_LEN(15), Type: DTYPE_String},
|
||||
|
||||
UnicodeString: L"AVR CDC Bootloader"
|
||||
};
|
||||
|
||||
/** This function is called by the library when in device mode, and must be overridden (see StdDescriptors.h
|
||||
* documentation) by the application code so that the address and size of a requested descriptor can be given
|
||||
* to the USB library. When the device recieves a Get Descriptor request on the control endpoint, this function
|
||||
* is called so that the descriptor details can be passed back and the appropriate descriptor sent back to the
|
||||
* USB host.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
uint16_t USB_GetDescriptor(const uint16_t wValue, const uint8_t wIndex, void** const DescriptorAddress)
|
||||
{
|
||||
const uint8_t DescriptorType = (wValue >> 8);
|
||||
const uint8_t DescriptorNumber = (wValue & 0xFF);
|
||||
|
||||
void* Address = NULL;
|
||||
uint16_t Size = NO_DESCRIPTOR;
|
||||
|
||||
switch (DescriptorType)
|
||||
{
|
||||
case DTYPE_Device:
|
||||
Address = DESCRIPTOR_ADDRESS(DeviceDescriptor);
|
||||
Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Device_t);
|
||||
break;
|
||||
case DTYPE_Configuration:
|
||||
Address = DESCRIPTOR_ADDRESS(ConfigurationDescriptor);
|
||||
Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Configuration_t);
|
||||
break;
|
||||
case DTYPE_String:
|
||||
if (!(DescriptorNumber))
|
||||
{
|
||||
Address = DESCRIPTOR_ADDRESS(LanguageString);
|
||||
Size = LanguageString.Header.Size;
|
||||
}
|
||||
else
|
||||
{
|
||||
Address = DESCRIPTOR_ADDRESS(ProductString);
|
||||
Size = ProductString.Header.Size;
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
break;
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
*DescriptorAddress = Address;
|
||||
return Size;
|
||||
}
|
@ -0,0 +1,95 @@
|
||||
/*
|
||||
LUFA Library
|
||||
Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2009.
|
||||
|
||||
dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com
|
||||
www.fourwalledcubicle.com
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
/*
|
||||
Copyright 2009 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com)
|
||||
|
||||
Permission to use, copy, modify, and distribute this software
|
||||
and its documentation for any purpose and without fee is hereby
|
||||
granted, provided that the above copyright notice appear in all
|
||||
copies and that both that the copyright notice and this
|
||||
permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting
|
||||
documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in
|
||||
advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the
|
||||
software without specific, written prior permission.
|
||||
|
||||
The author disclaim all warranties with regard to this
|
||||
software, including all implied warranties of merchantability
|
||||
and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any
|
||||
special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages
|
||||
whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether
|
||||
in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action,
|
||||
arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of
|
||||
this software.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
/** \file
|
||||
*
|
||||
* Header file for Descriptors.c.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
#ifndef _DESCRIPTORS_H_
|
||||
#define _DESCRIPTORS_H_
|
||||
|
||||
/* Includes: */
|
||||
#include <LUFA/Drivers/USB/USB.h>
|
||||
|
||||
/* Macros: */
|
||||
/** Structure for a CDC class Functional descriptor, with a given data size. This is used instead of a
|
||||
* type define so that the same macro can be used for functional descriptors of varying data lengths,
|
||||
* while allowing the sizeof() operator to return correct results.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* \param DataSize Size of the functional descriptor's data payload, in bytes
|
||||
*/
|
||||
#define CDC_FUNCTIONAL_DESCRIPTOR(DataSize) \
|
||||
struct \
|
||||
{ \
|
||||
USB_Descriptor_Header_t Header; \
|
||||
uint8_t SubType; \
|
||||
uint8_t Data[DataSize]; \
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
/** Endpoint number for the CDC control interface event notification endpoint. */
|
||||
#define CDC_NOTIFICATION_EPNUM 3
|
||||
|
||||
/** Size of the CDC control interface notification endpoint bank, in bytes */
|
||||
#define CDC_NOTIFICATION_EPSIZE 8
|
||||
|
||||
/** Endpoint number for the CDC data interface TX (data IN) endpoint */
|
||||
#define CDC_TX_EPNUM 1
|
||||
|
||||
/** Endpoint number for the CDC data interface RX (data OUT) endpoint */
|
||||
#define CDC_RX_EPNUM 2
|
||||
|
||||
/** Size of the CDC data interface TX and RX data endpoint banks, in bytes */
|
||||
#define CDC_TXRX_EPSIZE 16
|
||||
|
||||
/* Type Defines: */
|
||||
/** Type define for the device configuration descriptor structure. This must be defined in the
|
||||
* application code, as the configuration descriptor contains several sub-descriptors which
|
||||
* vary between devices, and which describe the device's usage to the host.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
typedef struct
|
||||
{
|
||||
USB_Descriptor_Configuration_Header_t Config;
|
||||
USB_Descriptor_Interface_t CCI_Interface;
|
||||
CDC_FUNCTIONAL_DESCRIPTOR(2) CDC_Functional_IntHeader;
|
||||
CDC_FUNCTIONAL_DESCRIPTOR(2) CDC_Functional_CallManagement;
|
||||
CDC_FUNCTIONAL_DESCRIPTOR(1) CDC_Functional_AbstractControlManagement;
|
||||
CDC_FUNCTIONAL_DESCRIPTOR(2) CDC_Functional_Union;
|
||||
USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t ManagementEndpoint;
|
||||
USB_Descriptor_Interface_t DCI_Interface;
|
||||
USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t DataOutEndpoint;
|
||||
USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t DataInEndpoint;
|
||||
} USB_Descriptor_Configuration_t;
|
||||
|
||||
/* Function Prototypes: */
|
||||
uint16_t USB_GetDescriptor(const uint16_t wValue, const uint8_t wIndex, void** const DescriptorAddress)
|
||||
ATTR_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(3);
|
||||
|
||||
#endif
|
@ -0,0 +1,1485 @@
|
||||
# Doxyfile 1.5.7.1
|
||||
|
||||
# This file describes the settings to be used by the documentation system
|
||||
# doxygen (www.doxygen.org) for a project
|
||||
#
|
||||
# All text after a hash (#) is considered a comment and will be ignored
|
||||
# The format is:
|
||||
# TAG = value [value, ...]
|
||||
# For lists items can also be appended using:
|
||||
# TAG += value [value, ...]
|
||||
# Values that contain spaces should be placed between quotes (" ")
|
||||
|
||||
#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
|
||||
# Project related configuration options
|
||||
#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
|
||||
|
||||
# This tag specifies the encoding used for all characters in the config file
|
||||
# that follow. The default is UTF-8 which is also the encoding used for all
|
||||
# text before the first occurrence of this tag. Doxygen uses libiconv (or the
|
||||
# iconv built into libc) for the transcoding. See
|
||||
# http://www.gnu.org/software/libiconv for the list of possible encodings.
|
||||
|
||||
DOXYFILE_ENCODING = UTF-8
|
||||
|
||||
# The PROJECT_NAME tag is a single word (or a sequence of words surrounded
|
||||
# by quotes) that should identify the project.
|
||||
|
||||
PROJECT_NAME = "LUFA Library - CDC Class Bootloader"
|
||||
|
||||
# The PROJECT_NUMBER tag can be used to enter a project or revision number.
|
||||
# This could be handy for archiving the generated documentation or
|
||||
# if some version control system is used.
|
||||
|
||||
PROJECT_NUMBER = 0.0.0
|
||||
|
||||
# The OUTPUT_DIRECTORY tag is used to specify the (relative or absolute)
|
||||
# base path where the generated documentation will be put.
|
||||
# If a relative path is entered, it will be relative to the location
|
||||
# where doxygen was started. If left blank the current directory will be used.
|
||||
|
||||
OUTPUT_DIRECTORY = ./Documentation/
|
||||
|
||||
# If the CREATE_SUBDIRS tag is set to YES, then doxygen will create
|
||||
# 4096 sub-directories (in 2 levels) under the output directory of each output
|
||||
# format and will distribute the generated files over these directories.
|
||||
# Enabling this option can be useful when feeding doxygen a huge amount of
|
||||
# source files, where putting all generated files in the same directory would
|
||||
# otherwise cause performance problems for the file system.
|
||||
|
||||
CREATE_SUBDIRS = YES
|
||||
|
||||
# The OUTPUT_LANGUAGE tag is used to specify the language in which all
|
||||
# documentation generated by doxygen is written. Doxygen will use this
|
||||
# information to generate all constant output in the proper language.
|
||||
# The default language is English, other supported languages are:
|
||||
# Afrikaans, Arabic, Brazilian, Catalan, Chinese, Chinese-Traditional,
|
||||
# Croatian, Czech, Danish, Dutch, Farsi, Finnish, French, German, Greek,
|
||||
# Hungarian, Italian, Japanese, Japanese-en (Japanese with English messages),
|
||||
# Korean, Korean-en, Lithuanian, Norwegian, Macedonian, Persian, Polish,
|
||||
# Portuguese, Romanian, Russian, Serbian, Serbian-Cyrilic, Slovak, Slovene,
|
||||
# Spanish, Swedish, and Ukrainian.
|
||||
|
||||
OUTPUT_LANGUAGE = English
|
||||
|
||||
# If the BRIEF_MEMBER_DESC tag is set to YES (the default) Doxygen will
|
||||
# include brief member descriptions after the members that are listed in
|
||||
# the file and class documentation (similar to JavaDoc).
|
||||
# Set to NO to disable this.
|
||||
|
||||
BRIEF_MEMBER_DESC = YES
|
||||
|
||||
# If the REPEAT_BRIEF tag is set to YES (the default) Doxygen will prepend
|
||||
# the brief description of a member or function before the detailed description.
|
||||
# Note: if both HIDE_UNDOC_MEMBERS and BRIEF_MEMBER_DESC are set to NO, the
|
||||
# brief descriptions will be completely suppressed.
|
||||
|
||||
REPEAT_BRIEF = YES
|
||||
|
||||
# This tag implements a quasi-intelligent brief description abbreviator
|
||||
# that is used to form the text in various listings. Each string
|
||||
# in this list, if found as the leading text of the brief description, will be
|
||||
# stripped from the text and the result after processing the whole list, is
|
||||
# used as the annotated text. Otherwise, the brief description is used as-is.
|
||||
# If left blank, the following values are used ("$name" is automatically
|
||||
# replaced with the name of the entity): "The $name class" "The $name widget"
|
||||
# "The $name file" "is" "provides" "specifies" "contains"
|
||||
# "represents" "a" "an" "the"
|
||||
|
||||
ABBREVIATE_BRIEF = "The $name class" \
|
||||
"The $name widget" \
|
||||
"The $name file" \
|
||||
is \
|
||||
provides \
|
||||
specifies \
|
||||
contains \
|
||||
represents \
|
||||
a \
|
||||
an \
|
||||
the
|
||||
|
||||
# If the ALWAYS_DETAILED_SEC and REPEAT_BRIEF tags are both set to YES then
|
||||
# Doxygen will generate a detailed section even if there is only a brief
|
||||
# description.
|
||||
|
||||
ALWAYS_DETAILED_SEC = NO
|
||||
|
||||
# If the INLINE_INHERITED_MEMB tag is set to YES, doxygen will show all
|
||||
# inherited members of a class in the documentation of that class as if those
|
||||
# members were ordinary class members. Constructors, destructors and assignment
|
||||
# operators of the base classes will not be shown.
|
||||
|
||||
INLINE_INHERITED_MEMB = NO
|
||||
|
||||
# If the FULL_PATH_NAMES tag is set to YES then Doxygen will prepend the full
|
||||
# path before files name in the file list and in the header files. If set
|
||||
# to NO the shortest path that makes the file name unique will be used.
|
||||
|
||||
FULL_PATH_NAMES = YES
|
||||
|
||||
# If the FULL_PATH_NAMES tag is set to YES then the STRIP_FROM_PATH tag
|
||||
# can be used to strip a user-defined part of the path. Stripping is
|
||||
# only done if one of the specified strings matches the left-hand part of
|
||||
# the path. The tag can be used to show relative paths in the file list.
|
||||
# If left blank the directory from which doxygen is run is used as the
|
||||
# path to strip.
|
||||
|
||||
STRIP_FROM_PATH =
|
||||
|
||||
# The STRIP_FROM_INC_PATH tag can be used to strip a user-defined part of
|
||||
# the path mentioned in the documentation of a class, which tells
|
||||
# the reader which header file to include in order to use a class.
|
||||
# If left blank only the name of the header file containing the class
|
||||
# definition is used. Otherwise one should specify the include paths that
|
||||
# are normally passed to the compiler using the -I flag.
|
||||
|
||||
STRIP_FROM_INC_PATH =
|
||||
|
||||
# If the SHORT_NAMES tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate much shorter
|
||||
# (but less readable) file names. This can be useful is your file systems
|
||||
# doesn't support long names like on DOS, Mac, or CD-ROM.
|
||||
|
||||
SHORT_NAMES = YES
|
||||
|
||||
# If the JAVADOC_AUTOBRIEF tag is set to YES then Doxygen
|
||||
# will interpret the first line (until the first dot) of a JavaDoc-style
|
||||
# comment as the brief description. If set to NO, the JavaDoc
|
||||
# comments will behave just like regular Qt-style comments
|
||||
# (thus requiring an explicit @brief command for a brief description.)
|
||||
|
||||
JAVADOC_AUTOBRIEF = NO
|
||||
|
||||
# If the QT_AUTOBRIEF tag is set to YES then Doxygen will
|
||||
# interpret the first line (until the first dot) of a Qt-style
|
||||
# comment as the brief description. If set to NO, the comments
|
||||
# will behave just like regular Qt-style comments (thus requiring
|
||||
# an explicit \brief command for a brief description.)
|
||||
|
||||
QT_AUTOBRIEF = NO
|
||||
|
||||
# The MULTILINE_CPP_IS_BRIEF tag can be set to YES to make Doxygen
|
||||
# treat a multi-line C++ special comment block (i.e. a block of //! or ///
|
||||
# comments) as a brief description. This used to be the default behaviour.
|
||||
# The new default is to treat a multi-line C++ comment block as a detailed
|
||||
# description. Set this tag to YES if you prefer the old behaviour instead.
|
||||
|
||||
MULTILINE_CPP_IS_BRIEF = NO
|
||||
|
||||
# If the INHERIT_DOCS tag is set to YES (the default) then an undocumented
|
||||
# member inherits the documentation from any documented member that it
|
||||
# re-implements.
|
||||
|
||||
INHERIT_DOCS = YES
|
||||
|
||||
# If the SEPARATE_MEMBER_PAGES tag is set to YES, then doxygen will produce
|
||||
# a new page for each member. If set to NO, the documentation of a member will
|
||||
# be part of the file/class/namespace that contains it.
|
||||
|
||||
SEPARATE_MEMBER_PAGES = NO
|
||||
|
||||
# The TAB_SIZE tag can be used to set the number of spaces in a tab.
|
||||
# Doxygen uses this value to replace tabs by spaces in code fragments.
|
||||
|
||||
TAB_SIZE = 4
|
||||
|
||||
# This tag can be used to specify a number of aliases that acts
|
||||
# as commands in the documentation. An alias has the form "name=value".
|
||||
# For example adding "sideeffect=\par Side Effects:\n" will allow you to
|
||||
# put the command \sideeffect (or @sideeffect) in the documentation, which
|
||||
# will result in a user-defined paragraph with heading "Side Effects:".
|
||||
# You can put \n's in the value part of an alias to insert newlines.
|
||||
|
||||
ALIASES =
|
||||
|
||||
# Set the OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_FOR_C tag to YES if your project consists of C
|
||||
# sources only. Doxygen will then generate output that is more tailored for C.
|
||||
# For instance, some of the names that are used will be different. The list
|
||||
# of all members will be omitted, etc.
|
||||
|
||||
OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_FOR_C = YES
|
||||
|
||||
# Set the OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_JAVA tag to YES if your project consists of Java
|
||||
# sources only. Doxygen will then generate output that is more tailored for
|
||||
# Java. For instance, namespaces will be presented as packages, qualified
|
||||
# scopes will look different, etc.
|
||||
|
||||
OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_JAVA = NO
|
||||
|
||||
# Set the OPTIMIZE_FOR_FORTRAN tag to YES if your project consists of Fortran
|
||||
# sources only. Doxygen will then generate output that is more tailored for
|
||||
# Fortran.
|
||||
|
||||
OPTIMIZE_FOR_FORTRAN = NO
|
||||
|
||||
# Set the OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_VHDL tag to YES if your project consists of VHDL
|
||||
# sources. Doxygen will then generate output that is tailored for
|
||||
# VHDL.
|
||||
|
||||
OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_VHDL = NO
|
||||
|
||||
# If you use STL classes (i.e. std::string, std::vector, etc.) but do not want
|
||||
# to include (a tag file for) the STL sources as input, then you should
|
||||
# set this tag to YES in order to let doxygen match functions declarations and
|
||||
# definitions whose arguments contain STL classes (e.g. func(std::string); v.s.
|
||||
# func(std::string) {}). This also make the inheritance and collaboration
|
||||
# diagrams that involve STL classes more complete and accurate.
|
||||
|
||||
BUILTIN_STL_SUPPORT = NO
|
||||
|
||||
# If you use Microsoft's C++/CLI language, you should set this option to YES to
|
||||
# enable parsing support.
|
||||
|
||||
CPP_CLI_SUPPORT = NO
|
||||
|
||||
# Set the SIP_SUPPORT tag to YES if your project consists of sip sources only.
|
||||
# Doxygen will parse them like normal C++ but will assume all classes use public
|
||||
# instead of private inheritance when no explicit protection keyword is present.
|
||||
|
||||
SIP_SUPPORT = NO
|
||||
|
||||
# For Microsoft's IDL there are propget and propput attributes to indicate getter
|
||||
# and setter methods for a property. Setting this option to YES (the default)
|
||||
# will make doxygen to replace the get and set methods by a property in the
|
||||
# documentation. This will only work if the methods are indeed getting or
|
||||
# setting a simple type. If this is not the case, or you want to show the
|
||||
# methods anyway, you should set this option to NO.
|
||||
|
||||
IDL_PROPERTY_SUPPORT = YES
|
||||
|
||||
# If member grouping is used in the documentation and the DISTRIBUTE_GROUP_DOC
|
||||
# tag is set to YES, then doxygen will reuse the documentation of the first
|
||||
# member in the group (if any) for the other members of the group. By default
|
||||
# all members of a group must be documented explicitly.
|
||||
|
||||
DISTRIBUTE_GROUP_DOC = NO
|
||||
|
||||
# Set the SUBGROUPING tag to YES (the default) to allow class member groups of
|
||||
# the same type (for instance a group of public functions) to be put as a
|
||||
# subgroup of that type (e.g. under the Public Functions section). Set it to
|
||||
# NO to prevent subgrouping. Alternatively, this can be done per class using
|
||||
# the \nosubgrouping command.
|
||||
|
||||
SUBGROUPING = YES
|
||||
|
||||
# When TYPEDEF_HIDES_STRUCT is enabled, a typedef of a struct, union, or enum
|
||||
# is documented as struct, union, or enum with the name of the typedef. So
|
||||
# typedef struct TypeS {} TypeT, will appear in the documentation as a struct
|
||||
# with name TypeT. When disabled the typedef will appear as a member of a file,
|
||||
# namespace, or class. And the struct will be named TypeS. This can typically
|
||||
# be useful for C code in case the coding convention dictates that all compound
|
||||
# types are typedef'ed and only the typedef is referenced, never the tag name.
|
||||
|
||||
TYPEDEF_HIDES_STRUCT = NO
|
||||
|
||||
# The SYMBOL_CACHE_SIZE determines the size of the internal cache use to
|
||||
# determine which symbols to keep in memory and which to flush to disk.
|
||||
# When the cache is full, less often used symbols will be written to disk.
|
||||
# For small to medium size projects (<1000 input files) the default value is
|
||||
# probably good enough. For larger projects a too small cache size can cause
|
||||
# doxygen to be busy swapping symbols to and from disk most of the time
|
||||
# causing a significant performance penality.
|
||||
# If the system has enough physical memory increasing the cache will improve the
|
||||
# performance by keeping more symbols in memory. Note that the value works on
|
||||
# a logarithmic scale so increasing the size by one will rougly double the
|
||||
# memory usage. The cache size is given by this formula:
|
||||
# 2^(16+SYMBOL_CACHE_SIZE). The valid range is 0..9, the default is 0,
|
||||
# corresponding to a cache size of 2^16 = 65536 symbols
|
||||
|
||||
SYMBOL_CACHE_SIZE = 0
|
||||
|
||||
#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
|
||||
# Build related configuration options
|
||||
#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
|
||||
|
||||
# If the EXTRACT_ALL tag is set to YES doxygen will assume all entities in
|
||||
# documentation are documented, even if no documentation was available.
|
||||
# Private class members and static file members will be hidden unless
|
||||
# the EXTRACT_PRIVATE and EXTRACT_STATIC tags are set to YES
|
||||
|
||||
EXTRACT_ALL = YES
|
||||
|
||||
# If the EXTRACT_PRIVATE tag is set to YES all private members of a class
|
||||
# will be included in the documentation.
|
||||
|
||||
EXTRACT_PRIVATE = YES
|
||||
|
||||
# If the EXTRACT_STATIC tag is set to YES all static members of a file
|
||||
# will be included in the documentation.
|
||||
|
||||
EXTRACT_STATIC = YES
|
||||
|
||||
# If the EXTRACT_LOCAL_CLASSES tag is set to YES classes (and structs)
|
||||
# defined locally in source files will be included in the documentation.
|
||||
# If set to NO only classes defined in header files are included.
|
||||
|
||||
EXTRACT_LOCAL_CLASSES = YES
|
||||
|
||||
# This flag is only useful for Objective-C code. When set to YES local
|
||||
# methods, which are defined in the implementation section but not in
|
||||
# the interface are included in the documentation.
|
||||
# If set to NO (the default) only methods in the interface are included.
|
||||
|
||||
EXTRACT_LOCAL_METHODS = NO
|
||||
|
||||
# If this flag is set to YES, the members of anonymous namespaces will be
|
||||
# extracted and appear in the documentation as a namespace called
|
||||
# 'anonymous_namespace{file}', where file will be replaced with the base
|
||||
# name of the file that contains the anonymous namespace. By default
|
||||
# anonymous namespace are hidden.
|
||||
|
||||
EXTRACT_ANON_NSPACES = NO
|
||||
|
||||
# If the HIDE_UNDOC_MEMBERS tag is set to YES, Doxygen will hide all
|
||||
# undocumented members of documented classes, files or namespaces.
|
||||
# If set to NO (the default) these members will be included in the
|
||||
# various overviews, but no documentation section is generated.
|
||||
# This option has no effect if EXTRACT_ALL is enabled.
|
||||
|
||||
HIDE_UNDOC_MEMBERS = NO
|
||||
|
||||
# If the HIDE_UNDOC_CLASSES tag is set to YES, Doxygen will hide all
|
||||
# undocumented classes that are normally visible in the class hierarchy.
|
||||
# If set to NO (the default) these classes will be included in the various
|
||||
# overviews. This option has no effect if EXTRACT_ALL is enabled.
|
||||
|
||||
HIDE_UNDOC_CLASSES = NO
|
||||
|
||||
# If the HIDE_FRIEND_COMPOUNDS tag is set to YES, Doxygen will hide all
|
||||
# friend (class|struct|union) declarations.
|
||||
# If set to NO (the default) these declarations will be included in the
|
||||
# documentation.
|
||||
|
||||
HIDE_FRIEND_COMPOUNDS = NO
|
||||
|
||||
# If the HIDE_IN_BODY_DOCS tag is set to YES, Doxygen will hide any
|
||||
# documentation blocks found inside the body of a function.
|
||||
# If set to NO (the default) these blocks will be appended to the
|
||||
# function's detailed documentation block.
|
||||
|
||||
HIDE_IN_BODY_DOCS = NO
|
||||
|
||||
# The INTERNAL_DOCS tag determines if documentation
|
||||
# that is typed after a \internal command is included. If the tag is set
|
||||
# to NO (the default) then the documentation will be excluded.
|
||||
# Set it to YES to include the internal documentation.
|
||||
|
||||
INTERNAL_DOCS = NO
|
||||
|
||||
# If the CASE_SENSE_NAMES tag is set to NO then Doxygen will only generate
|
||||
# file names in lower-case letters. If set to YES upper-case letters are also
|
||||
# allowed. This is useful if you have classes or files whose names only differ
|
||||
# in case and if your file system supports case sensitive file names. Windows
|
||||
# and Mac users are advised to set this option to NO.
|
||||
|
||||
CASE_SENSE_NAMES = NO
|
||||
|
||||
# If the HIDE_SCOPE_NAMES tag is set to NO (the default) then Doxygen
|
||||
# will show members with their full class and namespace scopes in the
|
||||
# documentation. If set to YES the scope will be hidden.
|
||||
|
||||
HIDE_SCOPE_NAMES = NO
|
||||
|
||||
# If the SHOW_INCLUDE_FILES tag is set to YES (the default) then Doxygen
|
||||
# will put a list of the files that are included by a file in the documentation
|
||||
# of that file.
|
||||
|
||||
SHOW_INCLUDE_FILES = YES
|
||||
|
||||
# If the INLINE_INFO tag is set to YES (the default) then a tag [inline]
|
||||
# is inserted in the documentation for inline members.
|
||||
|
||||
INLINE_INFO = YES
|
||||
|
||||
# If the SORT_MEMBER_DOCS tag is set to YES (the default) then doxygen
|
||||
# will sort the (detailed) documentation of file and class members
|
||||
# alphabetically by member name. If set to NO the members will appear in
|
||||
# declaration order.
|
||||
|
||||
SORT_MEMBER_DOCS = YES
|
||||
|
||||
# If the SORT_BRIEF_DOCS tag is set to YES then doxygen will sort the
|
||||
# brief documentation of file, namespace and class members alphabetically
|
||||
# by member name. If set to NO (the default) the members will appear in
|
||||
# declaration order.
|
||||
|
||||
SORT_BRIEF_DOCS = NO
|
||||
|
||||
# If the SORT_GROUP_NAMES tag is set to YES then doxygen will sort the
|
||||
# hierarchy of group names into alphabetical order. If set to NO (the default)
|
||||
# the group names will appear in their defined order.
|
||||
|
||||
SORT_GROUP_NAMES = NO
|
||||
|
||||
# If the SORT_BY_SCOPE_NAME tag is set to YES, the class list will be
|
||||
# sorted by fully-qualified names, including namespaces. If set to
|
||||
# NO (the default), the class list will be sorted only by class name,
|
||||
# not including the namespace part.
|
||||
# Note: This option is not very useful if HIDE_SCOPE_NAMES is set to YES.
|
||||
# Note: This option applies only to the class list, not to the
|
||||
# alphabetical list.
|
||||
|
||||
SORT_BY_SCOPE_NAME = NO
|
||||
|
||||
# The GENERATE_TODOLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or
|
||||
# disable (NO) the todo list. This list is created by putting \todo
|
||||
# commands in the documentation.
|
||||
|
||||
GENERATE_TODOLIST = NO
|
||||
|
||||
# The GENERATE_TESTLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or
|
||||
# disable (NO) the test list. This list is created by putting \test
|
||||
# commands in the documentation.
|
||||
|
||||
GENERATE_TESTLIST = NO
|
||||
|
||||
# The GENERATE_BUGLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or
|
||||
# disable (NO) the bug list. This list is created by putting \bug
|
||||
# commands in the documentation.
|
||||
|
||||
GENERATE_BUGLIST = NO
|
||||
|
||||
# The GENERATE_DEPRECATEDLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or
|
||||
# disable (NO) the deprecated list. This list is created by putting
|
||||
# \deprecated commands in the documentation.
|
||||
|
||||
GENERATE_DEPRECATEDLIST= YES
|
||||
|
||||
# The ENABLED_SECTIONS tag can be used to enable conditional
|
||||
# documentation sections, marked by \if sectionname ... \endif.
|
||||
|
||||
ENABLED_SECTIONS =
|
||||
|
||||
# The MAX_INITIALIZER_LINES tag determines the maximum number of lines
|
||||
# the initial value of a variable or define consists of for it to appear in
|
||||
# the documentation. If the initializer consists of more lines than specified
|
||||
# here it will be hidden. Use a value of 0 to hide initializers completely.
|
||||
# The appearance of the initializer of individual variables and defines in the
|
||||
# documentation can be controlled using \showinitializer or \hideinitializer
|
||||
# command in the documentation regardless of this setting.
|
||||
|
||||
MAX_INITIALIZER_LINES = 30
|
||||
|
||||
# Set the SHOW_USED_FILES tag to NO to disable the list of files generated
|
||||
# at the bottom of the documentation of classes and structs. If set to YES the
|
||||
# list will mention the files that were used to generate the documentation.
|
||||
|
||||
SHOW_USED_FILES = YES
|
||||
|
||||
# If the sources in your project are distributed over multiple directories
|
||||
# then setting the SHOW_DIRECTORIES tag to YES will show the directory hierarchy
|
||||
# in the documentation. The default is NO.
|
||||
|
||||
SHOW_DIRECTORIES = YES
|
||||
|
||||
# Set the SHOW_FILES tag to NO to disable the generation of the Files page.
|
||||
# This will remove the Files entry from the Quick Index and from the
|
||||
# Folder Tree View (if specified). The default is YES.
|
||||
|
||||
SHOW_FILES = YES
|
||||
|
||||
# Set the SHOW_NAMESPACES tag to NO to disable the generation of the
|
||||
# Namespaces page. This will remove the Namespaces entry from the Quick Index
|
||||
# and from the Folder Tree View (if specified). The default is YES.
|
||||
|
||||
SHOW_NAMESPACES = YES
|
||||
|
||||
# The FILE_VERSION_FILTER tag can be used to specify a program or script that
|
||||
# doxygen should invoke to get the current version for each file (typically from
|
||||
# the version control system). Doxygen will invoke the program by executing (via
|
||||
# popen()) the command <command> <input-file>, where <command> is the value of
|
||||
# the FILE_VERSION_FILTER tag, and <input-file> is the name of an input file
|
||||
# provided by doxygen. Whatever the program writes to standard output
|
||||
# is used as the file version. See the manual for examples.
|
||||
|
||||
FILE_VERSION_FILTER =
|
||||
|
||||
# The LAYOUT_FILE tag can be used to specify a layout file which will be parsed by
|
||||
# doxygen. The layout file controls the global structure of the generated output files
|
||||
# in an output format independent way. The create the layout file that represents
|
||||
# doxygen's defaults, run doxygen with the -l option. You can optionally specify a
|
||||
# file name after the option, if omitted DoxygenLayout.xml will be used as the name
|
||||
# of the layout file.
|
||||
|
||||
LAYOUT_FILE =
|
||||
|
||||
#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
|
||||
# configuration options related to warning and progress messages
|
||||
#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
|
||||
|
||||
# The QUIET tag can be used to turn on/off the messages that are generated
|
||||
# by doxygen. Possible values are YES and NO. If left blank NO is used.
|
||||
|
||||
QUIET = YES
|
||||
|
||||
# The WARNINGS tag can be used to turn on/off the warning messages that are
|
||||
# generated by doxygen. Possible values are YES and NO. If left blank
|
||||
# NO is used.
|
||||
|
||||
WARNINGS = YES
|
||||
|
||||
# If WARN_IF_UNDOCUMENTED is set to YES, then doxygen will generate warnings
|
||||
# for undocumented members. If EXTRACT_ALL is set to YES then this flag will
|
||||
# automatically be disabled.
|
||||
|
||||
WARN_IF_UNDOCUMENTED = YES
|
||||
|
||||
# If WARN_IF_DOC_ERROR is set to YES, doxygen will generate warnings for
|
||||
# potential errors in the documentation, such as not documenting some
|
||||
# parameters in a documented function, or documenting parameters that
|
||||
# don't exist or using markup commands wrongly.
|
||||
|
||||
WARN_IF_DOC_ERROR = YES
|
||||
|
||||
# This WARN_NO_PARAMDOC option can be abled to get warnings for
|
||||
# functions that are documented, but have no documentation for their parameters
|
||||
# or return value. If set to NO (the default) doxygen will only warn about
|
||||
# wrong or incomplete parameter documentation, but not about the absence of
|
||||
# documentation.
|
||||
|
||||
WARN_NO_PARAMDOC = YES
|
||||
|
||||
# The WARN_FORMAT tag determines the format of the warning messages that
|
||||
# doxygen can produce. The string should contain the $file, $line, and $text
|
||||
# tags, which will be replaced by the file and line number from which the
|
||||
# warning originated and the warning text. Optionally the format may contain
|
||||
# $version, which will be replaced by the version of the file (if it could
|
||||
# be obtained via FILE_VERSION_FILTER)
|
||||
|
||||
WARN_FORMAT = "$file:$line: $text"
|
||||
|
||||
# The WARN_LOGFILE tag can be used to specify a file to which warning
|
||||
# and error messages should be written. If left blank the output is written
|
||||
# to stderr.
|
||||
|
||||
WARN_LOGFILE =
|
||||
|
||||
#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
|
||||
# configuration options related to the input files
|
||||
#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
|
||||
|
||||
# The INPUT tag can be used to specify the files and/or directories that contain
|
||||
# documented source files. You may enter file names like "myfile.cpp" or
|
||||
# directories like "/usr/src/myproject". Separate the files or directories
|
||||
# with spaces.
|
||||
|
||||
INPUT = ./
|
||||
|
||||
# This tag can be used to specify the character encoding of the source files
|
||||
# that doxygen parses. Internally doxygen uses the UTF-8 encoding, which is
|
||||
# also the default input encoding. Doxygen uses libiconv (or the iconv built
|
||||
# into libc) for the transcoding. See http://www.gnu.org/software/libiconv for
|
||||
# the list of possible encodings.
|
||||
|
||||
INPUT_ENCODING = UTF-8
|
||||
|
||||
# If the value of the INPUT tag contains directories, you can use the
|
||||
# FILE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard pattern (like *.cpp
|
||||
# and *.h) to filter out the source-files in the directories. If left
|
||||
# blank the following patterns are tested:
|
||||
# *.c *.cc *.cxx *.cpp *.c++ *.java *.ii *.ixx *.ipp *.i++ *.inl *.h *.hh *.hxx
|
||||
# *.hpp *.h++ *.idl *.odl *.cs *.php *.php3 *.inc *.m *.mm *.py *.f90
|
||||
|
||||
FILE_PATTERNS = *.h \
|
||||
*.c \
|
||||
*.txt
|
||||
|
||||
# The RECURSIVE tag can be used to turn specify whether or not subdirectories
|
||||
# should be searched for input files as well. Possible values are YES and NO.
|
||||
# If left blank NO is used.
|
||||
|
||||
RECURSIVE = YES
|
||||
|
||||
# The EXCLUDE tag can be used to specify files and/or directories that should
|
||||
# excluded from the INPUT source files. This way you can easily exclude a
|
||||
# subdirectory from a directory tree whose root is specified with the INPUT tag.
|
||||
|
||||
EXCLUDE =
|
||||
|
||||
# The EXCLUDE_SYMLINKS tag can be used select whether or not files or
|
||||
# directories that are symbolic links (a Unix filesystem feature) are excluded
|
||||
# from the input.
|
||||
|
||||
EXCLUDE_SYMLINKS = NO
|
||||
|
||||
# If the value of the INPUT tag contains directories, you can use the
|
||||
# EXCLUDE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard patterns to exclude
|
||||
# certain files from those directories. Note that the wildcards are matched
|
||||
# against the file with absolute path, so to exclude all test directories
|
||||
# for example use the pattern */test/*
|
||||
|
||||
EXCLUDE_PATTERNS = */LowLevel/USBMode.h
|
||||
|
||||
# The EXCLUDE_SYMBOLS tag can be used to specify one or more symbol names
|
||||
# (namespaces, classes, functions, etc.) that should be excluded from the
|
||||
# output. The symbol name can be a fully qualified name, a word, or if the
|
||||
# wildcard * is used, a substring. Examples: ANamespace, AClass,
|
||||
# AClass::ANamespace, ANamespace::*Test
|
||||
|
||||
EXCLUDE_SYMBOLS = __*
|
||||
|
||||
# The EXAMPLE_PATH tag can be used to specify one or more files or
|
||||
# directories that contain example code fragments that are included (see
|
||||
# the \include command).
|
||||
|
||||
EXAMPLE_PATH =
|
||||
|
||||
# If the value of the EXAMPLE_PATH tag contains directories, you can use the
|
||||
# EXAMPLE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard pattern (like *.cpp
|
||||
# and *.h) to filter out the source-files in the directories. If left
|
||||
# blank all files are included.
|
||||
|
||||
EXAMPLE_PATTERNS = *
|
||||
|
||||
# If the EXAMPLE_RECURSIVE tag is set to YES then subdirectories will be
|
||||
# searched for input files to be used with the \include or \dontinclude
|
||||
# commands irrespective of the value of the RECURSIVE tag.
|
||||
# Possible values are YES and NO. If left blank NO is used.
|
||||
|
||||
EXAMPLE_RECURSIVE = NO
|
||||
|
||||
# The IMAGE_PATH tag can be used to specify one or more files or
|
||||
# directories that contain image that are included in the documentation (see
|
||||
# the \image command).
|
||||
|
||||
IMAGE_PATH =
|
||||
|
||||
# The INPUT_FILTER tag can be used to specify a program that doxygen should
|
||||
# invoke to filter for each input file. Doxygen will invoke the filter program
|
||||
# by executing (via popen()) the command <filter> <input-file>, where <filter>
|
||||
# is the value of the INPUT_FILTER tag, and <input-file> is the name of an
|
||||
# input file. Doxygen will then use the output that the filter program writes
|
||||
# to standard output. If FILTER_PATTERNS is specified, this tag will be
|
||||
# ignored.
|
||||
|
||||
INPUT_FILTER =
|
||||
|
||||
# The FILTER_PATTERNS tag can be used to specify filters on a per file pattern
|
||||
# basis. Doxygen will compare the file name with each pattern and apply the
|
||||
# filter if there is a match. The filters are a list of the form:
|
||||
# pattern=filter (like *.cpp=my_cpp_filter). See INPUT_FILTER for further
|
||||
# info on how filters are used. If FILTER_PATTERNS is empty, INPUT_FILTER
|
||||
# is applied to all files.
|
||||
|
||||
FILTER_PATTERNS =
|
||||
|
||||
# If the FILTER_SOURCE_FILES tag is set to YES, the input filter (if set using
|
||||
# INPUT_FILTER) will be used to filter the input files when producing source
|
||||
# files to browse (i.e. when SOURCE_BROWSER is set to YES).
|
||||
|
||||
FILTER_SOURCE_FILES = NO
|
||||
|
||||
#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
|
||||
# configuration options related to source browsing
|
||||
#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
|
||||
|
||||
# If the SOURCE_BROWSER tag is set to YES then a list of source files will
|
||||
# be generated. Documented entities will be cross-referenced with these sources.
|
||||
# Note: To get rid of all source code in the generated output, make sure also
|
||||
# VERBATIM_HEADERS is set to NO.
|
||||
|
||||
SOURCE_BROWSER = NO
|
||||
|
||||
# Setting the INLINE_SOURCES tag to YES will include the body
|
||||
# of functions and classes directly in the documentation.
|
||||
|
||||
INLINE_SOURCES = NO
|
||||
|
||||
# Setting the STRIP_CODE_COMMENTS tag to YES (the default) will instruct
|
||||
# doxygen to hide any special comment blocks from generated source code
|
||||
# fragments. Normal C and C++ comments will always remain visible.
|
||||
|
||||
STRIP_CODE_COMMENTS = YES
|
||||
|
||||
# If the REFERENCED_BY_RELATION tag is set to YES
|
||||
# then for each documented function all documented
|
||||
# functions referencing it will be listed.
|
||||
|
||||
REFERENCED_BY_RELATION = NO
|
||||
|
||||
# If the REFERENCES_RELATION tag is set to YES
|
||||
# then for each documented function all documented entities
|
||||
# called/used by that function will be listed.
|
||||
|
||||
REFERENCES_RELATION = NO
|
||||
|
||||
# If the REFERENCES_LINK_SOURCE tag is set to YES (the default)
|
||||
# and SOURCE_BROWSER tag is set to YES, then the hyperlinks from
|
||||
# functions in REFERENCES_RELATION and REFERENCED_BY_RELATION lists will
|
||||
# link to the source code. Otherwise they will link to the documentstion.
|
||||
|
||||
REFERENCES_LINK_SOURCE = NO
|
||||
|
||||
# If the USE_HTAGS tag is set to YES then the references to source code
|
||||
# will point to the HTML generated by the htags(1) tool instead of doxygen
|
||||
# built-in source browser. The htags tool is part of GNU's global source
|
||||
# tagging system (see http://www.gnu.org/software/global/global.html). You
|
||||
# will need version 4.8.6 or higher.
|
||||
|
||||
USE_HTAGS = NO
|
||||
|
||||
# If the VERBATIM_HEADERS tag is set to YES (the default) then Doxygen
|
||||
# will generate a verbatim copy of the header file for each class for
|
||||
# which an include is specified. Set to NO to disable this.
|
||||
|
||||
VERBATIM_HEADERS = NO
|
||||
|
||||
#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
|
||||
# configuration options related to the alphabetical class index
|
||||
#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
|
||||
|
||||
# If the ALPHABETICAL_INDEX tag is set to YES, an alphabetical index
|
||||
# of all compounds will be generated. Enable this if the project
|
||||
# contains a lot of classes, structs, unions or interfaces.
|
||||
|
||||
ALPHABETICAL_INDEX = YES
|
||||
|
||||
# If the alphabetical index is enabled (see ALPHABETICAL_INDEX) then
|
||||
# the COLS_IN_ALPHA_INDEX tag can be used to specify the number of columns
|
||||
# in which this list will be split (can be a number in the range [1..20])
|
||||
|
||||
COLS_IN_ALPHA_INDEX = 5
|
||||
|
||||
# In case all classes in a project start with a common prefix, all
|
||||
# classes will be put under the same header in the alphabetical index.
|
||||
# The IGNORE_PREFIX tag can be used to specify one or more prefixes that
|
||||
# should be ignored while generating the index headers.
|
||||
|
||||
IGNORE_PREFIX =
|
||||
|
||||
#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
|
||||
# configuration options related to the HTML output
|
||||
#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
|
||||
|
||||
# If the GENERATE_HTML tag is set to YES (the default) Doxygen will
|
||||
# generate HTML output.
|
||||
|
||||
GENERATE_HTML = YES
|
||||
|
||||
# The HTML_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the HTML docs will be put.
|
||||
# If a relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be
|
||||
# put in front of it. If left blank `html' will be used as the default path.
|
||||
|
||||
HTML_OUTPUT = html
|
||||
|
||||
# The HTML_FILE_EXTENSION tag can be used to specify the file extension for
|
||||
# each generated HTML page (for example: .htm,.php,.asp). If it is left blank
|
||||
# doxygen will generate files with .html extension.
|
||||
|
||||
HTML_FILE_EXTENSION = .html
|
||||
|
||||
# The HTML_HEADER tag can be used to specify a personal HTML header for
|
||||
# each generated HTML page. If it is left blank doxygen will generate a
|
||||
# standard header.
|
||||
|
||||
HTML_HEADER =
|
||||
|
||||
# The HTML_FOOTER tag can be used to specify a personal HTML footer for
|
||||
# each generated HTML page. If it is left blank doxygen will generate a
|
||||
# standard footer.
|
||||
|
||||
HTML_FOOTER =
|
||||
|
||||
# The HTML_STYLESHEET tag can be used to specify a user-defined cascading
|
||||
# style sheet that is used by each HTML page. It can be used to
|
||||
# fine-tune the look of the HTML output. If the tag is left blank doxygen
|
||||
# will generate a default style sheet. Note that doxygen will try to copy
|
||||
# the style sheet file to the HTML output directory, so don't put your own
|
||||
# stylesheet in the HTML output directory as well, or it will be erased!
|
||||
|
||||
HTML_STYLESHEET =
|
||||
|
||||
# If the HTML_ALIGN_MEMBERS tag is set to YES, the members of classes,
|
||||
# files or namespaces will be aligned in HTML using tables. If set to
|
||||
# NO a bullet list will be used.
|
||||
|
||||
HTML_ALIGN_MEMBERS = YES
|
||||
|
||||
# If the HTML_DYNAMIC_SECTIONS tag is set to YES then the generated HTML
|
||||
# documentation will contain sections that can be hidden and shown after the
|
||||
# page has loaded. For this to work a browser that supports
|
||||
# JavaScript and DHTML is required (for instance Mozilla 1.0+, Firefox
|
||||
# Netscape 6.0+, Internet explorer 5.0+, Konqueror, or Safari).
|
||||
|
||||
HTML_DYNAMIC_SECTIONS = YES
|
||||
|
||||
# If the GENERATE_DOCSET tag is set to YES, additional index files
|
||||
# will be generated that can be used as input for Apple's Xcode 3
|
||||
# integrated development environment, introduced with OSX 10.5 (Leopard).
|
||||
# To create a documentation set, doxygen will generate a Makefile in the
|
||||
# HTML output directory. Running make will produce the docset in that
|
||||
# directory and running "make install" will install the docset in
|
||||
# ~/Library/Developer/Shared/Documentation/DocSets so that Xcode will find
|
||||
# it at startup.
|
||||
# See http://developer.apple.com/tools/creatingdocsetswithdoxygen.html for more information.
|
||||
|
||||
GENERATE_DOCSET = NO
|
||||
|
||||
# When GENERATE_DOCSET tag is set to YES, this tag determines the name of the
|
||||
# feed. A documentation feed provides an umbrella under which multiple
|
||||
# documentation sets from a single provider (such as a company or product suite)
|
||||
# can be grouped.
|
||||
|
||||
DOCSET_FEEDNAME = "Doxygen generated docs"
|
||||
|
||||
# When GENERATE_DOCSET tag is set to YES, this tag specifies a string that
|
||||
# should uniquely identify the documentation set bundle. This should be a
|
||||
# reverse domain-name style string, e.g. com.mycompany.MyDocSet. Doxygen
|
||||
# will append .docset to the name.
|
||||
|
||||
DOCSET_BUNDLE_ID = org.doxygen.Project
|
||||
|
||||
# If the GENERATE_HTMLHELP tag is set to YES, additional index files
|
||||
# will be generated that can be used as input for tools like the
|
||||
# Microsoft HTML help workshop to generate a compiled HTML help file (.chm)
|
||||
# of the generated HTML documentation.
|
||||
|
||||
GENERATE_HTMLHELP = NO
|
||||
|
||||
# If the GENERATE_HTMLHELP tag is set to YES, the CHM_FILE tag can
|
||||
# be used to specify the file name of the resulting .chm file. You
|
||||
# can add a path in front of the file if the result should not be
|
||||
# written to the html output directory.
|
||||
|
||||
CHM_FILE =
|
||||
|
||||
# If the GENERATE_HTMLHELP tag is set to YES, the HHC_LOCATION tag can
|
||||
# be used to specify the location (absolute path including file name) of
|
||||
# the HTML help compiler (hhc.exe). If non-empty doxygen will try to run
|
||||
# the HTML help compiler on the generated index.hhp.
|
||||
|
||||
HHC_LOCATION =
|
||||
|
||||
# If the GENERATE_HTMLHELP tag is set to YES, the GENERATE_CHI flag
|
||||
# controls if a separate .chi index file is generated (YES) or that
|
||||
# it should be included in the master .chm file (NO).
|
||||
|
||||
GENERATE_CHI = NO
|
||||
|
||||
# If the GENERATE_HTMLHELP tag is set to YES, the CHM_INDEX_ENCODING
|
||||
# is used to encode HtmlHelp index (hhk), content (hhc) and project file
|
||||
# content.
|
||||
|
||||
CHM_INDEX_ENCODING =
|
||||
|
||||
# If the GENERATE_HTMLHELP tag is set to YES, the BINARY_TOC flag
|
||||
# controls whether a binary table of contents is generated (YES) or a
|
||||
# normal table of contents (NO) in the .chm file.
|
||||
|
||||
BINARY_TOC = NO
|
||||
|
||||
# The TOC_EXPAND flag can be set to YES to add extra items for group members
|
||||
# to the contents of the HTML help documentation and to the tree view.
|
||||
|
||||
TOC_EXPAND = YES
|
||||
|
||||
# If the GENERATE_QHP tag is set to YES and both QHP_NAMESPACE and QHP_VIRTUAL_FOLDER
|
||||
# are set, an additional index file will be generated that can be used as input for
|
||||
# Qt's qhelpgenerator to generate a Qt Compressed Help (.qch) of the generated
|
||||
# HTML documentation.
|
||||
|
||||
GENERATE_QHP = NO
|
||||
|
||||
# If the QHG_LOCATION tag is specified, the QCH_FILE tag can
|
||||
# be used to specify the file name of the resulting .qch file.
|
||||
# The path specified is relative to the HTML output folder.
|
||||
|
||||
QCH_FILE =
|
||||
|
||||
# The QHP_NAMESPACE tag specifies the namespace to use when generating
|
||||
# Qt Help Project output. For more information please see
|
||||
# <a href="http://doc.trolltech.com/qthelpproject.html#namespace">Qt Help Project / Namespace</a>.
|
||||
|
||||
QHP_NAMESPACE = org.doxygen.Project
|
||||
|
||||
# The QHP_VIRTUAL_FOLDER tag specifies the namespace to use when generating
|
||||
# Qt Help Project output. For more information please see
|
||||
# <a href="http://doc.trolltech.com/qthelpproject.html#virtual-folders">Qt Help Project / Virtual Folders</a>.
|
||||
|
||||
QHP_VIRTUAL_FOLDER = doc
|
||||
|
||||
# If the GENERATE_QHP tag is set to YES, the QHG_LOCATION tag can
|
||||
# be used to specify the location of Qt's qhelpgenerator.
|
||||
# If non-empty doxygen will try to run qhelpgenerator on the generated
|
||||
# .qhp file .
|
||||
|
||||
QHG_LOCATION =
|
||||
|
||||
# The DISABLE_INDEX tag can be used to turn on/off the condensed index at
|
||||
# top of each HTML page. The value NO (the default) enables the index and
|
||||
# the value YES disables it.
|
||||
|
||||
DISABLE_INDEX = NO
|
||||
|
||||
# This tag can be used to set the number of enum values (range [1..20])
|
||||
# that doxygen will group on one line in the generated HTML documentation.
|
||||
|
||||
ENUM_VALUES_PER_LINE = 1
|
||||
|
||||
# The GENERATE_TREEVIEW tag is used to specify whether a tree-like index
|
||||
# structure should be generated to display hierarchical information.
|
||||
# If the tag value is set to FRAME, a side panel will be generated
|
||||
# containing a tree-like index structure (just like the one that
|
||||
# is generated for HTML Help). For this to work a browser that supports
|
||||
# JavaScript, DHTML, CSS and frames is required (for instance Mozilla 1.0+,
|
||||
# Netscape 6.0+, Internet explorer 5.0+, or Konqueror). Windows users are
|
||||
# probably better off using the HTML help feature. Other possible values
|
||||
# for this tag are: HIERARCHIES, which will generate the Groups, Directories,
|
||||
# and Class Hierarchy pages using a tree view instead of an ordered list;
|
||||
# ALL, which combines the behavior of FRAME and HIERARCHIES; and NONE, which
|
||||
# disables this behavior completely. For backwards compatibility with previous
|
||||
# releases of Doxygen, the values YES and NO are equivalent to FRAME and NONE
|
||||
# respectively.
|
||||
|
||||
GENERATE_TREEVIEW = YES
|
||||
|
||||
# If the treeview is enabled (see GENERATE_TREEVIEW) then this tag can be
|
||||
# used to set the initial width (in pixels) of the frame in which the tree
|
||||
# is shown.
|
||||
|
||||
TREEVIEW_WIDTH = 250
|
||||
|
||||
# Use this tag to change the font size of Latex formulas included
|
||||
# as images in the HTML documentation. The default is 10. Note that
|
||||
# when you change the font size after a successful doxygen run you need
|
||||
# to manually remove any form_*.png images from the HTML output directory
|
||||
# to force them to be regenerated.
|
||||
|
||||
FORMULA_FONTSIZE = 10
|
||||
|
||||
#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
|
||||
# configuration options related to the LaTeX output
|
||||
#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
|
||||
|
||||
# If the GENERATE_LATEX tag is set to YES (the default) Doxygen will
|
||||
# generate Latex output.
|
||||
|
||||
GENERATE_LATEX = NO
|
||||
|
||||
# The LATEX_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the LaTeX docs will be put.
|
||||
# If a relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be
|
||||
# put in front of it. If left blank `latex' will be used as the default path.
|
||||
|
||||
LATEX_OUTPUT = latex
|
||||
|
||||
# The LATEX_CMD_NAME tag can be used to specify the LaTeX command name to be
|
||||
# invoked. If left blank `latex' will be used as the default command name.
|
||||
|
||||
LATEX_CMD_NAME = latex
|
||||
|
||||
# The MAKEINDEX_CMD_NAME tag can be used to specify the command name to
|
||||
# generate index for LaTeX. If left blank `makeindex' will be used as the
|
||||
# default command name.
|
||||
|
||||
MAKEINDEX_CMD_NAME = makeindex
|
||||
|
||||
# If the COMPACT_LATEX tag is set to YES Doxygen generates more compact
|
||||
# LaTeX documents. This may be useful for small projects and may help to
|
||||
# save some trees in general.
|
||||
|
||||
COMPACT_LATEX = NO
|
||||
|
||||
# The PAPER_TYPE tag can be used to set the paper type that is used
|
||||
# by the printer. Possible values are: a4, a4wide, letter, legal and
|
||||
# executive. If left blank a4wide will be used.
|
||||
|
||||
PAPER_TYPE = a4wide
|
||||
|
||||
# The EXTRA_PACKAGES tag can be to specify one or more names of LaTeX
|
||||
# packages that should be included in the LaTeX output.
|
||||
|
||||
EXTRA_PACKAGES =
|
||||
|
||||
# The LATEX_HEADER tag can be used to specify a personal LaTeX header for
|
||||
# the generated latex document. The header should contain everything until
|
||||
# the first chapter. If it is left blank doxygen will generate a
|
||||
# standard header. Notice: only use this tag if you know what you are doing!
|
||||
|
||||
LATEX_HEADER =
|
||||
|
||||
# If the PDF_HYPERLINKS tag is set to YES, the LaTeX that is generated
|
||||
# is prepared for conversion to pdf (using ps2pdf). The pdf file will
|
||||
# contain links (just like the HTML output) instead of page references
|
||||
# This makes the output suitable for online browsing using a pdf viewer.
|
||||
|
||||
PDF_HYPERLINKS = YES
|
||||
|
||||
# If the USE_PDFLATEX tag is set to YES, pdflatex will be used instead of
|
||||
# plain latex in the generated Makefile. Set this option to YES to get a
|
||||
# higher quality PDF documentation.
|
||||
|
||||
USE_PDFLATEX = YES
|
||||
|
||||
# If the LATEX_BATCHMODE tag is set to YES, doxygen will add the \\batchmode.
|
||||
# command to the generated LaTeX files. This will instruct LaTeX to keep
|
||||
# running if errors occur, instead of asking the user for help.
|
||||
# This option is also used when generating formulas in HTML.
|
||||
|
||||
LATEX_BATCHMODE = NO
|
||||
|
||||
# If LATEX_HIDE_INDICES is set to YES then doxygen will not
|
||||
# include the index chapters (such as File Index, Compound Index, etc.)
|
||||
# in the output.
|
||||
|
||||
LATEX_HIDE_INDICES = NO
|
||||
|
||||
#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
|
||||
# configuration options related to the RTF output
|
||||
#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
|
||||
|
||||
# If the GENERATE_RTF tag is set to YES Doxygen will generate RTF output
|
||||
# The RTF output is optimized for Word 97 and may not look very pretty with
|
||||
# other RTF readers or editors.
|
||||
|
||||
GENERATE_RTF = NO
|
||||
|
||||
# The RTF_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the RTF docs will be put.
|
||||
# If a relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be
|
||||
# put in front of it. If left blank `rtf' will be used as the default path.
|
||||
|
||||
RTF_OUTPUT = rtf
|
||||
|
||||
# If the COMPACT_RTF tag is set to YES Doxygen generates more compact
|
||||
# RTF documents. This may be useful for small projects and may help to
|
||||
# save some trees in general.
|
||||
|
||||
COMPACT_RTF = NO
|
||||
|
||||
# If the RTF_HYPERLINKS tag is set to YES, the RTF that is generated
|
||||
# will contain hyperlink fields. The RTF file will
|
||||
# contain links (just like the HTML output) instead of page references.
|
||||
# This makes the output suitable for online browsing using WORD or other
|
||||
# programs which support those fields.
|
||||
# Note: wordpad (write) and others do not support links.
|
||||
|
||||
RTF_HYPERLINKS = NO
|
||||
|
||||
# Load stylesheet definitions from file. Syntax is similar to doxygen's
|
||||
# config file, i.e. a series of assignments. You only have to provide
|
||||
# replacements, missing definitions are set to their default value.
|
||||
|
||||
RTF_STYLESHEET_FILE =
|
||||
|
||||
# Set optional variables used in the generation of an rtf document.
|
||||
# Syntax is similar to doxygen's config file.
|
||||
|
||||
RTF_EXTENSIONS_FILE =
|
||||
|
||||
#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
|
||||
# configuration options related to the man page output
|
||||
#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
|
||||
|
||||
# If the GENERATE_MAN tag is set to YES (the default) Doxygen will
|
||||
# generate man pages
|
||||
|
||||
GENERATE_MAN = NO
|
||||
|
||||
# The MAN_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the man pages will be put.
|
||||
# If a relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be
|
||||
# put in front of it. If left blank `man' will be used as the default path.
|
||||
|
||||
MAN_OUTPUT = man
|
||||
|
||||
# The MAN_EXTENSION tag determines the extension that is added to
|
||||
# the generated man pages (default is the subroutine's section .3)
|
||||
|
||||
MAN_EXTENSION = .3
|
||||
|
||||
# If the MAN_LINKS tag is set to YES and Doxygen generates man output,
|
||||
# then it will generate one additional man file for each entity
|
||||
# documented in the real man page(s). These additional files
|
||||
# only source the real man page, but without them the man command
|
||||
# would be unable to find the correct page. The default is NO.
|
||||
|
||||
MAN_LINKS = NO
|
||||
|
||||
#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
|
||||
# configuration options related to the XML output
|
||||
#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
|
||||
|
||||
# If the GENERATE_XML tag is set to YES Doxygen will
|
||||
# generate an XML file that captures the structure of
|
||||
# the code including all documentation.
|
||||
|
||||
GENERATE_XML = NO
|
||||
|
||||
# The XML_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the XML pages will be put.
|
||||
# If a relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be
|
||||
# put in front of it. If left blank `xml' will be used as the default path.
|
||||
|
||||
XML_OUTPUT = xml
|
||||
|
||||
# The XML_SCHEMA tag can be used to specify an XML schema,
|
||||
# which can be used by a validating XML parser to check the
|
||||
# syntax of the XML files.
|
||||
|
||||
XML_SCHEMA =
|
||||
|
||||
# The XML_DTD tag can be used to specify an XML DTD,
|
||||
# which can be used by a validating XML parser to check the
|
||||
# syntax of the XML files.
|
||||
|
||||
XML_DTD =
|
||||
|
||||
# If the XML_PROGRAMLISTING tag is set to YES Doxygen will
|
||||
# dump the program listings (including syntax highlighting
|
||||
# and cross-referencing information) to the XML output. Note that
|
||||
# enabling this will significantly increase the size of the XML output.
|
||||
|
||||
XML_PROGRAMLISTING = YES
|
||||
|
||||
#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
|
||||
# configuration options for the AutoGen Definitions output
|
||||
#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
|
||||
|
||||
# If the GENERATE_AUTOGEN_DEF tag is set to YES Doxygen will
|
||||
# generate an AutoGen Definitions (see autogen.sf.net) file
|
||||
# that captures the structure of the code including all
|
||||
# documentation. Note that this feature is still experimental
|
||||
# and incomplete at the moment.
|
||||
|
||||
GENERATE_AUTOGEN_DEF = NO
|
||||
|
||||
#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
|
||||
# configuration options related to the Perl module output
|
||||
#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
|
||||
|
||||
# If the GENERATE_PERLMOD tag is set to YES Doxygen will
|
||||
# generate a Perl module file that captures the structure of
|
||||
# the code including all documentation. Note that this
|
||||
# feature is still experimental and incomplete at the
|
||||
# moment.
|
||||
|
||||
GENERATE_PERLMOD = NO
|
||||
|
||||
# If the PERLMOD_LATEX tag is set to YES Doxygen will generate
|
||||
# the necessary Makefile rules, Perl scripts and LaTeX code to be able
|
||||
# to generate PDF and DVI output from the Perl module output.
|
||||
|
||||
PERLMOD_LATEX = NO
|
||||
|
||||
# If the PERLMOD_PRETTY tag is set to YES the Perl module output will be
|
||||
# nicely formatted so it can be parsed by a human reader. This is useful
|
||||
# if you want to understand what is going on. On the other hand, if this
|
||||
# tag is set to NO the size of the Perl module output will be much smaller
|
||||
# and Perl will parse it just the same.
|
||||
|
||||
PERLMOD_PRETTY = YES
|
||||
|
||||
# The names of the make variables in the generated doxyrules.make file
|
||||
# are prefixed with the string contained in PERLMOD_MAKEVAR_PREFIX.
|
||||
# This is useful so different doxyrules.make files included by the same
|
||||
# Makefile don't overwrite each other's variables.
|
||||
|
||||
PERLMOD_MAKEVAR_PREFIX =
|
||||
|
||||
#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
|
||||
# Configuration options related to the preprocessor
|
||||
#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
|
||||
|
||||
# If the ENABLE_PREPROCESSING tag is set to YES (the default) Doxygen will
|
||||
# evaluate all C-preprocessor directives found in the sources and include
|
||||
# files.
|
||||
|
||||
ENABLE_PREPROCESSING = YES
|
||||
|
||||
# If the MACRO_EXPANSION tag is set to YES Doxygen will expand all macro
|
||||
# names in the source code. If set to NO (the default) only conditional
|
||||
# compilation will be performed. Macro expansion can be done in a controlled
|
||||
# way by setting EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF to YES.
|
||||
|
||||
MACRO_EXPANSION = YES
|
||||
|
||||
# If the EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF and MACRO_EXPANSION tags are both set to YES
|
||||
# then the macro expansion is limited to the macros specified with the
|
||||
# PREDEFINED and EXPAND_AS_DEFINED tags.
|
||||
|
||||
EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF = YES
|
||||
|
||||
# If the SEARCH_INCLUDES tag is set to YES (the default) the includes files
|
||||
# in the INCLUDE_PATH (see below) will be search if a #include is found.
|
||||
|
||||
SEARCH_INCLUDES = YES
|
||||
|
||||
# The INCLUDE_PATH tag can be used to specify one or more directories that
|
||||
# contain include files that are not input files but should be processed by
|
||||
# the preprocessor.
|
||||
|
||||
INCLUDE_PATH =
|
||||
|
||||
# You can use the INCLUDE_FILE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard
|
||||
# patterns (like *.h and *.hpp) to filter out the header-files in the
|
||||
# directories. If left blank, the patterns specified with FILE_PATTERNS will
|
||||
# be used.
|
||||
|
||||
INCLUDE_FILE_PATTERNS =
|
||||
|
||||
# The PREDEFINED tag can be used to specify one or more macro names that
|
||||
# are defined before the preprocessor is started (similar to the -D option of
|
||||
# gcc). The argument of the tag is a list of macros of the form: name
|
||||
# or name=definition (no spaces). If the definition and the = are
|
||||
# omitted =1 is assumed. To prevent a macro definition from being
|
||||
# undefined via #undef or recursively expanded use the := operator
|
||||
# instead of the = operator.
|
||||
|
||||
PREDEFINED = __DOXYGEN__
|
||||
|
||||
# If the MACRO_EXPANSION and EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF tags are set to YES then
|
||||
# this tag can be used to specify a list of macro names that should be expanded.
|
||||
# The macro definition that is found in the sources will be used.
|
||||
# Use the PREDEFINED tag if you want to use a different macro definition.
|
||||
|
||||
EXPAND_AS_DEFINED = BUTTLOADTAG
|
||||
|
||||
# If the SKIP_FUNCTION_MACROS tag is set to YES (the default) then
|
||||
# doxygen's preprocessor will remove all function-like macros that are alone
|
||||
# on a line, have an all uppercase name, and do not end with a semicolon. Such
|
||||
# function macros are typically used for boiler-plate code, and will confuse
|
||||
# the parser if not removed.
|
||||
|
||||
SKIP_FUNCTION_MACROS = YES
|
||||
|
||||
#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
|
||||
# Configuration::additions related to external references
|
||||
#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
|
||||
|
||||
# The TAGFILES option can be used to specify one or more tagfiles.
|
||||
# Optionally an initial location of the external documentation
|
||||
# can be added for each tagfile. The format of a tag file without
|
||||
# this location is as follows:
|
||||
# TAGFILES = file1 file2 ...
|
||||
# Adding location for the tag files is done as follows:
|
||||
# TAGFILES = file1=loc1 "file2 = loc2" ...
|
||||
# where "loc1" and "loc2" can be relative or absolute paths or
|
||||
# URLs. If a location is present for each tag, the installdox tool
|
||||
# does not have to be run to correct the links.
|
||||
# Note that each tag file must have a unique name
|
||||
# (where the name does NOT include the path)
|
||||
# If a tag file is not located in the directory in which doxygen
|
||||
# is run, you must also specify the path to the tagfile here.
|
||||
|
||||
TAGFILES =
|
||||
|
||||
# When a file name is specified after GENERATE_TAGFILE, doxygen will create
|
||||
# a tag file that is based on the input files it reads.
|
||||
|
||||
GENERATE_TAGFILE =
|
||||
|
||||
# If the ALLEXTERNALS tag is set to YES all external classes will be listed
|
||||
# in the class index. If set to NO only the inherited external classes
|
||||
# will be listed.
|
||||
|
||||
ALLEXTERNALS = NO
|
||||
|
||||
# If the EXTERNAL_GROUPS tag is set to YES all external groups will be listed
|
||||
# in the modules index. If set to NO, only the current project's groups will
|
||||
# be listed.
|
||||
|
||||
EXTERNAL_GROUPS = YES
|
||||
|
||||
# The PERL_PATH should be the absolute path and name of the perl script
|
||||
# interpreter (i.e. the result of `which perl').
|
||||
|
||||
PERL_PATH = /usr/bin/perl
|
||||
|
||||
#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
|
||||
# Configuration options related to the dot tool
|
||||
#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
|
||||
|
||||
# If the CLASS_DIAGRAMS tag is set to YES (the default) Doxygen will
|
||||
# generate a inheritance diagram (in HTML, RTF and LaTeX) for classes with base
|
||||
# or super classes. Setting the tag to NO turns the diagrams off. Note that
|
||||
# this option is superseded by the HAVE_DOT option below. This is only a
|
||||
# fallback. It is recommended to install and use dot, since it yields more
|
||||
# powerful graphs.
|
||||
|
||||
CLASS_DIAGRAMS = NO
|
||||
|
||||
# You can define message sequence charts within doxygen comments using the \msc
|
||||
# command. Doxygen will then run the mscgen tool (see
|
||||
# http://www.mcternan.me.uk/mscgen/) to produce the chart and insert it in the
|
||||
# documentation. The MSCGEN_PATH tag allows you to specify the directory where
|
||||
# the mscgen tool resides. If left empty the tool is assumed to be found in the
|
||||
# default search path.
|
||||
|
||||
MSCGEN_PATH =
|
||||
|
||||
# If set to YES, the inheritance and collaboration graphs will hide
|
||||
# inheritance and usage relations if the target is undocumented
|
||||
# or is not a class.
|
||||
|
||||
HIDE_UNDOC_RELATIONS = YES
|
||||
|
||||
# If you set the HAVE_DOT tag to YES then doxygen will assume the dot tool is
|
||||
# available from the path. This tool is part of Graphviz, a graph visualization
|
||||
# toolkit from AT&T and Lucent Bell Labs. The other options in this section
|
||||
# have no effect if this option is set to NO (the default)
|
||||
|
||||
HAVE_DOT = NO
|
||||
|
||||
# By default doxygen will write a font called FreeSans.ttf to the output
|
||||
# directory and reference it in all dot files that doxygen generates. This
|
||||
# font does not include all possible unicode characters however, so when you need
|
||||
# these (or just want a differently looking font) you can specify the font name
|
||||
# using DOT_FONTNAME. You need need to make sure dot is able to find the font,
|
||||
# which can be done by putting it in a standard location or by setting the
|
||||
# DOTFONTPATH environment variable or by setting DOT_FONTPATH to the directory
|
||||
# containing the font.
|
||||
|
||||
DOT_FONTNAME = FreeSans
|
||||
|
||||
# The DOT_FONTSIZE tag can be used to set the size of the font of dot graphs.
|
||||
# The default size is 10pt.
|
||||
|
||||
DOT_FONTSIZE = 10
|
||||
|
||||
# By default doxygen will tell dot to use the output directory to look for the
|
||||
# FreeSans.ttf font (which doxygen will put there itself). If you specify a
|
||||
# different font using DOT_FONTNAME you can set the path where dot
|
||||
# can find it using this tag.
|
||||
|
||||
DOT_FONTPATH =
|
||||
|
||||
# If the CLASS_GRAPH and HAVE_DOT tags are set to YES then doxygen
|
||||
# will generate a graph for each documented class showing the direct and
|
||||
# indirect inheritance relations. Setting this tag to YES will force the
|
||||
# the CLASS_DIAGRAMS tag to NO.
|
||||
|
||||
CLASS_GRAPH = NO
|
||||
|
||||
# If the COLLABORATION_GRAPH and HAVE_DOT tags are set to YES then doxygen
|
||||
# will generate a graph for each documented class showing the direct and
|
||||
# indirect implementation dependencies (inheritance, containment, and
|
||||
# class references variables) of the class with other documented classes.
|
||||
|
||||
COLLABORATION_GRAPH = NO
|
||||
|
||||
# If the GROUP_GRAPHS and HAVE_DOT tags are set to YES then doxygen
|
||||
# will generate a graph for groups, showing the direct groups dependencies
|
||||
|
||||
GROUP_GRAPHS = NO
|
||||
|
||||
# If the UML_LOOK tag is set to YES doxygen will generate inheritance and
|
||||
# collaboration diagrams in a style similar to the OMG's Unified Modeling
|
||||
# Language.
|
||||
|
||||
UML_LOOK = NO
|
||||
|
||||
# If set to YES, the inheritance and collaboration graphs will show the
|
||||
# relations between templates and their instances.
|
||||
|
||||
TEMPLATE_RELATIONS = NO
|
||||
|
||||
# If the ENABLE_PREPROCESSING, SEARCH_INCLUDES, INCLUDE_GRAPH, and HAVE_DOT
|
||||
# tags are set to YES then doxygen will generate a graph for each documented
|
||||
# file showing the direct and indirect include dependencies of the file with
|
||||
# other documented files.
|
||||
|
||||
INCLUDE_GRAPH = NO
|
||||
|
||||
# If the ENABLE_PREPROCESSING, SEARCH_INCLUDES, INCLUDED_BY_GRAPH, and
|
||||
# HAVE_DOT tags are set to YES then doxygen will generate a graph for each
|
||||
# documented header file showing the documented files that directly or
|
||||
# indirectly include this file.
|
||||
|
||||
INCLUDED_BY_GRAPH = NO
|
||||
|
||||
# If the CALL_GRAPH and HAVE_DOT options are set to YES then
|
||||
# doxygen will generate a call dependency graph for every global function
|
||||
# or class method. Note that enabling this option will significantly increase
|
||||
# the time of a run. So in most cases it will be better to enable call graphs
|
||||
# for selected functions only using the \callgraph command.
|
||||
|
||||
CALL_GRAPH = NO
|
||||
|
||||
# If the CALLER_GRAPH and HAVE_DOT tags are set to YES then
|
||||
# doxygen will generate a caller dependency graph for every global function
|
||||
# or class method. Note that enabling this option will significantly increase
|
||||
# the time of a run. So in most cases it will be better to enable caller
|
||||
# graphs for selected functions only using the \callergraph command.
|
||||
|
||||
CALLER_GRAPH = NO
|
||||
|
||||
# If the GRAPHICAL_HIERARCHY and HAVE_DOT tags are set to YES then doxygen
|
||||
# will graphical hierarchy of all classes instead of a textual one.
|
||||
|
||||
GRAPHICAL_HIERARCHY = NO
|
||||
|
||||
# If the DIRECTORY_GRAPH, SHOW_DIRECTORIES and HAVE_DOT tags are set to YES
|
||||
# then doxygen will show the dependencies a directory has on other directories
|
||||
# in a graphical way. The dependency relations are determined by the #include
|
||||
# relations between the files in the directories.
|
||||
|
||||
DIRECTORY_GRAPH = NO
|
||||
|
||||
# The DOT_IMAGE_FORMAT tag can be used to set the image format of the images
|
||||
# generated by dot. Possible values are png, jpg, or gif
|
||||
# If left blank png will be used.
|
||||
|
||||
DOT_IMAGE_FORMAT = png
|
||||
|
||||
# The tag DOT_PATH can be used to specify the path where the dot tool can be
|
||||
# found. If left blank, it is assumed the dot tool can be found in the path.
|
||||
|
||||
DOT_PATH = "C:/Program Files/Graphviz2.18/bin"
|
||||
|
||||
# The DOTFILE_DIRS tag can be used to specify one or more directories that
|
||||
# contain dot files that are included in the documentation (see the
|
||||
# \dotfile command).
|
||||
|
||||
DOTFILE_DIRS =
|
||||
|
||||
# The DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES tag can be used to set the maximum number of
|
||||
# nodes that will be shown in the graph. If the number of nodes in a graph
|
||||
# becomes larger than this value, doxygen will truncate the graph, which is
|
||||
# visualized by representing a node as a red box. Note that doxygen if the
|
||||
# number of direct children of the root node in a graph is already larger than
|
||||
# DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES then the graph will not be shown at all. Also note
|
||||
# that the size of a graph can be further restricted by MAX_DOT_GRAPH_DEPTH.
|
||||
|
||||
DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES = 15
|
||||
|
||||
# The MAX_DOT_GRAPH_DEPTH tag can be used to set the maximum depth of the
|
||||
# graphs generated by dot. A depth value of 3 means that only nodes reachable
|
||||
# from the root by following a path via at most 3 edges will be shown. Nodes
|
||||
# that lay further from the root node will be omitted. Note that setting this
|
||||
# option to 1 or 2 may greatly reduce the computation time needed for large
|
||||
# code bases. Also note that the size of a graph can be further restricted by
|
||||
# DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES. Using a depth of 0 means no depth restriction.
|
||||
|
||||
MAX_DOT_GRAPH_DEPTH = 2
|
||||
|
||||
# Set the DOT_TRANSPARENT tag to YES to generate images with a transparent
|
||||
# background. This is disabled by default, because dot on Windows does not
|
||||
# seem to support this out of the box. Warning: Depending on the platform used,
|
||||
# enabling this option may lead to badly anti-aliased labels on the edges of
|
||||
# a graph (i.e. they become hard to read).
|
||||
|
||||
DOT_TRANSPARENT = YES
|
||||
|
||||
# Set the DOT_MULTI_TARGETS tag to YES allow dot to generate multiple output
|
||||
# files in one run (i.e. multiple -o and -T options on the command line). This
|
||||
# makes dot run faster, but since only newer versions of dot (>1.8.10)
|
||||
# support this, this feature is disabled by default.
|
||||
|
||||
DOT_MULTI_TARGETS = NO
|
||||
|
||||
# If the GENERATE_LEGEND tag is set to YES (the default) Doxygen will
|
||||
# generate a legend page explaining the meaning of the various boxes and
|
||||
# arrows in the dot generated graphs.
|
||||
|
||||
GENERATE_LEGEND = YES
|
||||
|
||||
# If the DOT_CLEANUP tag is set to YES (the default) Doxygen will
|
||||
# remove the intermediate dot files that are used to generate
|
||||
# the various graphs.
|
||||
|
||||
DOT_CLEANUP = YES
|
||||
|
||||
#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
|
||||
# Configuration::additions related to the search engine
|
||||
#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
|
||||
|
||||
# The SEARCHENGINE tag specifies whether or not a search engine should be
|
||||
# used. If set to NO the values of all tags below this one will be ignored.
|
||||
|
||||
SEARCHENGINE = NO
|
@ -0,0 +1,55 @@
|
||||
; Windows LUFA CDC Setup File
|
||||
; Copyright (c) 2000 Microsoft Corporation
|
||||
|
||||
[Version]
|
||||
Signature="$Windows NT$"
|
||||
Class=Ports
|
||||
ClassGuid={4D36E978-E325-11CE-BFC1-08002BE10318}
|
||||
Provider=%COMPANY%
|
||||
LayoutFile=layout.inf
|
||||
DriverVer=06/06/2006,1.0.0.0
|
||||
|
||||
[Manufacturer]
|
||||
%MFGNAME% = ManufName
|
||||
|
||||
[DestinationDirs]
|
||||
DefaultDestDir=12
|
||||
|
||||
[ManufName]
|
||||
%Modem3% = Modem3, USB\VID_03EB&PID_204A
|
||||
|
||||
;------------------------------------------------------------------------------
|
||||
; Windows 2000/XP Sections
|
||||
;------------------------------------------------------------------------------
|
||||
|
||||
[Modem3.nt]
|
||||
CopyFiles=USBModemCopyFileSection
|
||||
AddReg=Modem3.nt.AddReg
|
||||
|
||||
[USBModemCopyFileSection]
|
||||
usbser.sys,,,0x20
|
||||
|
||||
[Modem3.nt.AddReg]
|
||||
HKR,,DevLoader,,*ntkern
|
||||
HKR,,NTMPDriver,,usbser.sys
|
||||
HKR,,EnumPropPages32,,"MsPorts.dll,SerialPortPropPageProvider"
|
||||
|
||||
[Modem3.nt.Services]
|
||||
AddService=usbser, 0x00000002, DriverService
|
||||
|
||||
[DriverService]
|
||||
DisplayName=%SERVICE%
|
||||
ServiceType=1
|
||||
StartType=3
|
||||
ErrorControl=1
|
||||
ServiceBinary=%12%\usbser.sys
|
||||
|
||||
;------------------------------------------------------------------------------
|
||||
; String Definitions
|
||||
;------------------------------------------------------------------------------
|
||||
|
||||
[Strings]
|
||||
COMPANY="LUFA Library"
|
||||
MFGNAME="Dean Camera"
|
||||
Modem3="USB AVR109 Bootloader"
|
||||
SERVICE="USB Virtual Serial Port CDC Driver"
|
@ -0,0 +1,711 @@
|
||||
# Hey Emacs, this is a -*- makefile -*-
|
||||
#----------------------------------------------------------------------------
|
||||
# WinAVR Makefile Template written by Eric B. Weddington, Jörg Wunsch, et al.
|
||||
# >> Modified for use with the LUFA project. <<
|
||||
#
|
||||
# Released to the Public Domain
|
||||
#
|
||||
# Additional material for this makefile was written by:
|
||||
# Peter Fleury
|
||||
# Tim Henigan
|
||||
# Colin O'Flynn
|
||||
# Reiner Patommel
|
||||
# Markus Pfaff
|
||||
# Sander Pool
|
||||
# Frederik Rouleau
|
||||
# Carlos Lamas
|
||||
# Dean Camera
|
||||
# Opendous Inc.
|
||||
# Denver Gingerich
|
||||
#
|
||||
#----------------------------------------------------------------------------
|
||||
# On command line:
|
||||
#
|
||||
# make all = Make software.
|
||||
#
|
||||
# make clean = Clean out built project files.
|
||||
#
|
||||
# make coff = Convert ELF to AVR COFF.
|
||||
#
|
||||
# make extcoff = Convert ELF to AVR Extended COFF.
|
||||
#
|
||||
# make program = Download the hex file to the device, using avrdude.
|
||||
# Please customize the avrdude settings below first!
|
||||
#
|
||||
# make dfu = Download the hex file to the device, using dfu-programmer (must
|
||||
# have dfu-programmer installed).
|
||||
#
|
||||
# make flip = Download the hex file to the device, using Atmel FLIP (must
|
||||
# have Atmel FLIP installed).
|
||||
#
|
||||
# make dfu-ee = Download the eeprom file to the device, using dfu-programmer
|
||||
# (must have dfu-programmer installed).
|
||||
#
|
||||
# make flip-ee = Download the eeprom file to the device, using Atmel FLIP
|
||||
# (must have Atmel FLIP installed).
|
||||
#
|
||||
# make doxygen = Generate DoxyGen documentation for the project (must have
|
||||
# DoxyGen installed)
|
||||
#
|
||||
# make debug = Start either simulavr or avarice as specified for debugging,
|
||||
# with avr-gdb or avr-insight as the front end for debugging.
|
||||
#
|
||||
# make filename.s = Just compile filename.c into the assembler code only.
|
||||
#
|
||||
# make filename.i = Create a preprocessed source file for use in submitting
|
||||
# bug reports to the GCC project.
|
||||
#
|
||||
# To rebuild project do "make clean" then "make all".
|
||||
#----------------------------------------------------------------------------
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
# MCU name
|
||||
MCU = at90usb1287
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
# Target board (see library BoardTypes.h documentation, USER or blank for projects not requiring
|
||||
# LUFA board drivers). If USER is selected, put custom board drivers in a directory called
|
||||
# "Board" inside the application directory.
|
||||
BOARD = USBKEY
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
# Processor frequency.
|
||||
# This will define a symbol, F_CPU, in all source code files equal to the
|
||||
# processor frequency. You can then use this symbol in your source code to
|
||||
# calculate timings. Do NOT tack on a 'UL' at the end, this will be done
|
||||
# automatically to create a 32-bit value in your source code.
|
||||
# Typical values are:
|
||||
# F_CPU = 1000000
|
||||
# F_CPU = 1843200
|
||||
# F_CPU = 2000000
|
||||
# F_CPU = 3686400
|
||||
# F_CPU = 4000000
|
||||
# F_CPU = 7372800
|
||||
# F_CPU = 8000000
|
||||
# F_CPU = 11059200
|
||||
# F_CPU = 14745600
|
||||
# F_CPU = 16000000
|
||||
# F_CPU = 18432000
|
||||
# F_CPU = 20000000
|
||||
F_CPU = 8000000
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
# Output format. (can be srec, ihex, binary)
|
||||
FORMAT = ihex
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
# Target file name (without extension).
|
||||
TARGET = BootloaderCDC
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
# Object files directory
|
||||
# To put object files in current directory, use a dot (.), do NOT make
|
||||
# this an empty or blank macro!
|
||||
OBJDIR = .
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
# List C source files here. (C dependencies are automatically generated.)
|
||||
SRC = $(TARGET).c \
|
||||
Descriptors.c \
|
||||
../../LUFA/Drivers/USB/LowLevel/LowLevel.c \
|
||||
../../LUFA/Drivers/USB/LowLevel/Endpoint.c \
|
||||
../../LUFA/Drivers/USB/LowLevel/DevChapter9.c \
|
||||
../../LUFA/Drivers/USB/HighLevel/USBTask.c \
|
||||
../../LUFA/Drivers/USB/HighLevel/USBInterrupt.c \
|
||||
../../LUFA/Drivers/USB/HighLevel/Events.c \
|
||||
../../LUFA/Drivers/USB/HighLevel/StdDescriptors.c \
|
||||
|
||||
# List C++ source files here. (C dependencies are automatically generated.)
|
||||
CPPSRC =
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
# List Assembler source files here.
|
||||
# Make them always end in a capital .S. Files ending in a lowercase .s
|
||||
# will not be considered source files but generated files (assembler
|
||||
# output from the compiler), and will be deleted upon "make clean"!
|
||||
# Even though the DOS/Win* filesystem matches both .s and .S the same,
|
||||
# it will preserve the spelling of the filenames, and gcc itself does
|
||||
# care about how the name is spelled on its command-line.
|
||||
ASRC =
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
# Optimization level, can be [0, 1, 2, 3, s].
|
||||
# 0 = turn off optimization. s = optimize for size.
|
||||
# (Note: 3 is not always the best optimization level. See avr-libc FAQ.)
|
||||
OPT = s
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
# Debugging format.
|
||||
# Native formats for AVR-GCC's -g are dwarf-2 [default] or stabs.
|
||||
# AVR Studio 4.10 requires dwarf-2.
|
||||
# AVR [Extended] COFF format requires stabs, plus an avr-objcopy run.
|
||||
DEBUG = dwarf-2
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
# List any extra directories to look for include files here.
|
||||
# Each directory must be seperated by a space.
|
||||
# Use forward slashes for directory separators.
|
||||
# For a directory that has spaces, enclose it in quotes.
|
||||
EXTRAINCDIRS = ../../
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
# Compiler flag to set the C Standard level.
|
||||
# c89 = "ANSI" C
|
||||
# gnu89 = c89 plus GCC extensions
|
||||
# c99 = ISO C99 standard (not yet fully implemented)
|
||||
# gnu99 = c99 plus GCC extensions
|
||||
CSTANDARD = -std=gnu99
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
# Starting byte address of the bootloader
|
||||
BOOT_START = 0x1E000
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
# Place -D or -U options here for C sources
|
||||
CDEFS = -DF_CPU=$(F_CPU)UL -DBOARD=BOARD_$(BOARD) -DUSE_NONSTANDARD_DESCRIPTOR_NAMES -DSTATIC_ENDPOINT_CONFIGURATION
|
||||
CDEFS += -DUSB_DEVICE_ONLY -DUSE_STATIC_OPTIONS="(USB_DEVICE_OPT_FULLSPEED | USB_OPT_REG_ENABLED | USB_OPT_AUTO_PLL)"
|
||||
CDEFS += -DUSE_RAM_DESCRIPTORS -DBOOT_START_ADDR=$(BOOT_START)UL -DFIXED_CONTROL_ENDPOINT_SIZE=8 -DUSE_SINGLE_DEVICE_CONFIGURATION
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
# Place -D or -U options here for ASM sources
|
||||
ADEFS = -DF_CPU=$(F_CPU)
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
# Place -D or -U options here for C++ sources
|
||||
CPPDEFS = -DF_CPU=$(F_CPU)UL
|
||||
#CPPDEFS += -D__STDC_LIMIT_MACROS
|
||||
#CPPDEFS += -D__STDC_CONSTANT_MACROS
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
#---------------- Compiler Options C ----------------
|
||||
# -g*: generate debugging information
|
||||
# -O*: optimization level
|
||||
# -f...: tuning, see GCC manual and avr-libc documentation
|
||||
# -Wall...: warning level
|
||||
# -Wa,...: tell GCC to pass this to the assembler.
|
||||
# -adhlns...: create assembler listing
|
||||
CFLAGS = -g$(DEBUG)
|
||||
CFLAGS += $(CDEFS)
|
||||
CFLAGS += -O$(OPT)
|
||||
CFLAGS += -funsigned-char
|
||||
CFLAGS += -funsigned-bitfields
|
||||
CFLAGS += -ffunction-sections
|
||||
CFLAGS += -fpack-struct
|
||||
CFLAGS += -fshort-enums
|
||||
CFLAGS += -fno-inline-small-functions
|
||||
CFLAGS += -fno-reorder-blocks
|
||||
CFLAGS += -fno-reorder-blocks-and-partition
|
||||
CFLAGS += -fno-reorder-functions
|
||||
CFLAGS += -fno-toplevel-reorder
|
||||
CFLAGS += -Wall
|
||||
CFLAGS += -Wstrict-prototypes
|
||||
CFLAGS += -Wundef
|
||||
#CFLAGS += -fno-unit-at-a-time
|
||||
#CFLAGS += -Wunreachable-code
|
||||
#CFLAGS += -Wsign-compare
|
||||
CFLAGS += -Wa,-adhlns=$(<:%.c=$(OBJDIR)/%.lst)
|
||||
CFLAGS += $(patsubst %,-I%,$(EXTRAINCDIRS))
|
||||
CFLAGS += $(CSTANDARD)
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
#---------------- Compiler Options C++ ----------------
|
||||
# -g*: generate debugging information
|
||||
# -O*: optimization level
|
||||
# -f...: tuning, see GCC manual and avr-libc documentation
|
||||
# -Wall...: warning level
|
||||
# -Wa,...: tell GCC to pass this to the assembler.
|
||||
# -adhlns...: create assembler listing
|
||||
CPPFLAGS = -g$(DEBUG)
|
||||
CPPFLAGS += $(CPPDEFS)
|
||||
CPPFLAGS += -O$(OPT)
|
||||
CPPFLAGS += -funsigned-char
|
||||
CPPFLAGS += -funsigned-bitfields
|
||||
CPPFLAGS += -fpack-struct
|
||||
CPPFLAGS += -fshort-enums
|
||||
CPPFLAGS += -fno-exceptions
|
||||
CPPFLAGS += -Wall
|
||||
CFLAGS += -Wundef
|
||||
#CPPFLAGS += -mshort-calls
|
||||
#CPPFLAGS += -fno-unit-at-a-time
|
||||
#CPPFLAGS += -Wstrict-prototypes
|
||||
#CPPFLAGS += -Wunreachable-code
|
||||
#CPPFLAGS += -Wsign-compare
|
||||
CPPFLAGS += -Wa,-adhlns=$(<:%.cpp=$(OBJDIR)/%.lst)
|
||||
CPPFLAGS += $(patsubst %,-I%,$(EXTRAINCDIRS))
|
||||
#CPPFLAGS += $(CSTANDARD)
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
#---------------- Assembler Options ----------------
|
||||
# -Wa,...: tell GCC to pass this to the assembler.
|
||||
# -adhlns: create listing
|
||||
# -gstabs: have the assembler create line number information; note that
|
||||
# for use in COFF files, additional information about filenames
|
||||
# and function names needs to be present in the assembler source
|
||||
# files -- see avr-libc docs [FIXME: not yet described there]
|
||||
# -listing-cont-lines: Sets the maximum number of continuation lines of hex
|
||||
# dump that will be displayed for a given single line of source input.
|
||||
ASFLAGS = $(ADEFS) -Wa,-adhlns=$(<:%.S=$(OBJDIR)/%.lst),-gstabs,--listing-cont-lines=100
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
#---------------- Library Options ----------------
|
||||
# Minimalistic printf version
|
||||
PRINTF_LIB_MIN = -Wl,-u,vfprintf -lprintf_min
|
||||
|
||||
# Floating point printf version (requires MATH_LIB = -lm below)
|
||||
PRINTF_LIB_FLOAT = -Wl,-u,vfprintf -lprintf_flt
|
||||
|
||||
# If this is left blank, then it will use the Standard printf version.
|
||||
PRINTF_LIB =
|
||||
#PRINTF_LIB = $(PRINTF_LIB_MIN)
|
||||
#PRINTF_LIB = $(PRINTF_LIB_FLOAT)
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
# Minimalistic scanf version
|
||||
SCANF_LIB_MIN = -Wl,-u,vfscanf -lscanf_min
|
||||
|
||||
# Floating point + %[ scanf version (requires MATH_LIB = -lm below)
|
||||
SCANF_LIB_FLOAT = -Wl,-u,vfscanf -lscanf_flt
|
||||
|
||||
# If this is left blank, then it will use the Standard scanf version.
|
||||
SCANF_LIB =
|
||||
#SCANF_LIB = $(SCANF_LIB_MIN)
|
||||
#SCANF_LIB = $(SCANF_LIB_FLOAT)
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
MATH_LIB = -lm
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
# List any extra directories to look for libraries here.
|
||||
# Each directory must be seperated by a space.
|
||||
# Use forward slashes for directory separators.
|
||||
# For a directory that has spaces, enclose it in quotes.
|
||||
EXTRALIBDIRS =
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
#---------------- External Memory Options ----------------
|
||||
|
||||
# 64 KB of external RAM, starting after internal RAM (ATmega128!),
|
||||
# used for variables (.data/.bss) and heap (malloc()).
|
||||
#EXTMEMOPTS = -Wl,-Tdata=0x801100,--defsym=__heap_end=0x80ffff
|
||||
|
||||
# 64 KB of external RAM, starting after internal RAM (ATmega128!),
|
||||
# only used for heap (malloc()).
|
||||
#EXTMEMOPTS = -Wl,--section-start,.data=0x801100,--defsym=__heap_end=0x80ffff
|
||||
|
||||
EXTMEMOPTS =
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
#---------------- Linker Options ----------------
|
||||
# -Wl,...: tell GCC to pass this to linker.
|
||||
# -Map: create map file
|
||||
# --cref: add cross reference to map file
|
||||
LDFLAGS = -Wl,-Map=$(TARGET).map,--cref
|
||||
LDFLAGS += -Wl,--relax
|
||||
LDFLAGS += -Wl,--gc-sections
|
||||
LDFLAGS += -Wl,--section-start=.text=$(BOOT_START)
|
||||
LDFLAGS += $(EXTMEMOPTS)
|
||||
LDFLAGS += $(patsubst %,-L%,$(EXTRALIBDIRS))
|
||||
LDFLAGS += $(PRINTF_LIB) $(SCANF_LIB) $(MATH_LIB)
|
||||
#LDFLAGS += -T linker_script.x
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
#---------------- Programming Options (avrdude) ----------------
|
||||
|
||||
# Programming hardware: alf avr910 avrisp bascom bsd
|
||||
# dt006 pavr picoweb pony-stk200 sp12 stk200 stk500
|
||||
#
|
||||
# Type: avrdude -c ?
|
||||
# to get a full listing.
|
||||
#
|
||||
AVRDUDE_PROGRAMMER = jtagmkII
|
||||
|
||||
# com1 = serial port. Use lpt1 to connect to parallel port.
|
||||
AVRDUDE_PORT = usb
|
||||
|
||||
AVRDUDE_WRITE_FLASH = -U flash:w:$(TARGET).hex
|
||||
#AVRDUDE_WRITE_EEPROM = -U eeprom:w:$(TARGET).eep
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
# Uncomment the following if you want avrdude's erase cycle counter.
|
||||
# Note that this counter needs to be initialized first using -Yn,
|
||||
# see avrdude manual.
|
||||
#AVRDUDE_ERASE_COUNTER = -y
|
||||
|
||||
# Uncomment the following if you do /not/ wish a verification to be
|
||||
# performed after programming the device.
|
||||
#AVRDUDE_NO_VERIFY = -V
|
||||
|
||||
# Increase verbosity level. Please use this when submitting bug
|
||||
# reports about avrdude. See <http://savannah.nongnu.org/projects/avrdude>
|
||||
# to submit bug reports.
|
||||
#AVRDUDE_VERBOSE = -v -v
|
||||
|
||||
AVRDUDE_FLAGS = -p $(MCU) -P $(AVRDUDE_PORT) -c $(AVRDUDE_PROGRAMMER)
|
||||
AVRDUDE_FLAGS += $(AVRDUDE_NO_VERIFY)
|
||||
AVRDUDE_FLAGS += $(AVRDUDE_VERBOSE)
|
||||
AVRDUDE_FLAGS += $(AVRDUDE_ERASE_COUNTER)
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
#---------------- Debugging Options ----------------
|
||||
|
||||
# For simulavr only - target MCU frequency.
|
||||
DEBUG_MFREQ = $(F_CPU)
|
||||
|
||||
# Set the DEBUG_UI to either gdb or insight.
|
||||
# DEBUG_UI = gdb
|
||||
DEBUG_UI = insight
|
||||
|
||||
# Set the debugging back-end to either avarice, simulavr.
|
||||
DEBUG_BACKEND = avarice
|
||||
#DEBUG_BACKEND = simulavr
|
||||
|
||||
# GDB Init Filename.
|
||||
GDBINIT_FILE = __avr_gdbinit
|
||||
|
||||
# When using avarice settings for the JTAG
|
||||
JTAG_DEV = /dev/com1
|
||||
|
||||
# Debugging port used to communicate between GDB / avarice / simulavr.
|
||||
DEBUG_PORT = 4242
|
||||
|
||||
# Debugging host used to communicate between GDB / avarice / simulavr, normally
|
||||
# just set to localhost unless doing some sort of crazy debugging when
|
||||
# avarice is running on a different computer.
|
||||
DEBUG_HOST = localhost
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
#============================================================================
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
# Define programs and commands.
|
||||
SHELL = sh
|
||||
CC = avr-gcc
|
||||
OBJCOPY = avr-objcopy
|
||||
OBJDUMP = avr-objdump
|
||||
SIZE = avr-size
|
||||
AR = avr-ar rcs
|
||||
NM = avr-nm
|
||||
AVRDUDE = avrdude
|
||||
REMOVE = rm -f
|
||||
REMOVEDIR = rm -rf
|
||||
COPY = cp
|
||||
WINSHELL = cmd
|
||||
|
||||
# Define Messages
|
||||
# English
|
||||
MSG_ERRORS_NONE = Errors: none
|
||||
MSG_BEGIN = -------- begin --------
|
||||
MSG_END = -------- end --------
|
||||
MSG_SIZE_BEFORE = Size before:
|
||||
MSG_SIZE_AFTER = Size after:
|
||||
MSG_COFF = Converting to AVR COFF:
|
||||
MSG_EXTENDED_COFF = Converting to AVR Extended COFF:
|
||||
MSG_FLASH = Creating load file for Flash:
|
||||
MSG_EEPROM = Creating load file for EEPROM:
|
||||
MSG_EXTENDED_LISTING = Creating Extended Listing:
|
||||
MSG_SYMBOL_TABLE = Creating Symbol Table:
|
||||
MSG_LINKING = Linking:
|
||||
MSG_COMPILING = Compiling C:
|
||||
MSG_COMPILING_CPP = Compiling C++:
|
||||
MSG_ASSEMBLING = Assembling:
|
||||
MSG_CLEANING = Cleaning project:
|
||||
MSG_CREATING_LIBRARY = Creating library:
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
# Define all object files.
|
||||
OBJ = $(SRC:%.c=$(OBJDIR)/%.o) $(CPPSRC:%.cpp=$(OBJDIR)/%.o) $(ASRC:%.S=$(OBJDIR)/%.o)
|
||||
|
||||
# Define all listing files.
|
||||
LST = $(SRC:%.c=$(OBJDIR)/%.lst) $(CPPSRC:%.cpp=$(OBJDIR)/%.lst) $(ASRC:%.S=$(OBJDIR)/%.lst)
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
# Compiler flags to generate dependency files.
|
||||
GENDEPFLAGS = -MMD -MP -MF .dep/$(@F).d
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
# Combine all necessary flags and optional flags.
|
||||
# Add target processor to flags.
|
||||
ALL_CFLAGS = -mmcu=$(MCU) -I. $(CFLAGS) $(GENDEPFLAGS)
|
||||
ALL_CPPFLAGS = -mmcu=$(MCU) -I. -x c++ $(CPPFLAGS) $(GENDEPFLAGS)
|
||||
ALL_ASFLAGS = -mmcu=$(MCU) -I. -x assembler-with-cpp $(ASFLAGS)
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
# Default target.
|
||||
all: begin gccversion sizebefore build checkhooks checklibmode sizeafter end
|
||||
|
||||
# Change the build target to build a HEX file or a library.
|
||||
build: elf hex eep lss sym
|
||||
#build: lib
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
elf: $(TARGET).elf
|
||||
hex: $(TARGET).hex
|
||||
eep: $(TARGET).eep
|
||||
lss: $(TARGET).lss
|
||||
sym: $(TARGET).sym
|
||||
LIBNAME=lib$(TARGET).a
|
||||
lib: $(LIBNAME)
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
# Eye candy.
|
||||
# AVR Studio 3.x does not check make's exit code but relies on
|
||||
# the following magic strings to be generated by the compile job.
|
||||
begin:
|
||||
@echo
|
||||
@echo $(MSG_BEGIN)
|
||||
|
||||
end:
|
||||
@echo $(MSG_END)
|
||||
@echo
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
# Display size of file.
|
||||
HEXSIZE = $(SIZE) --target=$(FORMAT) $(TARGET).hex
|
||||
ELFSIZE = $(SIZE) $(MCU_FLAG) $(FORMAT_FLAG) $(TARGET).elf
|
||||
MCU_FLAG = $(shell $(SIZE) --help | grep -- --mcu > /dev/null && echo --mcu=$(MCU) )
|
||||
FORMAT_FLAG = $(shell $(SIZE) --help | grep -- --format=.*avr > /dev/null && echo --format=avr )
|
||||
|
||||
sizebefore:
|
||||
@if test -f $(TARGET).elf; then echo; echo $(MSG_SIZE_BEFORE); $(ELFSIZE); \
|
||||
2>/dev/null; echo; fi
|
||||
|
||||
sizeafter:
|
||||
@if test -f $(TARGET).elf; then echo; echo $(MSG_SIZE_AFTER); $(ELFSIZE); \
|
||||
2>/dev/null; echo; fi
|
||||
|
||||
checkhooks: build
|
||||
@echo
|
||||
@echo ------- Unhooked LUFA Events -------
|
||||
@$(shell) (grep -s '^Event.*LUFA/.*\\.o' $(TARGET).map | \
|
||||
cut -d' ' -f1 | cut -d'_' -f2- | grep ".*") || \
|
||||
echo "(None)"
|
||||
@echo ----- End Unhooked LUFA Events -----
|
||||
|
||||
checklibmode:
|
||||
@echo
|
||||
@echo ----------- Library Mode -----------
|
||||
@$(shell) ($(CC) $(ALL_CFLAGS) -E -dM - < /dev/null \
|
||||
| grep 'USB_\(DEVICE\|HOST\)_ONLY' | cut -d' ' -f2 | grep ".*") \
|
||||
|| echo "No specific mode (both device and host mode allowable)."
|
||||
@echo ------------------------------------
|
||||
|
||||
# Display compiler version information.
|
||||
gccversion :
|
||||
@$(CC) --version
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
# Program the device.
|
||||
program: $(TARGET).hex $(TARGET).eep
|
||||
$(AVRDUDE) $(AVRDUDE_FLAGS) $(AVRDUDE_WRITE_FLASH) $(AVRDUDE_WRITE_EEPROM)
|
||||
|
||||
flip: $(TARGET).hex
|
||||
batchisp -hardware usb -device $(MCU) -operation erase f
|
||||
batchisp -hardware usb -device $(MCU) -operation loadbuffer $(TARGET).hex program
|
||||
batchisp -hardware usb -device $(MCU) -operation start reset 0
|
||||
|
||||
dfu: $(TARGET).hex
|
||||
dfu-programmer $(MCU) erase
|
||||
dfu-programmer $(MCU) flash --debug 1 $(TARGET).hex
|
||||
dfu-programmer $(MCU) reset
|
||||
|
||||
flip-ee: $(TARGET).hex $(TARGET).eep
|
||||
copy $(TARGET).eep $(TARGET)eep.hex
|
||||
batchisp -hardware usb -device $(MCU) -operation memory EEPROM erase
|
||||
batchisp -hardware usb -device $(MCU) -operation memory EEPROM loadbuffer $(TARGET)eep.hex program
|
||||
batchisp -hardware usb -device $(MCU) -operation start reset 0
|
||||
|
||||
dfu-ee: $(TARGET).hex $(TARGET).eep
|
||||
dfu-programmer $(MCU) erase
|
||||
dfu-programmer $(MCU) eeprom --debug 1 $(TARGET).eep
|
||||
dfu-programmer $(MCU) reset
|
||||
|
||||
# Generate avr-gdb config/init file which does the following:
|
||||
# define the reset signal, load the target file, connect to target, and set
|
||||
# a breakpoint at main().
|
||||
gdb-config:
|
||||
@$(REMOVE) $(GDBINIT_FILE)
|
||||
@echo define reset >> $(GDBINIT_FILE)
|
||||
@echo SIGNAL SIGHUP >> $(GDBINIT_FILE)
|
||||
@echo end >> $(GDBINIT_FILE)
|
||||
@echo file $(TARGET).elf >> $(GDBINIT_FILE)
|
||||
@echo target remote $(DEBUG_HOST):$(DEBUG_PORT) >> $(GDBINIT_FILE)
|
||||
ifeq ($(DEBUG_BACKEND),simulavr)
|
||||
@echo load >> $(GDBINIT_FILE)
|
||||
endif
|
||||
@echo break main >> $(GDBINIT_FILE)
|
||||
|
||||
debug: gdb-config $(TARGET).elf
|
||||
ifeq ($(DEBUG_BACKEND), avarice)
|
||||
@echo Starting AVaRICE - Press enter when "waiting to connect" message displays.
|
||||
@$(WINSHELL) /c start avarice --jtag $(JTAG_DEV) --erase --program --file \
|
||||
$(TARGET).elf $(DEBUG_HOST):$(DEBUG_PORT)
|
||||
@$(WINSHELL) /c pause
|
||||
|
||||
else
|
||||
@$(WINSHELL) /c start simulavr --gdbserver --device $(MCU) --clock-freq \
|
||||
$(DEBUG_MFREQ) --port $(DEBUG_PORT)
|
||||
endif
|
||||
@$(WINSHELL) /c start avr-$(DEBUG_UI) --command=$(GDBINIT_FILE)
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
# Convert ELF to COFF for use in debugging / simulating in AVR Studio or VMLAB.
|
||||
COFFCONVERT = $(OBJCOPY) --debugging
|
||||
COFFCONVERT += --change-section-address .data-0x800000
|
||||
COFFCONVERT += --change-section-address .bss-0x800000
|
||||
COFFCONVERT += --change-section-address .noinit-0x800000
|
||||
COFFCONVERT += --change-section-address .eeprom-0x810000
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
coff: $(TARGET).elf
|
||||
@echo
|
||||
@echo $(MSG_COFF) $(TARGET).cof
|
||||
$(COFFCONVERT) -O coff-avr $< $(TARGET).cof
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
extcoff: $(TARGET).elf
|
||||
@echo
|
||||
@echo $(MSG_EXTENDED_COFF) $(TARGET).cof
|
||||
$(COFFCONVERT) -O coff-ext-avr $< $(TARGET).cof
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
# Create final output files (.hex, .eep) from ELF output file.
|
||||
%.hex: %.elf
|
||||
@echo
|
||||
@echo $(MSG_FLASH) $@
|
||||
$(OBJCOPY) -O $(FORMAT) -R .eeprom $< $@
|
||||
|
||||
%.eep: %.elf
|
||||
@echo
|
||||
@echo $(MSG_EEPROM) $@
|
||||
-$(OBJCOPY) -j .eeprom --set-section-flags=.eeprom="alloc,load" \
|
||||
--change-section-lma .eeprom=0 --no-change-warnings -O $(FORMAT) $< $@ || exit 0
|
||||
|
||||
# Create extended listing file from ELF output file.
|
||||
%.lss: %.elf
|
||||
@echo
|
||||
@echo $(MSG_EXTENDED_LISTING) $@
|
||||
$(OBJDUMP) -h -z -S $< > $@
|
||||
|
||||
# Create a symbol table from ELF output file.
|
||||
%.sym: %.elf
|
||||
@echo
|
||||
@echo $(MSG_SYMBOL_TABLE) $@
|
||||
$(NM) -n $< > $@
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
# Create library from object files.
|
||||
.SECONDARY : $(TARGET).a
|
||||
.PRECIOUS : $(OBJ)
|
||||
%.a: $(OBJ)
|
||||
@echo
|
||||
@echo $(MSG_CREATING_LIBRARY) $@
|
||||
$(AR) $@ $(OBJ)
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
# Link: create ELF output file from object files.
|
||||
.SECONDARY : $(TARGET).elf
|
||||
.PRECIOUS : $(OBJ)
|
||||
%.elf: $(OBJ)
|
||||
@echo
|
||||
@echo $(MSG_LINKING) $@
|
||||
$(CC) $(ALL_CFLAGS) $^ --output $@ $(LDFLAGS)
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
# Compile: create object files from C source files.
|
||||
$(OBJDIR)/%.o : %.c
|
||||
@echo
|
||||
@echo $(MSG_COMPILING) $<
|
||||
$(CC) -c $(ALL_CFLAGS) $< -o $@
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
# Compile: create object files from C++ source files.
|
||||
$(OBJDIR)/%.o : %.cpp
|
||||
@echo
|
||||
@echo $(MSG_COMPILING_CPP) $<
|
||||
$(CC) -c $(ALL_CPPFLAGS) $< -o $@
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
# Compile: create assembler files from C source files.
|
||||
%.s : %.c
|
||||
$(CC) -S $(ALL_CFLAGS) $< -o $@
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
# Compile: create assembler files from C++ source files.
|
||||
%.s : %.cpp
|
||||
$(CC) -S $(ALL_CPPFLAGS) $< -o $@
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
# Assemble: create object files from assembler source files.
|
||||
$(OBJDIR)/%.o : %.S
|
||||
@echo
|
||||
@echo $(MSG_ASSEMBLING) $<
|
||||
$(CC) -c $(ALL_ASFLAGS) $< -o $@
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
# Create preprocessed source for use in sending a bug report.
|
||||
%.i : %.c
|
||||
$(CC) -E -mmcu=$(MCU) -I. $(CFLAGS) $< -o $@
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
# Target: clean project.
|
||||
clean: begin clean_list clean_binary end
|
||||
|
||||
clean_binary:
|
||||
$(REMOVE) $(TARGET).hex
|
||||
|
||||
clean_list:
|
||||
@echo $(MSG_CLEANING)
|
||||
$(REMOVE) $(TARGET).eep
|
||||
$(REMOVE) $(TARGET).cof
|
||||
$(REMOVE) $(TARGET).elf
|
||||
$(REMOVE) $(TARGET).map
|
||||
$(REMOVE) $(TARGET).sym
|
||||
$(REMOVE) $(TARGET).lss
|
||||
$(REMOVE) $(SRC:%.c=$(OBJDIR)/%.o)
|
||||
$(REMOVE) $(SRC:%.c=$(OBJDIR)/%.lst)
|
||||
$(REMOVE) $(SRC:.c=.s)
|
||||
$(REMOVE) $(SRC:.c=.d)
|
||||
$(REMOVE) $(SRC:.c=.i)
|
||||
$(REMOVEDIR) .dep
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
doxygen:
|
||||
@echo Generating Project Documentation...
|
||||
@doxygen Doxygen.conf
|
||||
@echo Documentation Generation Complete.
|
||||
|
||||
clean_doxygen:
|
||||
rm -rf Documentation
|
||||
|
||||
# Create object files directory
|
||||
$(shell mkdir $(OBJDIR) 2>/dev/null)
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
# Include the dependency files.
|
||||
-include $(shell mkdir .dep 2>/dev/null) $(wildcard .dep/*)
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
# Listing of phony targets.
|
||||
.PHONY : all checkhooks checklibmode begin \
|
||||
finish end sizebefore sizeafter gccversion \
|
||||
build elf hex eep lss sym coff extcoff \
|
||||
clean clean_list clean_binary program debug \
|
||||
gdb-config doxygen
|
@ -0,0 +1 @@
|
||||
<AVRStudio><MANAGEMENT><ProjectName>BootloaderDFU</ProjectName><Created>30-Sep-2008 14:20:47</Created><LastEdit>30-Sep-2008 14:21:00</LastEdit><ICON>241</ICON><ProjectType>0</ProjectType><Created>30-Sep-2008 14:20:47</Created><Version>4</Version><Build>4, 14, 0, 589</Build><ProjectTypeName>AVR GCC</ProjectTypeName></MANAGEMENT><CODE_CREATION><ObjectFile></ObjectFile><EntryFile></EntryFile><SaveFolder>C:\Users\Dean\Documents\Electronics\Projects\WORK\MyUSBWORK\Bootloaders\DFU\</SaveFolder></CODE_CREATION><DEBUG_TARGET><CURRENT_TARGET></CURRENT_TARGET><CURRENT_PART></CURRENT_PART><BREAKPOINTS></BREAKPOINTS><IO_EXPAND><HIDE>false</HIDE></IO_EXPAND><REGISTERNAMES><Register>R00</Register><Register>R01</Register><Register>R02</Register><Register>R03</Register><Register>R04</Register><Register>R05</Register><Register>R06</Register><Register>R07</Register><Register>R08</Register><Register>R09</Register><Register>R10</Register><Register>R11</Register><Register>R12</Register><Register>R13</Register><Register>R14</Register><Register>R15</Register><Register>R16</Register><Register>R17</Register><Register>R18</Register><Register>R19</Register><Register>R20</Register><Register>R21</Register><Register>R22</Register><Register>R23</Register><Register>R24</Register><Register>R25</Register><Register>R26</Register><Register>R27</Register><Register>R28</Register><Register>R29</Register><Register>R30</Register><Register>R31</Register></REGISTERNAMES><COM></COM><COMType>0</COMType><WATCHNUM>0</WATCHNUM><WATCHNAMES><Pane0></Pane0><Pane1></Pane1><Pane2></Pane2><Pane3></Pane3></WATCHNAMES><BreakOnTrcaeFull>0</BreakOnTrcaeFull></DEBUG_TARGET><Debugger><Triggers></Triggers></Debugger><AVRGCCPLUGIN><FILES><SOURCEFILE>BootloaderDFU.c</SOURCEFILE><SOURCEFILE>Descriptors.c</SOURCEFILE><HEADERFILE>BootloaderDFU.h</HEADERFILE><HEADERFILE>Descriptors.h</HEADERFILE><OTHERFILE>makefile</OTHERFILE></FILES><CONFIGS><CONFIG><NAME>default</NAME><USESEXTERNALMAKEFILE>YES</USESEXTERNALMAKEFILE><EXTERNALMAKEFILE>makefile</EXTERNALMAKEFILE><PART>atmega128</PART><HEX>1</HEX><LIST>1</LIST><MAP>1</MAP><OUTPUTFILENAME>BootloaderDFU.elf</OUTPUTFILENAME><OUTPUTDIR>default\</OUTPUTDIR><ISDIRTY>1</ISDIRTY><OPTIONS/><INCDIRS/><LIBDIRS/><LIBS/><LINKOBJECTS/><OPTIONSFORALL>-Wall -gdwarf-2 -std=gnu99 -Os -funsigned-char -funsigned-bitfields -fpack-struct -fshort-enums</OPTIONSFORALL><LINKEROPTIONS></LINKEROPTIONS><SEGMENTS/></CONFIG></CONFIGS><LASTCONFIG>default</LASTCONFIG><USES_WINAVR>1</USES_WINAVR><GCC_LOC>C:\WinAVR-20080512\bin\avr-gcc.exe</GCC_LOC><MAKE_LOC>C:\WinAVR-20080512\utils\bin\make.exe</MAKE_LOC></AVRGCCPLUGIN><IOView><usergroups/><sort sorted="0" column="0" ordername="0" orderaddress="0" ordergroup="0"/></IOView><Files></Files><Events><Bookmarks></Bookmarks></Events><Trace><Filters></Filters></Trace></AVRStudio>
|
@ -0,0 +1,692 @@
|
||||
/*
|
||||
LUFA Library
|
||||
Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2009.
|
||||
|
||||
dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com
|
||||
www.fourwalledcubicle.com
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
/*
|
||||
Copyright 2009 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com)
|
||||
|
||||
Permission to use, copy, modify, and distribute this software
|
||||
and its documentation for any purpose and without fee is hereby
|
||||
granted, provided that the above copyright notice appear in all
|
||||
copies and that both that the copyright notice and this
|
||||
permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting
|
||||
documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in
|
||||
advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the
|
||||
software without specific, written prior permission.
|
||||
|
||||
The author disclaim all warranties with regard to this
|
||||
software, including all implied warranties of merchantability
|
||||
and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any
|
||||
special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages
|
||||
whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether
|
||||
in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action,
|
||||
arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of
|
||||
this software.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
/** \file
|
||||
*
|
||||
* Main source file for the DFU class bootloader. This file contains the complete bootloader logic.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
/** Configuration define. Define this token to true to case the bootloader to reject all memory commands
|
||||
* until a memory erase has been performed. When used in conjunction with the lockbits of the AVR, this
|
||||
* can protect the AVR's firmware from being dumped from a secured AVR. When false, memory operations are
|
||||
* allowed at any time.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
#define SECURE_MODE false
|
||||
|
||||
#define INCLUDE_FROM_BOOTLOADER_C
|
||||
#include "BootloaderDFU.h"
|
||||
|
||||
/** Flag to indicate if the bootloader is currently running in secure mode, disallowing memory operations
|
||||
* other than erase. This is initially set to the value set by SECURE_MODE, and cleared by the bootloader
|
||||
* once a memory erase has completed.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
bool IsSecure = SECURE_MODE;
|
||||
|
||||
/** Flag to indicate if the bootloader should be running, or should exit and allow the application code to run
|
||||
* via a soft reset. When cleared, the bootloader will abort, the USB interface will shut down and the application
|
||||
* jumped to via an indirect jump to location 0x0000 (or other location specified by the host).
|
||||
*/
|
||||
bool RunBootloader = true;
|
||||
|
||||
/** Flag to indicate if the bootloader is waiting to exit. When the host requests the bootloader to exit and
|
||||
* jump to the application address it specifies, it sends two sequential commands which must be properly
|
||||
* acknowedged. Upon reception of the first the RunBootloader flag is cleared and the WaitForExit flag is set,
|
||||
* causing the bootloader to wait for the final exit command before shutting down.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
bool WaitForExit = false;
|
||||
|
||||
/** Current DFU state machine state, one of the values in the DFU_State_t enum. */
|
||||
uint8_t DFU_State = dfuIDLE;
|
||||
|
||||
/** Status code of the last executed DFU command. This is set to one of the values in the DFU_Status_t enum after
|
||||
* each operation, and returned to the host when a Get Status DFU request is issued.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
uint8_t DFU_Status = OK;
|
||||
|
||||
/** Data containing the DFU command sent from the host. */
|
||||
DFU_Command_t SentCommand;
|
||||
|
||||
/** Response to the last issued Read Data DFU command. Unlike other DFU commands, the read command
|
||||
* requires a single byte response from the bootloader containing the read data when the next DFU_UPLOAD command
|
||||
* is issued by the host.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
uint8_t ResponseByte;
|
||||
|
||||
/** Pointer to the start of the user application. By default this is 0x0000 (the reset vector), however the host
|
||||
* may specify an alternate address when issuing the application soft-start command.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
AppPtr_t AppStartPtr = (AppPtr_t)0x0000;
|
||||
|
||||
/** 64-bit flash page number. This is concatenated with the current 16-bit address on USB AVRs containing more than
|
||||
* 64KB of flash memory.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
uint8_t Flash64KBPage = 0;
|
||||
|
||||
/** Memory start address, indicating the current address in the memory being addressed (either FLASH or EEPROM
|
||||
* depending on the issued command from the host).
|
||||
*/
|
||||
uint16_t StartAddr = 0x0000;
|
||||
|
||||
/** Memory end address, indicating the end address to read to/write from in the memory being addressed (either FLASH
|
||||
* of EEPROM depending on the issued command from the host).
|
||||
*/
|
||||
uint16_t EndAddr = 0x0000;
|
||||
|
||||
/** Main program entry point. This routine configures the hardware required by the bootloader, then continuously
|
||||
* runs the bootloader processing routine until instructed to soft-exit, or hard-reset via the watchdog to start
|
||||
* the loaded application code.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
int main (void)
|
||||
{
|
||||
/* Disable watchdog if enabled by bootloader/fuses */
|
||||
MCUSR &= ~(1 << WDRF);
|
||||
wdt_disable();
|
||||
|
||||
/* Disable Clock Division */
|
||||
SetSystemClockPrescaler(0);
|
||||
|
||||
/* Relocate the interrupt vector table to the bootloader section */
|
||||
MCUCR = (1 << IVCE);
|
||||
MCUCR = (1 << IVSEL);
|
||||
|
||||
/* Initialize the USB subsystem */
|
||||
USB_Init();
|
||||
|
||||
/* Run the USB management task while the bootloader is supposed to be running */
|
||||
while (RunBootloader || WaitForExit)
|
||||
USB_USBTask();
|
||||
|
||||
/* Shut down the USB subsystem */
|
||||
USB_ShutDown();
|
||||
|
||||
/* Relocate the interrupt vector table back to the application section */
|
||||
MCUCR = (1 << IVCE);
|
||||
MCUCR = 0;
|
||||
|
||||
/* Reset any used hardware ports back to their defaults */
|
||||
PORTD = 0;
|
||||
DDRD = 0;
|
||||
|
||||
#if defined(PORTE)
|
||||
PORTE = 0;
|
||||
DDRE = 0;
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
/* Start the user application */
|
||||
AppStartPtr();
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
/** Event handler for the USB_Disconnect event. This indicates that the bootloader should exit and the user
|
||||
* application started.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
EVENT_HANDLER(USB_Disconnect)
|
||||
{
|
||||
/* Upon disconnection, run user application */
|
||||
RunBootloader = false;
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
/** Event handler for the USB_UnhandledControlPacket event. This is used to catch standard and class specific
|
||||
* control requests that are not handled internally by the USB library (including the DFU commands, which are
|
||||
* all issued via the control endpoint), so that they can be handled appropriately for the application.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
EVENT_HANDLER(USB_UnhandledControlPacket)
|
||||
{
|
||||
/* Discard unused wIndex value */
|
||||
Endpoint_Discard_Word();
|
||||
|
||||
/* Discard unused wValue value */
|
||||
Endpoint_Discard_Word();
|
||||
|
||||
/* Get the size of the command and data from the wLength value */
|
||||
SentCommand.DataSize = Endpoint_Read_Word_LE();
|
||||
|
||||
switch (bRequest)
|
||||
{
|
||||
case DFU_DNLOAD:
|
||||
Endpoint_ClearSetupReceived();
|
||||
|
||||
/* Check if bootloader is waiting to terminate */
|
||||
if (WaitForExit)
|
||||
{
|
||||
/* Bootloader is terminating - process last received command */
|
||||
ProcessBootloaderCommand();
|
||||
|
||||
/* Indicate that the last command has now been processed - free to exit bootloader */
|
||||
WaitForExit = false;
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
/* If the request has a data stage, load it into the command struct */
|
||||
if (SentCommand.DataSize)
|
||||
{
|
||||
while (!(Endpoint_IsSetupOUTReceived()));
|
||||
|
||||
/* First byte of the data stage is the DNLOAD request's command */
|
||||
SentCommand.Command = Endpoint_Read_Byte();
|
||||
|
||||
/* One byte of the data stage is the command, so subtract it from the total data bytes */
|
||||
SentCommand.DataSize--;
|
||||
|
||||
/* Load in the rest of the data stage as command parameters */
|
||||
for (uint8_t DataByte = 0; (DataByte < sizeof(SentCommand.Data)) &&
|
||||
Endpoint_BytesInEndpoint(); DataByte++)
|
||||
{
|
||||
SentCommand.Data[DataByte] = Endpoint_Read_Byte();
|
||||
SentCommand.DataSize--;
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
/* Process the command */
|
||||
ProcessBootloaderCommand();
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
/* Check if currently downloading firmware */
|
||||
if (DFU_State == dfuDNLOAD_IDLE)
|
||||
{
|
||||
if (!(SentCommand.DataSize))
|
||||
{
|
||||
DFU_State = dfuIDLE;
|
||||
}
|
||||
else
|
||||
{
|
||||
/* Throw away the filler bytes before the start of the firmware */
|
||||
DiscardFillerBytes(DFU_FILLER_BYTES_SIZE);
|
||||
|
||||
/* Throw away the page alignment filler bytes before the start of the firmware */
|
||||
DiscardFillerBytes(StartAddr % SPM_PAGESIZE);
|
||||
|
||||
/* Calculate the number of bytes remaining to be written */
|
||||
uint16_t BytesRemaining = ((EndAddr - StartAddr) + 1);
|
||||
|
||||
if (IS_ONEBYTE_COMMAND(SentCommand.Data, 0x00)) // Write flash
|
||||
{
|
||||
/* Calculate the number of words to be written from the number of bytes to be written */
|
||||
uint16_t WordsRemaining = (BytesRemaining >> 1);
|
||||
|
||||
union
|
||||
{
|
||||
uint16_t Words[2];
|
||||
uint32_t Long;
|
||||
} CurrFlashAddress = {Words: {StartAddr, Flash64KBPage}};
|
||||
|
||||
uint32_t CurrFlashPageStartAddress = CurrFlashAddress.Long;
|
||||
uint8_t WordsInFlashPage = 0;
|
||||
|
||||
while (WordsRemaining--)
|
||||
{
|
||||
/* Check if endpoint is empty - if so clear it and wait until ready for next packet */
|
||||
if (!(Endpoint_BytesInEndpoint()))
|
||||
{
|
||||
Endpoint_ClearSetupOUT();
|
||||
while (!(Endpoint_IsSetupOUTReceived()));
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
/* Write the next word into the current flash page */
|
||||
boot_page_fill(CurrFlashAddress.Long, Endpoint_Read_Word_LE());
|
||||
|
||||
/* Adjust counters */
|
||||
WordsInFlashPage += 1;
|
||||
CurrFlashAddress.Long += 2;
|
||||
|
||||
/* See if an entire page has been written to the flash page buffer */
|
||||
if ((WordsInFlashPage == (SPM_PAGESIZE >> 1)) || !(WordsRemaining))
|
||||
{
|
||||
/* Commit the flash page to memory */
|
||||
boot_page_write(CurrFlashPageStartAddress);
|
||||
boot_spm_busy_wait();
|
||||
|
||||
/* Check if programming incomplete */
|
||||
if (WordsRemaining)
|
||||
{
|
||||
CurrFlashPageStartAddress = CurrFlashAddress.Long;
|
||||
WordsInFlashPage = 0;
|
||||
|
||||
/* Erase next page's temp buffer */
|
||||
boot_page_erase(CurrFlashAddress.Long);
|
||||
boot_spm_busy_wait();
|
||||
}
|
||||
}
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
/* Once programming complete, start address equals the end address */
|
||||
StartAddr = EndAddr;
|
||||
|
||||
/* Re-enable the RWW section of flash */
|
||||
boot_rww_enable();
|
||||
}
|
||||
else // Write EEPROM
|
||||
{
|
||||
while (BytesRemaining--)
|
||||
{
|
||||
/* Check if endpoint is empty - if so clear it and wait until ready for next packet */
|
||||
if (!(Endpoint_BytesInEndpoint()))
|
||||
{
|
||||
Endpoint_ClearSetupOUT();
|
||||
while (!(Endpoint_IsSetupOUTReceived()));
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
/* Read the byte from the USB interface and write to to the EEPROM */
|
||||
eeprom_write_byte((uint8_t*)StartAddr, Endpoint_Read_Byte());
|
||||
|
||||
/* Adjust counters */
|
||||
StartAddr++;
|
||||
}
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
/* Throw away the currently unused DFU file suffix */
|
||||
DiscardFillerBytes(DFU_FILE_SUFFIX_SIZE);
|
||||
}
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
Endpoint_ClearSetupOUT();
|
||||
|
||||
/* Send ZLP to the host to acknowedge the request */
|
||||
Endpoint_ClearSetupIN();
|
||||
|
||||
break;
|
||||
case DFU_UPLOAD:
|
||||
Endpoint_ClearSetupReceived();
|
||||
|
||||
while (!(Endpoint_IsSetupINReady()));
|
||||
|
||||
if (DFU_State != dfuUPLOAD_IDLE)
|
||||
{
|
||||
if ((DFU_State == dfuERROR) && IS_ONEBYTE_COMMAND(SentCommand.Data, 0x01)) // Blank Check
|
||||
{
|
||||
/* Blank checking is performed in the DFU_DNLOAD request - if we get here we've told the host
|
||||
that the memory isn't blank, and the host is requesting the first non-blank address */
|
||||
Endpoint_Write_Word_LE(StartAddr);
|
||||
}
|
||||
else
|
||||
{
|
||||
/* Idle state upload - send response to last issued command */
|
||||
Endpoint_Write_Byte(ResponseByte);
|
||||
}
|
||||
}
|
||||
else
|
||||
{
|
||||
/* Determine the number of bytes remaining in the current block */
|
||||
uint16_t BytesRemaining = ((EndAddr - StartAddr) + 1);
|
||||
|
||||
if (IS_ONEBYTE_COMMAND(SentCommand.Data, 0x00)) // Read FLASH
|
||||
{
|
||||
/* Calculate the number of words to be written from the number of bytes to be written */
|
||||
uint16_t WordsRemaining = (BytesRemaining >> 1);
|
||||
|
||||
union
|
||||
{
|
||||
uint16_t Words[2];
|
||||
uint32_t Long;
|
||||
} CurrFlashAddress = {Words: {StartAddr, Flash64KBPage}};
|
||||
|
||||
while (WordsRemaining--)
|
||||
{
|
||||
/* Check if endpoint is full - if so clear it and wait until ready for next packet */
|
||||
if (Endpoint_BytesInEndpoint() == FIXED_CONTROL_ENDPOINT_SIZE)
|
||||
{
|
||||
Endpoint_ClearSetupIN();
|
||||
while (!(Endpoint_IsSetupINReady()));
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
/* Read the flash word and send it via USB to the host */
|
||||
#if defined(RAMPZ)
|
||||
Endpoint_Write_Word_LE(pgm_read_word_far(CurrFlashAddress.Long));
|
||||
#else
|
||||
Endpoint_Write_Word_LE(pgm_read_word(CurrFlashAddress.Long));
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
/* Adjust counters */
|
||||
CurrFlashAddress.Long += 2;
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
/* Once reading is complete, start address equals the end address */
|
||||
StartAddr = EndAddr;
|
||||
}
|
||||
else if (IS_ONEBYTE_COMMAND(SentCommand.Data, 0x02)) // Read EEPROM
|
||||
{
|
||||
while (BytesRemaining--)
|
||||
{
|
||||
/* Check if endpoint is full - if so clear it and wait until ready for next packet */
|
||||
if (Endpoint_BytesInEndpoint() == FIXED_CONTROL_ENDPOINT_SIZE)
|
||||
{
|
||||
Endpoint_ClearSetupIN();
|
||||
while (!(Endpoint_IsSetupINReady()));
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
/* Read the EEPROM byte and send it via USB to the host */
|
||||
Endpoint_Write_Byte(eeprom_read_byte((uint8_t*)StartAddr));
|
||||
|
||||
/* Adjust counters */
|
||||
StartAddr++;
|
||||
}
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
/* Return to idle state */
|
||||
DFU_State = dfuIDLE;
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
Endpoint_ClearSetupIN();
|
||||
|
||||
/* Send ZLP to the host to acknowedge the request */
|
||||
while (!(Endpoint_IsSetupOUTReceived()));
|
||||
Endpoint_ClearSetupOUT();
|
||||
|
||||
break;
|
||||
case DFU_GETSTATUS:
|
||||
Endpoint_ClearSetupReceived();
|
||||
|
||||
/* Write 8-bit status value */
|
||||
Endpoint_Write_Byte(DFU_Status);
|
||||
|
||||
/* Write 24-bit poll timeout value */
|
||||
Endpoint_Write_Byte(0);
|
||||
Endpoint_Write_Word_LE(0);
|
||||
|
||||
/* Write 8-bit state value */
|
||||
Endpoint_Write_Byte(DFU_State);
|
||||
|
||||
/* Write 8-bit state string ID number */
|
||||
Endpoint_Write_Byte(0);
|
||||
|
||||
Endpoint_ClearSetupIN();
|
||||
|
||||
while (!(Endpoint_IsSetupOUTReceived()));
|
||||
Endpoint_ClearSetupOUT();
|
||||
|
||||
break;
|
||||
case DFU_CLRSTATUS:
|
||||
Endpoint_ClearSetupReceived();
|
||||
|
||||
/* Reset the status value variable to the default OK status */
|
||||
DFU_Status = OK;
|
||||
|
||||
Endpoint_ClearSetupIN();
|
||||
|
||||
break;
|
||||
case DFU_GETSTATE:
|
||||
Endpoint_ClearSetupReceived();
|
||||
|
||||
/* Write the current device state to the endpoint */
|
||||
Endpoint_Write_Byte(DFU_State);
|
||||
|
||||
Endpoint_ClearSetupIN();
|
||||
|
||||
while (!(Endpoint_IsSetupOUTReceived()));
|
||||
Endpoint_ClearSetupOUT();
|
||||
|
||||
break;
|
||||
case DFU_ABORT:
|
||||
Endpoint_ClearSetupReceived();
|
||||
|
||||
/* Reset the current state variable to the default idle state */
|
||||
DFU_State = dfuIDLE;
|
||||
|
||||
Endpoint_ClearSetupIN();
|
||||
|
||||
break;
|
||||
}
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
/** Routine to discard the specified number of bytes from the control endpoint stream. This is used to
|
||||
* discard unused bytes in the stream from the host, including the memory program block suffix.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* \param NumberOfBytes Number of bytes to discard from the host from the control endpoint
|
||||
*/
|
||||
static void DiscardFillerBytes(uint8_t NumberOfBytes)
|
||||
{
|
||||
while (NumberOfBytes--)
|
||||
{
|
||||
if (!(Endpoint_BytesInEndpoint()))
|
||||
{
|
||||
Endpoint_ClearSetupOUT();
|
||||
|
||||
/* Wait until next data packet received */
|
||||
while (!(Endpoint_IsSetupOUTReceived()));
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
Endpoint_Discard_Byte();
|
||||
}
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
/** Routine to process an issued command from the host, via a DFU_DNLOAD request wrapper. This routine ensures
|
||||
* that the command is allowed based on the current secure mode flag value, and passes the command off to the
|
||||
* appropriate handler function.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
static void ProcessBootloaderCommand(void)
|
||||
{
|
||||
/* Check if device is in secure mode */
|
||||
if (IsSecure)
|
||||
{
|
||||
/* Don't process command unless it is a READ or chip erase command */
|
||||
if (!(((SentCommand.Command == COMMAND_WRITE) &&
|
||||
IS_TWOBYTE_COMMAND(SentCommand.Data, 0x00, 0xFF)) ||
|
||||
(SentCommand.Command == COMMAND_READ)))
|
||||
{
|
||||
/* Set the state and status variables to indicate the error */
|
||||
DFU_State = dfuERROR;
|
||||
DFU_Status = errWRITE;
|
||||
|
||||
/* Stall command */
|
||||
Endpoint_StallTransaction();
|
||||
|
||||
/* Don't process the command */
|
||||
return;
|
||||
}
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
/* Dispatch the required command processing routine based on the command type */
|
||||
switch (SentCommand.Command)
|
||||
{
|
||||
case COMMAND_PROG_START:
|
||||
ProcessMemProgCommand();
|
||||
break;
|
||||
case COMMAND_DISP_DATA:
|
||||
ProcessMemReadCommand();
|
||||
break;
|
||||
case COMMAND_WRITE:
|
||||
ProcessWriteCommand();
|
||||
break;
|
||||
case COMMAND_READ:
|
||||
ProcessReadCommand();
|
||||
break;
|
||||
case COMMAND_CHANGE_BASE_ADDR:
|
||||
if (IS_TWOBYTE_COMMAND(SentCommand.Data, 0x03, 0x00)) // Set 64KB flash page command
|
||||
Flash64KBPage = SentCommand.Data[2];
|
||||
|
||||
break;
|
||||
}
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
/** Routine to concatenate the given pair of 16-bit memory start and end addresses from the host, and store them
|
||||
* in the StartAddr and EndAddr global variables.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
static void LoadStartEndAddresses(void)
|
||||
{
|
||||
union
|
||||
{
|
||||
uint8_t Bytes[2];
|
||||
uint16_t Word;
|
||||
} Address[2] = {{Bytes: {SentCommand.Data[2], SentCommand.Data[1]}},
|
||||
{Bytes: {SentCommand.Data[4], SentCommand.Data[3]}}};
|
||||
|
||||
/* Load in the start and ending read addresses from the sent data packet */
|
||||
StartAddr = Address[0].Word;
|
||||
EndAddr = Address[1].Word;
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
/** Handler for a Memory Program command issued by the host. This routine handles the preperations needed
|
||||
* to write subsequent data from the host into the specified memory.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
static void ProcessMemProgCommand(void)
|
||||
{
|
||||
if (IS_ONEBYTE_COMMAND(SentCommand.Data, 0x00) || // Write FLASH command
|
||||
IS_ONEBYTE_COMMAND(SentCommand.Data, 0x01)) // Write EEPROM command
|
||||
{
|
||||
/* Load in the start and ending read addresses */
|
||||
LoadStartEndAddresses();
|
||||
|
||||
/* If FLASH is being written to, we need to pre-erase the first page to write to */
|
||||
if (IS_ONEBYTE_COMMAND(SentCommand.Data, 0x00))
|
||||
{
|
||||
union
|
||||
{
|
||||
uint16_t Words[2];
|
||||
uint32_t Long;
|
||||
} CurrFlashAddress = {Words: {StartAddr, Flash64KBPage}};
|
||||
|
||||
/* Erase the current page's temp buffer */
|
||||
boot_page_erase(CurrFlashAddress.Long);
|
||||
boot_spm_busy_wait();
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
/* Set the state so that the next DNLOAD requests reads in the firmware */
|
||||
DFU_State = dfuDNLOAD_IDLE;
|
||||
}
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
/** Handler for a Memory Read command issued by the host. This routine handles the preperations needed
|
||||
* to read subsequent data from the specified memory out to the host, as well as implementing the memory
|
||||
* blank check command.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
static void ProcessMemReadCommand(void)
|
||||
{
|
||||
if (IS_ONEBYTE_COMMAND(SentCommand.Data, 0x00) || // Read FLASH command
|
||||
IS_ONEBYTE_COMMAND(SentCommand.Data, 0x02)) // Read EEPROM command
|
||||
{
|
||||
/* Load in the start and ending read addresses */
|
||||
LoadStartEndAddresses();
|
||||
|
||||
/* Set the state so that the next UPLOAD requests read out the firmware */
|
||||
DFU_State = dfuUPLOAD_IDLE;
|
||||
}
|
||||
else if (IS_ONEBYTE_COMMAND(SentCommand.Data, 0x01)) // Blank check FLASH command
|
||||
{
|
||||
uint32_t CurrFlashAddress = 0;
|
||||
|
||||
while (CurrFlashAddress < BOOT_START_ADDR)
|
||||
{
|
||||
/* Check if the current byte is not blank */
|
||||
#if defined(RAMPZ)
|
||||
if (pgm_read_byte_far(CurrFlashAddress) != 0xFF)
|
||||
#else
|
||||
if (pgm_read_byte(CurrFlashAddress) != 0xFF)
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
{
|
||||
/* Save the location of the first non-blank byte for response back to the host */
|
||||
Flash64KBPage = (CurrFlashAddress >> 16);
|
||||
StartAddr = CurrFlashAddress;
|
||||
|
||||
/* Set state and status variables to the appropriate error values */
|
||||
DFU_State = dfuERROR;
|
||||
DFU_Status = errCHECK_ERASED;
|
||||
|
||||
break;
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
CurrFlashAddress++;
|
||||
}
|
||||
}
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
/** Handler for a Data Write command issued by the host. This routine handles non-programming commands such as
|
||||
* bootloader exit (both via software jumps and hardware watchdog resets) and flash memory erasure.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
static void ProcessWriteCommand(void)
|
||||
{
|
||||
if (IS_ONEBYTE_COMMAND(SentCommand.Data, 0x03)) // Start application
|
||||
{
|
||||
/* Indicate that the bootloader is terminating */
|
||||
WaitForExit = true;
|
||||
|
||||
/* Check if empty request data array - an empty request after a filled request retains the
|
||||
previous valid request data, but initializes the reset */
|
||||
if (!(SentCommand.DataSize))
|
||||
{
|
||||
if (SentCommand.Data[1] == 0x00) // Start via watchdog
|
||||
{
|
||||
/* Start the watchdog to reset the AVR once the communications are finalized */
|
||||
wdt_enable(WDTO_250MS);
|
||||
}
|
||||
else // Start via jump
|
||||
{
|
||||
/* Load in the jump address into the application start address pointer */
|
||||
union
|
||||
{
|
||||
uint8_t Bytes[2];
|
||||
AppPtr_t FuncPtr;
|
||||
} Address = {Bytes: {SentCommand.Data[4], SentCommand.Data[3]}};
|
||||
|
||||
AppStartPtr = Address.FuncPtr;
|
||||
|
||||
/* Set the flag to terminate the bootloader at next opportunity */
|
||||
RunBootloader = false;
|
||||
}
|
||||
}
|
||||
}
|
||||
else if (IS_TWOBYTE_COMMAND(SentCommand.Data, 0x00, 0xFF)) // Erase flash
|
||||
{
|
||||
uint32_t CurrFlashAddress = 0;
|
||||
|
||||
/* Clear the application section of flash */
|
||||
while (CurrFlashAddress < BOOT_START_ADDR)
|
||||
{
|
||||
boot_page_erase(CurrFlashAddress);
|
||||
boot_spm_busy_wait();
|
||||
boot_page_write(CurrFlashAddress);
|
||||
boot_spm_busy_wait();
|
||||
|
||||
CurrFlashAddress += SPM_PAGESIZE;
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
/* Re-enable the RWW section of flash as writing to the flash locks it out */
|
||||
boot_rww_enable();
|
||||
|
||||
/* Memory has been erased, reset the security bit so that programming/reading is allowed */
|
||||
IsSecure = false;
|
||||
}
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
/** Handler for a Data Read command issued by the host. This routine handles bootloader information retrieval
|
||||
* commands such as device signature and bootloader version retrieval.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
static void ProcessReadCommand(void)
|
||||
{
|
||||
const uint8_t BootloaderInfo[3] = {BOOTLOADER_VERSION, BOOTLOADER_ID_BYTE1, BOOTLOADER_ID_BYTE2};
|
||||
const uint8_t SignatureInfo[3] = {SIGNATURE_BYTE_1, SIGNATURE_BYTE_2, SIGNATURE_BYTE_3};
|
||||
|
||||
uint8_t DataIndexToRead = SentCommand.Data[1];
|
||||
|
||||
if (IS_ONEBYTE_COMMAND(SentCommand.Data, 0x00)) // Read bootloader info
|
||||
{
|
||||
ResponseByte = BootloaderInfo[DataIndexToRead];
|
||||
}
|
||||
else if (IS_ONEBYTE_COMMAND(SentCommand.Data, 0x01)) // Read signature byte
|
||||
{
|
||||
ResponseByte = SignatureInfo[DataIndexToRead - 0x30];
|
||||
}
|
||||
}
|
@ -0,0 +1,199 @@
|
||||
/*
|
||||
LUFA Library
|
||||
Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2009.
|
||||
|
||||
dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com
|
||||
www.fourwalledcubicle.com
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
/*
|
||||
Copyright 2009 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com)
|
||||
|
||||
Permission to use, copy, modify, and distribute this software
|
||||
and its documentation for any purpose and without fee is hereby
|
||||
granted, provided that the above copyright notice appear in all
|
||||
copies and that both that the copyright notice and this
|
||||
permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting
|
||||
documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in
|
||||
advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the
|
||||
software without specific, written prior permission.
|
||||
|
||||
The author disclaim all warranties with regard to this
|
||||
software, including all implied warranties of merchantability
|
||||
and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any
|
||||
special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages
|
||||
whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether
|
||||
in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action,
|
||||
arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of
|
||||
this software.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
/** \file
|
||||
*
|
||||
* Header file for BootloaderDFU.c.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
#ifndef _BOOTLOADER_H_
|
||||
#define _BOOTLOADER_H_
|
||||
|
||||
/* Includes: */
|
||||
#include <avr/io.h>
|
||||
#include <avr/wdt.h>
|
||||
#include <avr/boot.h>
|
||||
#include <avr/eeprom.h>
|
||||
#include <stdbool.h>
|
||||
|
||||
#include "Descriptors.h"
|
||||
|
||||
#include <LUFA/Drivers/USB/USB.h> // USB Functionality
|
||||
|
||||
/* Macros: */
|
||||
/** Major bootloader version number. */
|
||||
#define BOOTLOADER_VERSION_MINOR 2
|
||||
|
||||
/** Minor bootloader version number. */
|
||||
#define BOOTLOADER_VERSION_REV 0
|
||||
|
||||
/** Complete bootloder version number expressed as a packed byte, constructed from the
|
||||
* two individual bootloader version macros.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
#define BOOTLOADER_VERSION ((BOOTLOADER_VERSION_MINOR << 4) | BOOTLOADER_VERSION_REV)
|
||||
|
||||
/** First byte of the bootloader identification bytes, used to identify a device's bootloader. */
|
||||
#define BOOTLOADER_ID_BYTE1 0xDC
|
||||
|
||||
/** Second byte of the bootloader identification bytes, used to identify a device's bootloader. */
|
||||
#define BOOTLOADER_ID_BYTE2 0xFB
|
||||
|
||||
/** Convenience macro, used to determine if the issued command is the given one-byte long command.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* \param dataarr Command byte array to check against
|
||||
* \param cb1 First command byte to check
|
||||
*/
|
||||
#define IS_ONEBYTE_COMMAND(dataarr, cb1) (dataarr[0] == cb1)
|
||||
|
||||
/** Convenience macro, used to determine if the issued command is the given two-byte long command.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* \param dataarr Command byte array to check against
|
||||
* \param cb1 First command byte to check
|
||||
* \param cb2 Second command byte to check
|
||||
*/
|
||||
#define IS_TWOBYTE_COMMAND(dataarr, cb1, cb2) ((dataarr[0] == cb1) && (dataarr[1] == cb2))
|
||||
|
||||
/** Length of the DFU file suffix block, appended to the end of each complete memory write command.
|
||||
* The DFU file suffix is currently unused (but is designed to give extra file information, such as
|
||||
* a CRC of the complete firmware for error checking) and so is discarded.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
#define DFU_FILE_SUFFIX_SIZE 16
|
||||
|
||||
/** Length of the DFU file filler block, appended to the start of each complete memory write command.
|
||||
* Filler bytes are added to the start of each complete memory write command, and must be discarded.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
#define DFU_FILLER_BYTES_SIZE 26
|
||||
|
||||
/** DFU class command request to detatch from the host. */
|
||||
#define DFU_DETATCH 0x00
|
||||
|
||||
/** DFU class command request to send data from the host to the bootloader. */
|
||||
#define DFU_DNLOAD 0x01
|
||||
|
||||
/** DFU class command request to send data from the bootloader to the host. */
|
||||
#define DFU_UPLOAD 0x02
|
||||
|
||||
/** DFU class command request to get the current DFU status and state from the bootloader. */
|
||||
#define DFU_GETSTATUS 0x03
|
||||
|
||||
/** DFU class command request to reset the current DFU status and state variables to their defaults. */
|
||||
#define DFU_CLRSTATUS 0x04
|
||||
|
||||
/** DFU class command request to get the current DFU state of the bootloader. */
|
||||
#define DFU_GETSTATE 0x05
|
||||
|
||||
/** DFU class command request to abort the current multi-request transfer and return to the dfuIDLE state. */
|
||||
#define DFU_ABORT 0x06
|
||||
|
||||
/** DFU command to begin programming the device's memory. */
|
||||
#define COMMAND_PROG_START 0x01
|
||||
|
||||
/** DFU command to begin reading the device's memory. */
|
||||
#define COMMAND_DISP_DATA 0x03
|
||||
|
||||
/** DFU command to issue a write command. */
|
||||
#define COMMAND_WRITE 0x04
|
||||
|
||||
/** DFU command to issue a read command. */
|
||||
#define COMMAND_READ 0x05
|
||||
|
||||
/** DFU command to issue a memory base address change command, to set the current 64KB flash page
|
||||
* that subsequent flash operations should use. */
|
||||
#define COMMAND_CHANGE_BASE_ADDR 0x06
|
||||
|
||||
/* Type Defines: */
|
||||
/** Type define for a non-returning function pointer to the loaded application. */
|
||||
typedef void (*AppPtr_t)(void) ATTR_NO_RETURN;
|
||||
|
||||
/** Type define for a strucuture containing a complete DFU command issued by the host. */
|
||||
typedef struct
|
||||
{
|
||||
uint8_t Command; /**< Single byte command to perform, one of the COMMAND_* macro values */
|
||||
uint8_t Data[5]; /**< Command parameters */
|
||||
uint16_t DataSize; /**< Size of the command parameters */
|
||||
} DFU_Command_t;
|
||||
|
||||
/* Enums: */
|
||||
/** DFU bootloader states. Refer to the DFU class specification for information on each state. */
|
||||
enum DFU_State_t
|
||||
{
|
||||
appIDLE = 0,
|
||||
appDETACH = 1,
|
||||
dfuIDLE = 2,
|
||||
dfuDNLOAD_SYNC = 3,
|
||||
dfuDNBUSY = 4,
|
||||
dfuDNLOAD_IDLE = 5,
|
||||
dfuMANIFEST_SYNC = 6,
|
||||
dfuMANIFEST = 7,
|
||||
dfuMANIFEST_WAIT_RESET = 8,
|
||||
dfuUPLOAD_IDLE = 9,
|
||||
dfuERROR = 10
|
||||
};
|
||||
|
||||
/** DFU command status error codes. Refer to the DFU class specification for information on each error code. */
|
||||
enum DFU_Status_t
|
||||
{
|
||||
OK = 0,
|
||||
errTARGET = 1,
|
||||
errFILE = 2,
|
||||
errWRITE = 3,
|
||||
errERASE = 4,
|
||||
errCHECK_ERASED = 5,
|
||||
errPROG = 6,
|
||||
errVERIFY = 7,
|
||||
errADDRESS = 8,
|
||||
errNOTDONE = 9,
|
||||
errFIRMWARE = 10,
|
||||
errVENDOR = 11,
|
||||
errUSBR = 12,
|
||||
errPOR = 13,
|
||||
errUNKNOWN = 14,
|
||||
errSTALLEDPKT = 15
|
||||
};
|
||||
|
||||
/* Event Handlers: */
|
||||
/** Indicates that this module will catch the USB_Disconnect event when thrown by the library. */
|
||||
HANDLES_EVENT(USB_Disconnect);
|
||||
|
||||
/** Indicates that this module will catch the USB_UnhandledControlPacket event when thrown by the library. */
|
||||
HANDLES_EVENT(USB_UnhandledControlPacket);
|
||||
|
||||
/* Function Prototypes: */
|
||||
#if defined(INCLUDE_FROM_BOOTLOADER_C)
|
||||
static void DiscardFillerBytes(uint8_t NumberOfBytes);
|
||||
static void ProcessBootloaderCommand(void);
|
||||
static void LoadStartEndAddresses(void);
|
||||
static void ProcessMemProgCommand(void);
|
||||
static void ProcessMemReadCommand(void);
|
||||
static void ProcessWriteCommand(void);
|
||||
static void ProcessReadCommand(void);
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
#endif
|
@ -0,0 +1,52 @@
|
||||
/** \file
|
||||
*
|
||||
* This file contains special DoxyGen information for the generation of the main page and other special
|
||||
* documentation pages. It is not a project source file.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
/** \mainpage DFU Class USB AVR Bootloader
|
||||
*
|
||||
* This bootloader enumerates to the host as a DFU Class device, allowing for DFU-compatible programming
|
||||
* software to load firmware onto the AVR.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* This bootloader is compatible with Atmel's FLIP application. However, it requires the use of Atmel's
|
||||
* DFU drivers. You will need to install Atmel's DFU drivers prior to using this bootloader.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* As an open-source option, this bootloader is also compatible with the Linux Atmel USB DFU Programmer
|
||||
* software, available for download at http://sourceforge.net/projects/dfu-programmer/.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* If SECURE_MODE is defined as true, upon startup the bootloader will be locked, with only the chip erase
|
||||
* function available (similar to Atmel's DFU bootloader). If SECURE_MODE is defined as false, all functions
|
||||
* are usable on startup without the prerequisite firmware erase.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* Out of the box this bootloader builds for the USB1287, and should fit into 4KB of bootloader space. If
|
||||
* you wish to enlarge this space and/or change the AVR model, you will need to edit the BOOT_START and MCU
|
||||
* values in the accompanying makefile.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* <b>NOTE:</b> This device spoofs Atmel's DFU Bootloader USB VID and PID so that the Atmel DFU bootloader
|
||||
* drivers included with FLIP will work. If you do not wish to use Atmel's ID codes, please
|
||||
* manually change them in Descriptors.c and alter your driver's INF file accordingly.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* <table>
|
||||
* <tr>
|
||||
* <td><b>USB Mode:</b></td>
|
||||
* <td>Device</td>
|
||||
* </tr>
|
||||
* <tr>
|
||||
* <td><b>USB Class:</b></td>
|
||||
* <td>Device Firmware Update Class (DFU)</td>
|
||||
* </tr>
|
||||
* <tr>
|
||||
* <td><b>USB Subclass:</b></td>
|
||||
* <td>None</td>
|
||||
* </tr>
|
||||
* <tr>
|
||||
* <td><b>Relevant Standards:</b></td>
|
||||
* <td>USBIF DFU Class Standard, Atmel USB Bootloader Datasheet</td>
|
||||
* </tr>
|
||||
* <tr>
|
||||
* <td><b>Usable Speeds:</b></td>
|
||||
* <td>Full Speed Mode</td>
|
||||
* </tr>
|
||||
* </table>
|
||||
*/
|
@ -0,0 +1,181 @@
|
||||
/*
|
||||
LUFA Library
|
||||
Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2009.
|
||||
|
||||
dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com
|
||||
www.fourwalledcubicle.com
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
/*
|
||||
Copyright 2009 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com)
|
||||
|
||||
Permission to use, copy, modify, and distribute this software
|
||||
and its documentation for any purpose and without fee is hereby
|
||||
granted, provided that the above copyright notice appear in all
|
||||
copies and that both that the copyright notice and this
|
||||
permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting
|
||||
documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in
|
||||
advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the
|
||||
software without specific, written prior permission.
|
||||
|
||||
The author disclaim all warranties with regard to this
|
||||
software, including all implied warranties of merchantability
|
||||
and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any
|
||||
special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages
|
||||
whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether
|
||||
in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action,
|
||||
arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of
|
||||
this software.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
/** \file
|
||||
*
|
||||
* USB Device Descriptors, for library use when in USB device mode. Descriptors are special
|
||||
* computer-readable structures which the host requests upon device enumeration, to determine
|
||||
* the device's capabilities and functions.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
#include "Descriptors.h"
|
||||
|
||||
/** Device descriptor structure. This descriptor, located in FLASH memory, describes the overall
|
||||
* device characteristics, including the supported USB version, control endpoint size and the
|
||||
* number of device configurations. The descriptor is read out by the USB host when the enumeration
|
||||
* process begins.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
USB_Descriptor_Device_t DeviceDescriptor =
|
||||
{
|
||||
Header: {Size: sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Device_t), Type: DTYPE_Device},
|
||||
|
||||
USBSpecification: VERSION_BCD(01.10),
|
||||
Class: 0x00,
|
||||
SubClass: 0x00,
|
||||
Protocol: 0x00,
|
||||
|
||||
Endpoint0Size: FIXED_CONTROL_ENDPOINT_SIZE,
|
||||
|
||||
VendorID: 0x03EB,
|
||||
ProductID: PRODUCT_ID_CODE,
|
||||
ReleaseNumber: 0x0000,
|
||||
|
||||
ManufacturerStrIndex: NO_DESCRIPTOR,
|
||||
ProductStrIndex: 0x01,
|
||||
SerialNumStrIndex: NO_DESCRIPTOR,
|
||||
|
||||
NumberOfConfigurations: 1
|
||||
};
|
||||
|
||||
/** Configuration descriptor structure. This descriptor, located in FLASH memory, describes the usage
|
||||
* of the device in one of its supported configurations, including information about any device interfaces
|
||||
* and endpoints. The descriptor is read out by the USB host during the enumeration process when selecting
|
||||
* a configuration so that the host may correctly communicate with the USB device.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
USB_Descriptor_Configuration_t ConfigurationDescriptor =
|
||||
{
|
||||
Config:
|
||||
{
|
||||
Header: {Size: sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Configuration_Header_t), Type: DTYPE_Configuration},
|
||||
|
||||
TotalConfigurationSize: sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Configuration_t),
|
||||
TotalInterfaces: 1,
|
||||
|
||||
ConfigurationNumber: 1,
|
||||
ConfigurationStrIndex: NO_DESCRIPTOR,
|
||||
|
||||
ConfigAttributes: (USB_CONFIG_ATTR_BUSPOWERED | USB_CONFIG_ATTR_SELFPOWERED),
|
||||
|
||||
MaxPowerConsumption: USB_CONFIG_POWER_MA(100)
|
||||
},
|
||||
|
||||
DFUInterface:
|
||||
{
|
||||
Header: {Size: sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Interface_t), Type: DTYPE_Interface},
|
||||
|
||||
InterfaceNumber: 0,
|
||||
AlternateSetting: 0,
|
||||
|
||||
TotalEndpoints: 0,
|
||||
|
||||
Class: 0xFE,
|
||||
SubClass: 0x01,
|
||||
Protocol: 0x02,
|
||||
|
||||
InterfaceStrIndex: NO_DESCRIPTOR
|
||||
},
|
||||
|
||||
DFUFunctional:
|
||||
{
|
||||
Header: {Size: sizeof(USB_DFU_Functional_Descriptor_t), Type: DTYPE_DFUFunctional},
|
||||
|
||||
Attributes: (ATTR_CAN_UPLOAD | ATTR_CAN_DOWNLOAD),
|
||||
|
||||
DetatchTimeout: 0x0000,
|
||||
TransferSize: 0x0c00,
|
||||
|
||||
DFUSpecification: VERSION_BCD(01.01)
|
||||
}
|
||||
};
|
||||
|
||||
/** Language descriptor structure. This descriptor, located in FLASH memory, is returned when the host requests
|
||||
* the string descriptor with index 0 (the first index). It is actually an array of 16-bit integers, which indicate
|
||||
* via the language ID table available at USB.org what languages the device supports for its string descriptors.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
USB_Descriptor_String_t LanguageString =
|
||||
{
|
||||
Header: {Size: USB_STRING_LEN(1), Type: DTYPE_String},
|
||||
|
||||
UnicodeString: {LANGUAGE_ID_ENG}
|
||||
};
|
||||
|
||||
/** Product descriptor string. This is a Unicode string containing the product's details in human readable form,
|
||||
* and is read out upon request by the host when the appropriate string ID is requested, listed in the Device
|
||||
* Descriptor.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
USB_Descriptor_String_t ProductString =
|
||||
{
|
||||
Header: {Size: USB_STRING_LEN(18), Type: DTYPE_String},
|
||||
|
||||
UnicodeString: L"AVR DFU Bootloader"
|
||||
};
|
||||
|
||||
/** This function is called by the library when in device mode, and must be overridden (see StdDescriptors.h
|
||||
* documentation) by the application code so that the address and size of a requested descriptor can be given
|
||||
* to the USB library. When the device recieves a Get Descriptor request on the control endpoint, this function
|
||||
* is called so that the descriptor details can be passed back and the appropriate descriptor sent back to the
|
||||
* USB host.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
uint16_t USB_GetDescriptor(const uint16_t wValue, const uint8_t wIndex, void** const DescriptorAddress)
|
||||
{
|
||||
const uint8_t DescriptorType = (wValue >> 8);
|
||||
const uint8_t DescriptorNumber = (wValue & 0xFF);
|
||||
|
||||
void* Address = NULL;
|
||||
uint16_t Size = NO_DESCRIPTOR;
|
||||
|
||||
switch (DescriptorType)
|
||||
{
|
||||
case DTYPE_Device:
|
||||
Address = DESCRIPTOR_ADDRESS(DeviceDescriptor);
|
||||
Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Device_t);
|
||||
break;
|
||||
case DTYPE_Configuration:
|
||||
Address = DESCRIPTOR_ADDRESS(ConfigurationDescriptor);
|
||||
Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Configuration_t);
|
||||
break;
|
||||
case DTYPE_String:
|
||||
if (!(DescriptorNumber))
|
||||
{
|
||||
Address = DESCRIPTOR_ADDRESS(LanguageString);
|
||||
Size = LanguageString.Header.Size;
|
||||
}
|
||||
else
|
||||
{
|
||||
Address = DESCRIPTOR_ADDRESS(ProductString);
|
||||
Size = ProductString.Header.Size;
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
break;
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
*DescriptorAddress = Address;
|
||||
return Size;
|
||||
}
|
@ -0,0 +1,166 @@
|
||||
/*
|
||||
LUFA Library
|
||||
Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2009.
|
||||
|
||||
dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com
|
||||
www.fourwalledcubicle.com
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
/*
|
||||
Copyright 2009 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com)
|
||||
|
||||
Permission to use, copy, modify, and distribute this software
|
||||
and its documentation for any purpose and without fee is hereby
|
||||
granted, provided that the above copyright notice appear in all
|
||||
copies and that both that the copyright notice and this
|
||||
permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting
|
||||
documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in
|
||||
advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the
|
||||
software without specific, written prior permission.
|
||||
|
||||
The author disclaim all warranties with regard to this
|
||||
software, including all implied warranties of merchantability
|
||||
and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any
|
||||
special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages
|
||||
whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether
|
||||
in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action,
|
||||
arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of
|
||||
this software.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
/** \file
|
||||
*
|
||||
* Header file for Descriptors.c.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
#ifndef _DESCRIPTORS_H_
|
||||
#define _DESCRIPTORS_H_
|
||||
|
||||
/* Includes: */
|
||||
#include <LUFA/Drivers/USB/USB.h>
|
||||
|
||||
/* Macros: */
|
||||
/** Descriptor type value for a DFU class functional descriptor. */
|
||||
#define DTYPE_DFUFunctional 0x21
|
||||
|
||||
/** DFU attribute mask, indicating that the DFU device will detach and re-attach when a DFU_DETACH
|
||||
* command is issued, rather than the host issing a USB Reset.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
#define ATTR_WILL_DETATCH (1 << 3)
|
||||
|
||||
/** DFU attribute mask, indicating that the DFU device can communicate during the manefestation phase
|
||||
* (memory programming phase).
|
||||
*/
|
||||
#define ATTR_MANEFESTATION_TOLLERANT (1 << 2)
|
||||
|
||||
/** DFU attribute mask, indicating that the DFU device can accept DFU_UPLOAD requests to send data from
|
||||
* the device to the host.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
#define ATTR_CAN_UPLOAD (1 << 1)
|
||||
|
||||
/** DFU attribute mask, indicating that the DFU device can accept DFU_DNLOAD requests to send data from
|
||||
* the host to the device.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
#define ATTR_CAN_DOWNLOAD (1 << 0)
|
||||
|
||||
#if defined(__AVR_AT90USB1286__)
|
||||
#define PRODUCT_ID_CODE 0x2FFB
|
||||
|
||||
#define SIGNATURE_BYTE_1 0x1E
|
||||
#define SIGNATURE_BYTE_2 0x97
|
||||
#define SIGNATURE_BYTE_3 0x82
|
||||
#elif defined(__AVR_AT90USB1287__)
|
||||
#define PRODUCT_ID_CODE 0x2FFB
|
||||
|
||||
#define SIGNATURE_BYTE_1 0x1E
|
||||
#define SIGNATURE_BYTE_2 0x97
|
||||
#define SIGNATURE_BYTE_3 0x82
|
||||
#elif defined(__AVR_AT90USB646__)
|
||||
#define PRODUCT_ID_CODE 0x2FF9
|
||||
|
||||
#define SIGNATURE_BYTE_1 0x1E
|
||||
#define SIGNATURE_BYTE_2 0x96
|
||||
#define SIGNATURE_BYTE_3 0x82
|
||||
#elif defined(__AVR_AT90USB647__)
|
||||
#define PRODUCT_ID_CODE 0x2FF9
|
||||
|
||||
#define SIGNATURE_BYTE_1 0x1E
|
||||
#define SIGNATURE_BYTE_2 0x96
|
||||
#define SIGNATURE_BYTE_3 0x82
|
||||
#elif defined(__AVR_AT90USB162__)
|
||||
#define PRODUCT_ID_CODE 0x2FFA
|
||||
|
||||
#define SIGNATURE_BYTE_1 0x1E
|
||||
#define SIGNATURE_BYTE_2 0x94
|
||||
#define SIGNATURE_BYTE_3 0x82
|
||||
#elif defined(__AVR_AT90USB82__)
|
||||
#define PRODUCT_ID_CODE 0x2FF7
|
||||
|
||||
#define SIGNATURE_BYTE_1 0x1E
|
||||
#define SIGNATURE_BYTE_2 0x94
|
||||
#define SIGNATURE_BYTE_3 0x82
|
||||
#elif defined(__AVR_ATmega32U6__)
|
||||
#define PRODUCT_ID_CODE 0x2FFB
|
||||
|
||||
#define SIGNATURE_BYTE_1 0x1E
|
||||
#define SIGNATURE_BYTE_2 0x95
|
||||
#define SIGNATURE_BYTE_3 0x88
|
||||
#elif defined(__AVR_ATmega32U4__)
|
||||
#define PRODUCT_ID_CODE 0x2FF4
|
||||
|
||||
#define SIGNATURE_BYTE_1 0x1E
|
||||
#define SIGNATURE_BYTE_2 0x95
|
||||
#define SIGNATURE_BYTE_3 0x87
|
||||
#elif defined(__AVR_ATmega16U4__)
|
||||
#define PRODUCT_ID_CODE 0x2FF3
|
||||
|
||||
#define SIGNATURE_BYTE_1 0x1E
|
||||
#define SIGNATURE_BYTE_2 0x94
|
||||
#define SIGNATURE_BYTE_3 0x88
|
||||
#else
|
||||
#error The selected AVR part is not currently supported by this bootloader.
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
#if !defined(PRODUCT_ID_CODE)
|
||||
#error Current AVR model is not supported by this bootloader.
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
/* Type Defines: */
|
||||
/** Type define for a DFU class function descriptor. This descriptor gives DFU class information
|
||||
* to the host when read, indicating the DFU device's capabilities.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
typedef struct
|
||||
{
|
||||
USB_Descriptor_Header_t Header; /**< Standard descriptor header structure */
|
||||
|
||||
uint8_t Attributes; /**< DFU device attributes, a mask comprising of the
|
||||
* ATTR_* macros listed in this source file
|
||||
*/
|
||||
uint16_t DetatchTimeout; /**< Timeout in milliseconds between a USB_DETACH
|
||||
* command being issued and the device detaching
|
||||
* from the USB bus
|
||||
*/
|
||||
uint16_t TransferSize; /**< Maximum number of bytes the DFU device can accept
|
||||
* from the host in a transaction
|
||||
*/
|
||||
uint16_t DFUSpecification; /**< BCD packed DFU specification number this DFU
|
||||
* device complies with
|
||||
*/
|
||||
} USB_DFU_Functional_Descriptor_t;
|
||||
|
||||
/** Type define for the device configuration descriptor structure. This must be defined in the
|
||||
* application code, as the configuration descriptor contains several sub-descriptors which
|
||||
* vary between devices, and which describe the device's usage to the host.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
typedef struct
|
||||
{
|
||||
USB_Descriptor_Configuration_Header_t Config;
|
||||
USB_Descriptor_Interface_t DFUInterface;
|
||||
USB_DFU_Functional_Descriptor_t DFUFunctional;
|
||||
} USB_Descriptor_Configuration_t;
|
||||
|
||||
/* Function Prototypes: */
|
||||
uint16_t USB_GetDescriptor(const uint16_t wValue, const uint8_t wIndex, void** const DescriptorAddress)
|
||||
ATTR_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(3);
|
||||
|
||||
#endif
|
@ -0,0 +1,1485 @@
|
||||
# Doxyfile 1.5.7.1
|
||||
|
||||
# This file describes the settings to be used by the documentation system
|
||||
# doxygen (www.doxygen.org) for a project
|
||||
#
|
||||
# All text after a hash (#) is considered a comment and will be ignored
|
||||
# The format is:
|
||||
# TAG = value [value, ...]
|
||||
# For lists items can also be appended using:
|
||||
# TAG += value [value, ...]
|
||||
# Values that contain spaces should be placed between quotes (" ")
|
||||
|
||||
#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
|
||||
# Project related configuration options
|
||||
#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
|
||||
|
||||
# This tag specifies the encoding used for all characters in the config file
|
||||
# that follow. The default is UTF-8 which is also the encoding used for all
|
||||
# text before the first occurrence of this tag. Doxygen uses libiconv (or the
|
||||
# iconv built into libc) for the transcoding. See
|
||||
# http://www.gnu.org/software/libiconv for the list of possible encodings.
|
||||
|
||||
DOXYFILE_ENCODING = UTF-8
|
||||
|
||||
# The PROJECT_NAME tag is a single word (or a sequence of words surrounded
|
||||
# by quotes) that should identify the project.
|
||||
|
||||
PROJECT_NAME = "LUFA Library - DFU Class Bootloader"
|
||||
|
||||
# The PROJECT_NUMBER tag can be used to enter a project or revision number.
|
||||
# This could be handy for archiving the generated documentation or
|
||||
# if some version control system is used.
|
||||
|
||||
PROJECT_NUMBER = 0.0.0
|
||||
|
||||
# The OUTPUT_DIRECTORY tag is used to specify the (relative or absolute)
|
||||
# base path where the generated documentation will be put.
|
||||
# If a relative path is entered, it will be relative to the location
|
||||
# where doxygen was started. If left blank the current directory will be used.
|
||||
|
||||
OUTPUT_DIRECTORY = ./Documentation/
|
||||
|
||||
# If the CREATE_SUBDIRS tag is set to YES, then doxygen will create
|
||||
# 4096 sub-directories (in 2 levels) under the output directory of each output
|
||||
# format and will distribute the generated files over these directories.
|
||||
# Enabling this option can be useful when feeding doxygen a huge amount of
|
||||
# source files, where putting all generated files in the same directory would
|
||||
# otherwise cause performance problems for the file system.
|
||||
|
||||
CREATE_SUBDIRS = YES
|
||||
|
||||
# The OUTPUT_LANGUAGE tag is used to specify the language in which all
|
||||
# documentation generated by doxygen is written. Doxygen will use this
|
||||
# information to generate all constant output in the proper language.
|
||||
# The default language is English, other supported languages are:
|
||||
# Afrikaans, Arabic, Brazilian, Catalan, Chinese, Chinese-Traditional,
|
||||
# Croatian, Czech, Danish, Dutch, Farsi, Finnish, French, German, Greek,
|
||||
# Hungarian, Italian, Japanese, Japanese-en (Japanese with English messages),
|
||||
# Korean, Korean-en, Lithuanian, Norwegian, Macedonian, Persian, Polish,
|
||||
# Portuguese, Romanian, Russian, Serbian, Serbian-Cyrilic, Slovak, Slovene,
|
||||
# Spanish, Swedish, and Ukrainian.
|
||||
|
||||
OUTPUT_LANGUAGE = English
|
||||
|
||||
# If the BRIEF_MEMBER_DESC tag is set to YES (the default) Doxygen will
|
||||
# include brief member descriptions after the members that are listed in
|
||||
# the file and class documentation (similar to JavaDoc).
|
||||
# Set to NO to disable this.
|
||||
|
||||
BRIEF_MEMBER_DESC = YES
|
||||
|
||||
# If the REPEAT_BRIEF tag is set to YES (the default) Doxygen will prepend
|
||||
# the brief description of a member or function before the detailed description.
|
||||
# Note: if both HIDE_UNDOC_MEMBERS and BRIEF_MEMBER_DESC are set to NO, the
|
||||
# brief descriptions will be completely suppressed.
|
||||
|
||||
REPEAT_BRIEF = YES
|
||||
|
||||
# This tag implements a quasi-intelligent brief description abbreviator
|
||||
# that is used to form the text in various listings. Each string
|
||||
# in this list, if found as the leading text of the brief description, will be
|
||||
# stripped from the text and the result after processing the whole list, is
|
||||
# used as the annotated text. Otherwise, the brief description is used as-is.
|
||||
# If left blank, the following values are used ("$name" is automatically
|
||||
# replaced with the name of the entity): "The $name class" "The $name widget"
|
||||
# "The $name file" "is" "provides" "specifies" "contains"
|
||||
# "represents" "a" "an" "the"
|
||||
|
||||
ABBREVIATE_BRIEF = "The $name class" \
|
||||
"The $name widget" \
|
||||
"The $name file" \
|
||||
is \
|
||||
provides \
|
||||
specifies \
|
||||
contains \
|
||||
represents \
|
||||
a \
|
||||
an \
|
||||
the
|
||||
|
||||
# If the ALWAYS_DETAILED_SEC and REPEAT_BRIEF tags are both set to YES then
|
||||
# Doxygen will generate a detailed section even if there is only a brief
|
||||
# description.
|
||||
|
||||
ALWAYS_DETAILED_SEC = NO
|
||||
|
||||
# If the INLINE_INHERITED_MEMB tag is set to YES, doxygen will show all
|
||||
# inherited members of a class in the documentation of that class as if those
|
||||
# members were ordinary class members. Constructors, destructors and assignment
|
||||
# operators of the base classes will not be shown.
|
||||
|
||||
INLINE_INHERITED_MEMB = NO
|
||||
|
||||
# If the FULL_PATH_NAMES tag is set to YES then Doxygen will prepend the full
|
||||
# path before files name in the file list and in the header files. If set
|
||||
# to NO the shortest path that makes the file name unique will be used.
|
||||
|
||||
FULL_PATH_NAMES = YES
|
||||
|
||||
# If the FULL_PATH_NAMES tag is set to YES then the STRIP_FROM_PATH tag
|
||||
# can be used to strip a user-defined part of the path. Stripping is
|
||||
# only done if one of the specified strings matches the left-hand part of
|
||||
# the path. The tag can be used to show relative paths in the file list.
|
||||
# If left blank the directory from which doxygen is run is used as the
|
||||
# path to strip.
|
||||
|
||||
STRIP_FROM_PATH =
|
||||
|
||||
# The STRIP_FROM_INC_PATH tag can be used to strip a user-defined part of
|
||||
# the path mentioned in the documentation of a class, which tells
|
||||
# the reader which header file to include in order to use a class.
|
||||
# If left blank only the name of the header file containing the class
|
||||
# definition is used. Otherwise one should specify the include paths that
|
||||
# are normally passed to the compiler using the -I flag.
|
||||
|
||||
STRIP_FROM_INC_PATH =
|
||||
|
||||
# If the SHORT_NAMES tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate much shorter
|
||||
# (but less readable) file names. This can be useful is your file systems
|
||||
# doesn't support long names like on DOS, Mac, or CD-ROM.
|
||||
|
||||
SHORT_NAMES = YES
|
||||
|
||||
# If the JAVADOC_AUTOBRIEF tag is set to YES then Doxygen
|
||||
# will interpret the first line (until the first dot) of a JavaDoc-style
|
||||
# comment as the brief description. If set to NO, the JavaDoc
|
||||
# comments will behave just like regular Qt-style comments
|
||||
# (thus requiring an explicit @brief command for a brief description.)
|
||||
|
||||
JAVADOC_AUTOBRIEF = NO
|
||||
|
||||
# If the QT_AUTOBRIEF tag is set to YES then Doxygen will
|
||||
# interpret the first line (until the first dot) of a Qt-style
|
||||
# comment as the brief description. If set to NO, the comments
|
||||
# will behave just like regular Qt-style comments (thus requiring
|
||||
# an explicit \brief command for a brief description.)
|
||||
|
||||
QT_AUTOBRIEF = NO
|
||||
|
||||
# The MULTILINE_CPP_IS_BRIEF tag can be set to YES to make Doxygen
|
||||
# treat a multi-line C++ special comment block (i.e. a block of //! or ///
|
||||
# comments) as a brief description. This used to be the default behaviour.
|
||||
# The new default is to treat a multi-line C++ comment block as a detailed
|
||||
# description. Set this tag to YES if you prefer the old behaviour instead.
|
||||
|
||||
MULTILINE_CPP_IS_BRIEF = NO
|
||||
|
||||
# If the INHERIT_DOCS tag is set to YES (the default) then an undocumented
|
||||
# member inherits the documentation from any documented member that it
|
||||
# re-implements.
|
||||
|
||||
INHERIT_DOCS = YES
|
||||
|
||||
# If the SEPARATE_MEMBER_PAGES tag is set to YES, then doxygen will produce
|
||||
# a new page for each member. If set to NO, the documentation of a member will
|
||||
# be part of the file/class/namespace that contains it.
|
||||
|
||||
SEPARATE_MEMBER_PAGES = NO
|
||||
|
||||
# The TAB_SIZE tag can be used to set the number of spaces in a tab.
|
||||
# Doxygen uses this value to replace tabs by spaces in code fragments.
|
||||
|
||||
TAB_SIZE = 4
|
||||
|
||||
# This tag can be used to specify a number of aliases that acts
|
||||
# as commands in the documentation. An alias has the form "name=value".
|
||||
# For example adding "sideeffect=\par Side Effects:\n" will allow you to
|
||||
# put the command \sideeffect (or @sideeffect) in the documentation, which
|
||||
# will result in a user-defined paragraph with heading "Side Effects:".
|
||||
# You can put \n's in the value part of an alias to insert newlines.
|
||||
|
||||
ALIASES =
|
||||
|
||||
# Set the OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_FOR_C tag to YES if your project consists of C
|
||||
# sources only. Doxygen will then generate output that is more tailored for C.
|
||||
# For instance, some of the names that are used will be different. The list
|
||||
# of all members will be omitted, etc.
|
||||
|
||||
OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_FOR_C = YES
|
||||
|
||||
# Set the OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_JAVA tag to YES if your project consists of Java
|
||||
# sources only. Doxygen will then generate output that is more tailored for
|
||||
# Java. For instance, namespaces will be presented as packages, qualified
|
||||
# scopes will look different, etc.
|
||||
|
||||
OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_JAVA = NO
|
||||
|
||||
# Set the OPTIMIZE_FOR_FORTRAN tag to YES if your project consists of Fortran
|
||||
# sources only. Doxygen will then generate output that is more tailored for
|
||||
# Fortran.
|
||||
|
||||
OPTIMIZE_FOR_FORTRAN = NO
|
||||
|
||||
# Set the OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_VHDL tag to YES if your project consists of VHDL
|
||||
# sources. Doxygen will then generate output that is tailored for
|
||||
# VHDL.
|
||||
|
||||
OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_VHDL = NO
|
||||
|
||||
# If you use STL classes (i.e. std::string, std::vector, etc.) but do not want
|
||||
# to include (a tag file for) the STL sources as input, then you should
|
||||
# set this tag to YES in order to let doxygen match functions declarations and
|
||||
# definitions whose arguments contain STL classes (e.g. func(std::string); v.s.
|
||||
# func(std::string) {}). This also make the inheritance and collaboration
|
||||
# diagrams that involve STL classes more complete and accurate.
|
||||
|
||||
BUILTIN_STL_SUPPORT = NO
|
||||
|
||||
# If you use Microsoft's C++/CLI language, you should set this option to YES to
|
||||
# enable parsing support.
|
||||
|
||||
CPP_CLI_SUPPORT = NO
|
||||
|
||||
# Set the SIP_SUPPORT tag to YES if your project consists of sip sources only.
|
||||
# Doxygen will parse them like normal C++ but will assume all classes use public
|
||||
# instead of private inheritance when no explicit protection keyword is present.
|
||||
|
||||
SIP_SUPPORT = NO
|
||||
|
||||
# For Microsoft's IDL there are propget and propput attributes to indicate getter
|
||||
# and setter methods for a property. Setting this option to YES (the default)
|
||||
# will make doxygen to replace the get and set methods by a property in the
|
||||
# documentation. This will only work if the methods are indeed getting or
|
||||
# setting a simple type. If this is not the case, or you want to show the
|
||||
# methods anyway, you should set this option to NO.
|
||||
|
||||
IDL_PROPERTY_SUPPORT = YES
|
||||
|
||||
# If member grouping is used in the documentation and the DISTRIBUTE_GROUP_DOC
|
||||
# tag is set to YES, then doxygen will reuse the documentation of the first
|
||||
# member in the group (if any) for the other members of the group. By default
|
||||
# all members of a group must be documented explicitly.
|
||||
|
||||
DISTRIBUTE_GROUP_DOC = NO
|
||||
|
||||
# Set the SUBGROUPING tag to YES (the default) to allow class member groups of
|
||||
# the same type (for instance a group of public functions) to be put as a
|
||||
# subgroup of that type (e.g. under the Public Functions section). Set it to
|
||||
# NO to prevent subgrouping. Alternatively, this can be done per class using
|
||||
# the \nosubgrouping command.
|
||||
|
||||
SUBGROUPING = YES
|
||||
|
||||
# When TYPEDEF_HIDES_STRUCT is enabled, a typedef of a struct, union, or enum
|
||||
# is documented as struct, union, or enum with the name of the typedef. So
|
||||
# typedef struct TypeS {} TypeT, will appear in the documentation as a struct
|
||||
# with name TypeT. When disabled the typedef will appear as a member of a file,
|
||||
# namespace, or class. And the struct will be named TypeS. This can typically
|
||||
# be useful for C code in case the coding convention dictates that all compound
|
||||
# types are typedef'ed and only the typedef is referenced, never the tag name.
|
||||
|
||||
TYPEDEF_HIDES_STRUCT = NO
|
||||
|
||||
# The SYMBOL_CACHE_SIZE determines the size of the internal cache use to
|
||||
# determine which symbols to keep in memory and which to flush to disk.
|
||||
# When the cache is full, less often used symbols will be written to disk.
|
||||
# For small to medium size projects (<1000 input files) the default value is
|
||||
# probably good enough. For larger projects a too small cache size can cause
|
||||
# doxygen to be busy swapping symbols to and from disk most of the time
|
||||
# causing a significant performance penality.
|
||||
# If the system has enough physical memory increasing the cache will improve the
|
||||
# performance by keeping more symbols in memory. Note that the value works on
|
||||
# a logarithmic scale so increasing the size by one will rougly double the
|
||||
# memory usage. The cache size is given by this formula:
|
||||
# 2^(16+SYMBOL_CACHE_SIZE). The valid range is 0..9, the default is 0,
|
||||
# corresponding to a cache size of 2^16 = 65536 symbols
|
||||
|
||||
SYMBOL_CACHE_SIZE = 0
|
||||
|
||||
#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
|
||||
# Build related configuration options
|
||||
#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
|
||||
|
||||
# If the EXTRACT_ALL tag is set to YES doxygen will assume all entities in
|
||||
# documentation are documented, even if no documentation was available.
|
||||
# Private class members and static file members will be hidden unless
|
||||
# the EXTRACT_PRIVATE and EXTRACT_STATIC tags are set to YES
|
||||
|
||||
EXTRACT_ALL = YES
|
||||
|
||||
# If the EXTRACT_PRIVATE tag is set to YES all private members of a class
|
||||
# will be included in the documentation.
|
||||
|
||||
EXTRACT_PRIVATE = YES
|
||||
|
||||
# If the EXTRACT_STATIC tag is set to YES all static members of a file
|
||||
# will be included in the documentation.
|
||||
|
||||
EXTRACT_STATIC = YES
|
||||
|
||||
# If the EXTRACT_LOCAL_CLASSES tag is set to YES classes (and structs)
|
||||
# defined locally in source files will be included in the documentation.
|
||||
# If set to NO only classes defined in header files are included.
|
||||
|
||||
EXTRACT_LOCAL_CLASSES = YES
|
||||
|
||||
# This flag is only useful for Objective-C code. When set to YES local
|
||||
# methods, which are defined in the implementation section but not in
|
||||
# the interface are included in the documentation.
|
||||
# If set to NO (the default) only methods in the interface are included.
|
||||
|
||||
EXTRACT_LOCAL_METHODS = NO
|
||||
|
||||
# If this flag is set to YES, the members of anonymous namespaces will be
|
||||
# extracted and appear in the documentation as a namespace called
|
||||
# 'anonymous_namespace{file}', where file will be replaced with the base
|
||||
# name of the file that contains the anonymous namespace. By default
|
||||
# anonymous namespace are hidden.
|
||||
|
||||
EXTRACT_ANON_NSPACES = NO
|
||||
|
||||
# If the HIDE_UNDOC_MEMBERS tag is set to YES, Doxygen will hide all
|
||||
# undocumented members of documented classes, files or namespaces.
|
||||
# If set to NO (the default) these members will be included in the
|
||||
# various overviews, but no documentation section is generated.
|
||||
# This option has no effect if EXTRACT_ALL is enabled.
|
||||
|
||||
HIDE_UNDOC_MEMBERS = NO
|
||||
|
||||
# If the HIDE_UNDOC_CLASSES tag is set to YES, Doxygen will hide all
|
||||
# undocumented classes that are normally visible in the class hierarchy.
|
||||
# If set to NO (the default) these classes will be included in the various
|
||||
# overviews. This option has no effect if EXTRACT_ALL is enabled.
|
||||
|
||||
HIDE_UNDOC_CLASSES = NO
|
||||
|
||||
# If the HIDE_FRIEND_COMPOUNDS tag is set to YES, Doxygen will hide all
|
||||
# friend (class|struct|union) declarations.
|
||||
# If set to NO (the default) these declarations will be included in the
|
||||
# documentation.
|
||||
|
||||
HIDE_FRIEND_COMPOUNDS = NO
|
||||
|
||||
# If the HIDE_IN_BODY_DOCS tag is set to YES, Doxygen will hide any
|
||||
# documentation blocks found inside the body of a function.
|
||||
# If set to NO (the default) these blocks will be appended to the
|
||||
# function's detailed documentation block.
|
||||
|
||||
HIDE_IN_BODY_DOCS = NO
|
||||
|
||||
# The INTERNAL_DOCS tag determines if documentation
|
||||
# that is typed after a \internal command is included. If the tag is set
|
||||
# to NO (the default) then the documentation will be excluded.
|
||||
# Set it to YES to include the internal documentation.
|
||||
|
||||
INTERNAL_DOCS = NO
|
||||
|
||||
# If the CASE_SENSE_NAMES tag is set to NO then Doxygen will only generate
|
||||
# file names in lower-case letters. If set to YES upper-case letters are also
|
||||
# allowed. This is useful if you have classes or files whose names only differ
|
||||
# in case and if your file system supports case sensitive file names. Windows
|
||||
# and Mac users are advised to set this option to NO.
|
||||
|
||||
CASE_SENSE_NAMES = NO
|
||||
|
||||
# If the HIDE_SCOPE_NAMES tag is set to NO (the default) then Doxygen
|
||||
# will show members with their full class and namespace scopes in the
|
||||
# documentation. If set to YES the scope will be hidden.
|
||||
|
||||
HIDE_SCOPE_NAMES = NO
|
||||
|
||||
# If the SHOW_INCLUDE_FILES tag is set to YES (the default) then Doxygen
|
||||
# will put a list of the files that are included by a file in the documentation
|
||||
# of that file.
|
||||
|
||||
SHOW_INCLUDE_FILES = YES
|
||||
|
||||
# If the INLINE_INFO tag is set to YES (the default) then a tag [inline]
|
||||
# is inserted in the documentation for inline members.
|
||||
|
||||
INLINE_INFO = YES
|
||||
|
||||
# If the SORT_MEMBER_DOCS tag is set to YES (the default) then doxygen
|
||||
# will sort the (detailed) documentation of file and class members
|
||||
# alphabetically by member name. If set to NO the members will appear in
|
||||
# declaration order.
|
||||
|
||||
SORT_MEMBER_DOCS = YES
|
||||
|
||||
# If the SORT_BRIEF_DOCS tag is set to YES then doxygen will sort the
|
||||
# brief documentation of file, namespace and class members alphabetically
|
||||
# by member name. If set to NO (the default) the members will appear in
|
||||
# declaration order.
|
||||
|
||||
SORT_BRIEF_DOCS = NO
|
||||
|
||||
# If the SORT_GROUP_NAMES tag is set to YES then doxygen will sort the
|
||||
# hierarchy of group names into alphabetical order. If set to NO (the default)
|
||||
# the group names will appear in their defined order.
|
||||
|
||||
SORT_GROUP_NAMES = NO
|
||||
|
||||
# If the SORT_BY_SCOPE_NAME tag is set to YES, the class list will be
|
||||
# sorted by fully-qualified names, including namespaces. If set to
|
||||
# NO (the default), the class list will be sorted only by class name,
|
||||
# not including the namespace part.
|
||||
# Note: This option is not very useful if HIDE_SCOPE_NAMES is set to YES.
|
||||
# Note: This option applies only to the class list, not to the
|
||||
# alphabetical list.
|
||||
|
||||
SORT_BY_SCOPE_NAME = NO
|
||||
|
||||
# The GENERATE_TODOLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or
|
||||
# disable (NO) the todo list. This list is created by putting \todo
|
||||
# commands in the documentation.
|
||||
|
||||
GENERATE_TODOLIST = NO
|
||||
|
||||
# The GENERATE_TESTLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or
|
||||
# disable (NO) the test list. This list is created by putting \test
|
||||
# commands in the documentation.
|
||||
|
||||
GENERATE_TESTLIST = NO
|
||||
|
||||
# The GENERATE_BUGLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or
|
||||
# disable (NO) the bug list. This list is created by putting \bug
|
||||
# commands in the documentation.
|
||||
|
||||
GENERATE_BUGLIST = NO
|
||||
|
||||
# The GENERATE_DEPRECATEDLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or
|
||||
# disable (NO) the deprecated list. This list is created by putting
|
||||
# \deprecated commands in the documentation.
|
||||
|
||||
GENERATE_DEPRECATEDLIST= YES
|
||||
|
||||
# The ENABLED_SECTIONS tag can be used to enable conditional
|
||||
# documentation sections, marked by \if sectionname ... \endif.
|
||||
|
||||
ENABLED_SECTIONS =
|
||||
|
||||
# The MAX_INITIALIZER_LINES tag determines the maximum number of lines
|
||||
# the initial value of a variable or define consists of for it to appear in
|
||||
# the documentation. If the initializer consists of more lines than specified
|
||||
# here it will be hidden. Use a value of 0 to hide initializers completely.
|
||||
# The appearance of the initializer of individual variables and defines in the
|
||||
# documentation can be controlled using \showinitializer or \hideinitializer
|
||||
# command in the documentation regardless of this setting.
|
||||
|
||||
MAX_INITIALIZER_LINES = 30
|
||||
|
||||
# Set the SHOW_USED_FILES tag to NO to disable the list of files generated
|
||||
# at the bottom of the documentation of classes and structs. If set to YES the
|
||||
# list will mention the files that were used to generate the documentation.
|
||||
|
||||
SHOW_USED_FILES = YES
|
||||
|
||||
# If the sources in your project are distributed over multiple directories
|
||||
# then setting the SHOW_DIRECTORIES tag to YES will show the directory hierarchy
|
||||
# in the documentation. The default is NO.
|
||||
|
||||
SHOW_DIRECTORIES = YES
|
||||
|
||||
# Set the SHOW_FILES tag to NO to disable the generation of the Files page.
|
||||
# This will remove the Files entry from the Quick Index and from the
|
||||
# Folder Tree View (if specified). The default is YES.
|
||||
|
||||
SHOW_FILES = YES
|
||||
|
||||
# Set the SHOW_NAMESPACES tag to NO to disable the generation of the
|
||||
# Namespaces page. This will remove the Namespaces entry from the Quick Index
|
||||
# and from the Folder Tree View (if specified). The default is YES.
|
||||
|
||||
SHOW_NAMESPACES = YES
|
||||
|
||||
# The FILE_VERSION_FILTER tag can be used to specify a program or script that
|
||||
# doxygen should invoke to get the current version for each file (typically from
|
||||
# the version control system). Doxygen will invoke the program by executing (via
|
||||
# popen()) the command <command> <input-file>, where <command> is the value of
|
||||
# the FILE_VERSION_FILTER tag, and <input-file> is the name of an input file
|
||||
# provided by doxygen. Whatever the program writes to standard output
|
||||
# is used as the file version. See the manual for examples.
|
||||
|
||||
FILE_VERSION_FILTER =
|
||||
|
||||
# The LAYOUT_FILE tag can be used to specify a layout file which will be parsed by
|
||||
# doxygen. The layout file controls the global structure of the generated output files
|
||||
# in an output format independent way. The create the layout file that represents
|
||||
# doxygen's defaults, run doxygen with the -l option. You can optionally specify a
|
||||
# file name after the option, if omitted DoxygenLayout.xml will be used as the name
|
||||
# of the layout file.
|
||||
|
||||
LAYOUT_FILE =
|
||||
|
||||
#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
|
||||
# configuration options related to warning and progress messages
|
||||
#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
|
||||
|
||||
# The QUIET tag can be used to turn on/off the messages that are generated
|
||||
# by doxygen. Possible values are YES and NO. If left blank NO is used.
|
||||
|
||||
QUIET = YES
|
||||
|
||||
# The WARNINGS tag can be used to turn on/off the warning messages that are
|
||||
# generated by doxygen. Possible values are YES and NO. If left blank
|
||||
# NO is used.
|
||||
|
||||
WARNINGS = YES
|
||||
|
||||
# If WARN_IF_UNDOCUMENTED is set to YES, then doxygen will generate warnings
|
||||
# for undocumented members. If EXTRACT_ALL is set to YES then this flag will
|
||||
# automatically be disabled.
|
||||
|
||||
WARN_IF_UNDOCUMENTED = YES
|
||||
|
||||
# If WARN_IF_DOC_ERROR is set to YES, doxygen will generate warnings for
|
||||
# potential errors in the documentation, such as not documenting some
|
||||
# parameters in a documented function, or documenting parameters that
|
||||
# don't exist or using markup commands wrongly.
|
||||
|
||||
WARN_IF_DOC_ERROR = YES
|
||||
|
||||
# This WARN_NO_PARAMDOC option can be abled to get warnings for
|
||||
# functions that are documented, but have no documentation for their parameters
|
||||
# or return value. If set to NO (the default) doxygen will only warn about
|
||||
# wrong or incomplete parameter documentation, but not about the absence of
|
||||
# documentation.
|
||||
|
||||
WARN_NO_PARAMDOC = YES
|
||||
|
||||
# The WARN_FORMAT tag determines the format of the warning messages that
|
||||
# doxygen can produce. The string should contain the $file, $line, and $text
|
||||
# tags, which will be replaced by the file and line number from which the
|
||||
# warning originated and the warning text. Optionally the format may contain
|
||||
# $version, which will be replaced by the version of the file (if it could
|
||||
# be obtained via FILE_VERSION_FILTER)
|
||||
|
||||
WARN_FORMAT = "$file:$line: $text"
|
||||
|
||||
# The WARN_LOGFILE tag can be used to specify a file to which warning
|
||||
# and error messages should be written. If left blank the output is written
|
||||
# to stderr.
|
||||
|
||||
WARN_LOGFILE =
|
||||
|
||||
#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
|
||||
# configuration options related to the input files
|
||||
#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
|
||||
|
||||
# The INPUT tag can be used to specify the files and/or directories that contain
|
||||
# documented source files. You may enter file names like "myfile.cpp" or
|
||||
# directories like "/usr/src/myproject". Separate the files or directories
|
||||
# with spaces.
|
||||
|
||||
INPUT = ./
|
||||
|
||||
# This tag can be used to specify the character encoding of the source files
|
||||
# that doxygen parses. Internally doxygen uses the UTF-8 encoding, which is
|
||||
# also the default input encoding. Doxygen uses libiconv (or the iconv built
|
||||
# into libc) for the transcoding. See http://www.gnu.org/software/libiconv for
|
||||
# the list of possible encodings.
|
||||
|
||||
INPUT_ENCODING = UTF-8
|
||||
|
||||
# If the value of the INPUT tag contains directories, you can use the
|
||||
# FILE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard pattern (like *.cpp
|
||||
# and *.h) to filter out the source-files in the directories. If left
|
||||
# blank the following patterns are tested:
|
||||
# *.c *.cc *.cxx *.cpp *.c++ *.java *.ii *.ixx *.ipp *.i++ *.inl *.h *.hh *.hxx
|
||||
# *.hpp *.h++ *.idl *.odl *.cs *.php *.php3 *.inc *.m *.mm *.py *.f90
|
||||
|
||||
FILE_PATTERNS = *.h \
|
||||
*.c \
|
||||
*.txt
|
||||
|
||||
# The RECURSIVE tag can be used to turn specify whether or not subdirectories
|
||||
# should be searched for input files as well. Possible values are YES and NO.
|
||||
# If left blank NO is used.
|
||||
|
||||
RECURSIVE = YES
|
||||
|
||||
# The EXCLUDE tag can be used to specify files and/or directories that should
|
||||
# excluded from the INPUT source files. This way you can easily exclude a
|
||||
# subdirectory from a directory tree whose root is specified with the INPUT tag.
|
||||
|
||||
EXCLUDE =
|
||||
|
||||
# The EXCLUDE_SYMLINKS tag can be used select whether or not files or
|
||||
# directories that are symbolic links (a Unix filesystem feature) are excluded
|
||||
# from the input.
|
||||
|
||||
EXCLUDE_SYMLINKS = NO
|
||||
|
||||
# If the value of the INPUT tag contains directories, you can use the
|
||||
# EXCLUDE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard patterns to exclude
|
||||
# certain files from those directories. Note that the wildcards are matched
|
||||
# against the file with absolute path, so to exclude all test directories
|
||||
# for example use the pattern */test/*
|
||||
|
||||
EXCLUDE_PATTERNS = */LowLevel/USBMode.h
|
||||
|
||||
# The EXCLUDE_SYMBOLS tag can be used to specify one or more symbol names
|
||||
# (namespaces, classes, functions, etc.) that should be excluded from the
|
||||
# output. The symbol name can be a fully qualified name, a word, or if the
|
||||
# wildcard * is used, a substring. Examples: ANamespace, AClass,
|
||||
# AClass::ANamespace, ANamespace::*Test
|
||||
|
||||
EXCLUDE_SYMBOLS = __*
|
||||
|
||||
# The EXAMPLE_PATH tag can be used to specify one or more files or
|
||||
# directories that contain example code fragments that are included (see
|
||||
# the \include command).
|
||||
|
||||
EXAMPLE_PATH =
|
||||
|
||||
# If the value of the EXAMPLE_PATH tag contains directories, you can use the
|
||||
# EXAMPLE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard pattern (like *.cpp
|
||||
# and *.h) to filter out the source-files in the directories. If left
|
||||
# blank all files are included.
|
||||
|
||||
EXAMPLE_PATTERNS = *
|
||||
|
||||
# If the EXAMPLE_RECURSIVE tag is set to YES then subdirectories will be
|
||||
# searched for input files to be used with the \include or \dontinclude
|
||||
# commands irrespective of the value of the RECURSIVE tag.
|
||||
# Possible values are YES and NO. If left blank NO is used.
|
||||
|
||||
EXAMPLE_RECURSIVE = NO
|
||||
|
||||
# The IMAGE_PATH tag can be used to specify one or more files or
|
||||
# directories that contain image that are included in the documentation (see
|
||||
# the \image command).
|
||||
|
||||
IMAGE_PATH =
|
||||
|
||||
# The INPUT_FILTER tag can be used to specify a program that doxygen should
|
||||
# invoke to filter for each input file. Doxygen will invoke the filter program
|
||||
# by executing (via popen()) the command <filter> <input-file>, where <filter>
|
||||
# is the value of the INPUT_FILTER tag, and <input-file> is the name of an
|
||||
# input file. Doxygen will then use the output that the filter program writes
|
||||
# to standard output. If FILTER_PATTERNS is specified, this tag will be
|
||||
# ignored.
|
||||
|
||||
INPUT_FILTER =
|
||||
|
||||
# The FILTER_PATTERNS tag can be used to specify filters on a per file pattern
|
||||
# basis. Doxygen will compare the file name with each pattern and apply the
|
||||
# filter if there is a match. The filters are a list of the form:
|
||||
# pattern=filter (like *.cpp=my_cpp_filter). See INPUT_FILTER for further
|
||||
# info on how filters are used. If FILTER_PATTERNS is empty, INPUT_FILTER
|
||||
# is applied to all files.
|
||||
|
||||
FILTER_PATTERNS =
|
||||
|
||||
# If the FILTER_SOURCE_FILES tag is set to YES, the input filter (if set using
|
||||
# INPUT_FILTER) will be used to filter the input files when producing source
|
||||
# files to browse (i.e. when SOURCE_BROWSER is set to YES).
|
||||
|
||||
FILTER_SOURCE_FILES = NO
|
||||
|
||||
#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
|
||||
# configuration options related to source browsing
|
||||
#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
|
||||
|
||||
# If the SOURCE_BROWSER tag is set to YES then a list of source files will
|
||||
# be generated. Documented entities will be cross-referenced with these sources.
|
||||
# Note: To get rid of all source code in the generated output, make sure also
|
||||
# VERBATIM_HEADERS is set to NO.
|
||||
|
||||
SOURCE_BROWSER = NO
|
||||
|
||||
# Setting the INLINE_SOURCES tag to YES will include the body
|
||||
# of functions and classes directly in the documentation.
|
||||
|
||||
INLINE_SOURCES = NO
|
||||
|
||||
# Setting the STRIP_CODE_COMMENTS tag to YES (the default) will instruct
|
||||
# doxygen to hide any special comment blocks from generated source code
|
||||
# fragments. Normal C and C++ comments will always remain visible.
|
||||
|
||||
STRIP_CODE_COMMENTS = YES
|
||||
|
||||
# If the REFERENCED_BY_RELATION tag is set to YES
|
||||
# then for each documented function all documented
|
||||
# functions referencing it will be listed.
|
||||
|
||||
REFERENCED_BY_RELATION = NO
|
||||
|
||||
# If the REFERENCES_RELATION tag is set to YES
|
||||
# then for each documented function all documented entities
|
||||
# called/used by that function will be listed.
|
||||
|
||||
REFERENCES_RELATION = NO
|
||||
|
||||
# If the REFERENCES_LINK_SOURCE tag is set to YES (the default)
|
||||
# and SOURCE_BROWSER tag is set to YES, then the hyperlinks from
|
||||
# functions in REFERENCES_RELATION and REFERENCED_BY_RELATION lists will
|
||||
# link to the source code. Otherwise they will link to the documentstion.
|
||||
|
||||
REFERENCES_LINK_SOURCE = NO
|
||||
|
||||
# If the USE_HTAGS tag is set to YES then the references to source code
|
||||
# will point to the HTML generated by the htags(1) tool instead of doxygen
|
||||
# built-in source browser. The htags tool is part of GNU's global source
|
||||
# tagging system (see http://www.gnu.org/software/global/global.html). You
|
||||
# will need version 4.8.6 or higher.
|
||||
|
||||
USE_HTAGS = NO
|
||||
|
||||
# If the VERBATIM_HEADERS tag is set to YES (the default) then Doxygen
|
||||
# will generate a verbatim copy of the header file for each class for
|
||||
# which an include is specified. Set to NO to disable this.
|
||||
|
||||
VERBATIM_HEADERS = NO
|
||||
|
||||
#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
|
||||
# configuration options related to the alphabetical class index
|
||||
#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
|
||||
|
||||
# If the ALPHABETICAL_INDEX tag is set to YES, an alphabetical index
|
||||
# of all compounds will be generated. Enable this if the project
|
||||
# contains a lot of classes, structs, unions or interfaces.
|
||||
|
||||
ALPHABETICAL_INDEX = YES
|
||||
|
||||
# If the alphabetical index is enabled (see ALPHABETICAL_INDEX) then
|
||||
# the COLS_IN_ALPHA_INDEX tag can be used to specify the number of columns
|
||||
# in which this list will be split (can be a number in the range [1..20])
|
||||
|
||||
COLS_IN_ALPHA_INDEX = 5
|
||||
|
||||
# In case all classes in a project start with a common prefix, all
|
||||
# classes will be put under the same header in the alphabetical index.
|
||||
# The IGNORE_PREFIX tag can be used to specify one or more prefixes that
|
||||
# should be ignored while generating the index headers.
|
||||
|
||||
IGNORE_PREFIX =
|
||||
|
||||
#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
|
||||
# configuration options related to the HTML output
|
||||
#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
|
||||
|
||||
# If the GENERATE_HTML tag is set to YES (the default) Doxygen will
|
||||
# generate HTML output.
|
||||
|
||||
GENERATE_HTML = YES
|
||||
|
||||
# The HTML_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the HTML docs will be put.
|
||||
# If a relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be
|
||||
# put in front of it. If left blank `html' will be used as the default path.
|
||||
|
||||
HTML_OUTPUT = html
|
||||
|
||||
# The HTML_FILE_EXTENSION tag can be used to specify the file extension for
|
||||
# each generated HTML page (for example: .htm,.php,.asp). If it is left blank
|
||||
# doxygen will generate files with .html extension.
|
||||
|
||||
HTML_FILE_EXTENSION = .html
|
||||
|
||||
# The HTML_HEADER tag can be used to specify a personal HTML header for
|
||||
# each generated HTML page. If it is left blank doxygen will generate a
|
||||
# standard header.
|
||||
|
||||
HTML_HEADER =
|
||||
|
||||
# The HTML_FOOTER tag can be used to specify a personal HTML footer for
|
||||
# each generated HTML page. If it is left blank doxygen will generate a
|
||||
# standard footer.
|
||||
|
||||
HTML_FOOTER =
|
||||
|
||||
# The HTML_STYLESHEET tag can be used to specify a user-defined cascading
|
||||
# style sheet that is used by each HTML page. It can be used to
|
||||
# fine-tune the look of the HTML output. If the tag is left blank doxygen
|
||||
# will generate a default style sheet. Note that doxygen will try to copy
|
||||
# the style sheet file to the HTML output directory, so don't put your own
|
||||
# stylesheet in the HTML output directory as well, or it will be erased!
|
||||
|
||||
HTML_STYLESHEET =
|
||||
|
||||
# If the HTML_ALIGN_MEMBERS tag is set to YES, the members of classes,
|
||||
# files or namespaces will be aligned in HTML using tables. If set to
|
||||
# NO a bullet list will be used.
|
||||
|
||||
HTML_ALIGN_MEMBERS = YES
|
||||
|
||||
# If the HTML_DYNAMIC_SECTIONS tag is set to YES then the generated HTML
|
||||
# documentation will contain sections that can be hidden and shown after the
|
||||
# page has loaded. For this to work a browser that supports
|
||||
# JavaScript and DHTML is required (for instance Mozilla 1.0+, Firefox
|
||||
# Netscape 6.0+, Internet explorer 5.0+, Konqueror, or Safari).
|
||||
|
||||
HTML_DYNAMIC_SECTIONS = YES
|
||||
|
||||
# If the GENERATE_DOCSET tag is set to YES, additional index files
|
||||
# will be generated that can be used as input for Apple's Xcode 3
|
||||
# integrated development environment, introduced with OSX 10.5 (Leopard).
|
||||
# To create a documentation set, doxygen will generate a Makefile in the
|
||||
# HTML output directory. Running make will produce the docset in that
|
||||
# directory and running "make install" will install the docset in
|
||||
# ~/Library/Developer/Shared/Documentation/DocSets so that Xcode will find
|
||||
# it at startup.
|
||||
# See http://developer.apple.com/tools/creatingdocsetswithdoxygen.html for more information.
|
||||
|
||||
GENERATE_DOCSET = NO
|
||||
|
||||
# When GENERATE_DOCSET tag is set to YES, this tag determines the name of the
|
||||
# feed. A documentation feed provides an umbrella under which multiple
|
||||
# documentation sets from a single provider (such as a company or product suite)
|
||||
# can be grouped.
|
||||
|
||||
DOCSET_FEEDNAME = "Doxygen generated docs"
|
||||
|
||||
# When GENERATE_DOCSET tag is set to YES, this tag specifies a string that
|
||||
# should uniquely identify the documentation set bundle. This should be a
|
||||
# reverse domain-name style string, e.g. com.mycompany.MyDocSet. Doxygen
|
||||
# will append .docset to the name.
|
||||
|
||||
DOCSET_BUNDLE_ID = org.doxygen.Project
|
||||
|
||||
# If the GENERATE_HTMLHELP tag is set to YES, additional index files
|
||||
# will be generated that can be used as input for tools like the
|
||||
# Microsoft HTML help workshop to generate a compiled HTML help file (.chm)
|
||||
# of the generated HTML documentation.
|
||||
|
||||
GENERATE_HTMLHELP = NO
|
||||
|
||||
# If the GENERATE_HTMLHELP tag is set to YES, the CHM_FILE tag can
|
||||
# be used to specify the file name of the resulting .chm file. You
|
||||
# can add a path in front of the file if the result should not be
|
||||
# written to the html output directory.
|
||||
|
||||
CHM_FILE =
|
||||
|
||||
# If the GENERATE_HTMLHELP tag is set to YES, the HHC_LOCATION tag can
|
||||
# be used to specify the location (absolute path including file name) of
|
||||
# the HTML help compiler (hhc.exe). If non-empty doxygen will try to run
|
||||
# the HTML help compiler on the generated index.hhp.
|
||||
|
||||
HHC_LOCATION =
|
||||
|
||||
# If the GENERATE_HTMLHELP tag is set to YES, the GENERATE_CHI flag
|
||||
# controls if a separate .chi index file is generated (YES) or that
|
||||
# it should be included in the master .chm file (NO).
|
||||
|
||||
GENERATE_CHI = NO
|
||||
|
||||
# If the GENERATE_HTMLHELP tag is set to YES, the CHM_INDEX_ENCODING
|
||||
# is used to encode HtmlHelp index (hhk), content (hhc) and project file
|
||||
# content.
|
||||
|
||||
CHM_INDEX_ENCODING =
|
||||
|
||||
# If the GENERATE_HTMLHELP tag is set to YES, the BINARY_TOC flag
|
||||
# controls whether a binary table of contents is generated (YES) or a
|
||||
# normal table of contents (NO) in the .chm file.
|
||||
|
||||
BINARY_TOC = NO
|
||||
|
||||
# The TOC_EXPAND flag can be set to YES to add extra items for group members
|
||||
# to the contents of the HTML help documentation and to the tree view.
|
||||
|
||||
TOC_EXPAND = YES
|
||||
|
||||
# If the GENERATE_QHP tag is set to YES and both QHP_NAMESPACE and QHP_VIRTUAL_FOLDER
|
||||
# are set, an additional index file will be generated that can be used as input for
|
||||
# Qt's qhelpgenerator to generate a Qt Compressed Help (.qch) of the generated
|
||||
# HTML documentation.
|
||||
|
||||
GENERATE_QHP = NO
|
||||
|
||||
# If the QHG_LOCATION tag is specified, the QCH_FILE tag can
|
||||
# be used to specify the file name of the resulting .qch file.
|
||||
# The path specified is relative to the HTML output folder.
|
||||
|
||||
QCH_FILE =
|
||||
|
||||
# The QHP_NAMESPACE tag specifies the namespace to use when generating
|
||||
# Qt Help Project output. For more information please see
|
||||
# <a href="http://doc.trolltech.com/qthelpproject.html#namespace">Qt Help Project / Namespace</a>.
|
||||
|
||||
QHP_NAMESPACE = org.doxygen.Project
|
||||
|
||||
# The QHP_VIRTUAL_FOLDER tag specifies the namespace to use when generating
|
||||
# Qt Help Project output. For more information please see
|
||||
# <a href="http://doc.trolltech.com/qthelpproject.html#virtual-folders">Qt Help Project / Virtual Folders</a>.
|
||||
|
||||
QHP_VIRTUAL_FOLDER = doc
|
||||
|
||||
# If the GENERATE_QHP tag is set to YES, the QHG_LOCATION tag can
|
||||
# be used to specify the location of Qt's qhelpgenerator.
|
||||
# If non-empty doxygen will try to run qhelpgenerator on the generated
|
||||
# .qhp file .
|
||||
|
||||
QHG_LOCATION =
|
||||
|
||||
# The DISABLE_INDEX tag can be used to turn on/off the condensed index at
|
||||
# top of each HTML page. The value NO (the default) enables the index and
|
||||
# the value YES disables it.
|
||||
|
||||
DISABLE_INDEX = NO
|
||||
|
||||
# This tag can be used to set the number of enum values (range [1..20])
|
||||
# that doxygen will group on one line in the generated HTML documentation.
|
||||
|
||||
ENUM_VALUES_PER_LINE = 1
|
||||
|
||||
# The GENERATE_TREEVIEW tag is used to specify whether a tree-like index
|
||||
# structure should be generated to display hierarchical information.
|
||||
# If the tag value is set to FRAME, a side panel will be generated
|
||||
# containing a tree-like index structure (just like the one that
|
||||
# is generated for HTML Help). For this to work a browser that supports
|
||||
# JavaScript, DHTML, CSS and frames is required (for instance Mozilla 1.0+,
|
||||
# Netscape 6.0+, Internet explorer 5.0+, or Konqueror). Windows users are
|
||||
# probably better off using the HTML help feature. Other possible values
|
||||
# for this tag are: HIERARCHIES, which will generate the Groups, Directories,
|
||||
# and Class Hierarchy pages using a tree view instead of an ordered list;
|
||||
# ALL, which combines the behavior of FRAME and HIERARCHIES; and NONE, which
|
||||
# disables this behavior completely. For backwards compatibility with previous
|
||||
# releases of Doxygen, the values YES and NO are equivalent to FRAME and NONE
|
||||
# respectively.
|
||||
|
||||
GENERATE_TREEVIEW = YES
|
||||
|
||||
# If the treeview is enabled (see GENERATE_TREEVIEW) then this tag can be
|
||||
# used to set the initial width (in pixels) of the frame in which the tree
|
||||
# is shown.
|
||||
|
||||
TREEVIEW_WIDTH = 250
|
||||
|
||||
# Use this tag to change the font size of Latex formulas included
|
||||
# as images in the HTML documentation. The default is 10. Note that
|
||||
# when you change the font size after a successful doxygen run you need
|
||||
# to manually remove any form_*.png images from the HTML output directory
|
||||
# to force them to be regenerated.
|
||||
|
||||
FORMULA_FONTSIZE = 10
|
||||
|
||||
#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
|
||||
# configuration options related to the LaTeX output
|
||||
#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
|
||||
|
||||
# If the GENERATE_LATEX tag is set to YES (the default) Doxygen will
|
||||
# generate Latex output.
|
||||
|
||||
GENERATE_LATEX = NO
|
||||
|
||||
# The LATEX_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the LaTeX docs will be put.
|
||||
# If a relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be
|
||||
# put in front of it. If left blank `latex' will be used as the default path.
|
||||
|
||||
LATEX_OUTPUT = latex
|
||||
|
||||
# The LATEX_CMD_NAME tag can be used to specify the LaTeX command name to be
|
||||
# invoked. If left blank `latex' will be used as the default command name.
|
||||
|
||||
LATEX_CMD_NAME = latex
|
||||
|
||||
# The MAKEINDEX_CMD_NAME tag can be used to specify the command name to
|
||||
# generate index for LaTeX. If left blank `makeindex' will be used as the
|
||||
# default command name.
|
||||
|
||||
MAKEINDEX_CMD_NAME = makeindex
|
||||
|
||||
# If the COMPACT_LATEX tag is set to YES Doxygen generates more compact
|
||||
# LaTeX documents. This may be useful for small projects and may help to
|
||||
# save some trees in general.
|
||||
|
||||
COMPACT_LATEX = NO
|
||||
|
||||
# The PAPER_TYPE tag can be used to set the paper type that is used
|
||||
# by the printer. Possible values are: a4, a4wide, letter, legal and
|
||||
# executive. If left blank a4wide will be used.
|
||||
|
||||
PAPER_TYPE = a4wide
|
||||
|
||||
# The EXTRA_PACKAGES tag can be to specify one or more names of LaTeX
|
||||
# packages that should be included in the LaTeX output.
|
||||
|
||||
EXTRA_PACKAGES =
|
||||
|
||||
# The LATEX_HEADER tag can be used to specify a personal LaTeX header for
|
||||
# the generated latex document. The header should contain everything until
|
||||
# the first chapter. If it is left blank doxygen will generate a
|
||||
# standard header. Notice: only use this tag if you know what you are doing!
|
||||
|
||||
LATEX_HEADER =
|
||||
|
||||
# If the PDF_HYPERLINKS tag is set to YES, the LaTeX that is generated
|
||||
# is prepared for conversion to pdf (using ps2pdf). The pdf file will
|
||||
# contain links (just like the HTML output) instead of page references
|
||||
# This makes the output suitable for online browsing using a pdf viewer.
|
||||
|
||||
PDF_HYPERLINKS = YES
|
||||
|
||||
# If the USE_PDFLATEX tag is set to YES, pdflatex will be used instead of
|
||||
# plain latex in the generated Makefile. Set this option to YES to get a
|
||||
# higher quality PDF documentation.
|
||||
|
||||
USE_PDFLATEX = YES
|
||||
|
||||
# If the LATEX_BATCHMODE tag is set to YES, doxygen will add the \\batchmode.
|
||||
# command to the generated LaTeX files. This will instruct LaTeX to keep
|
||||
# running if errors occur, instead of asking the user for help.
|
||||
# This option is also used when generating formulas in HTML.
|
||||
|
||||
LATEX_BATCHMODE = NO
|
||||
|
||||
# If LATEX_HIDE_INDICES is set to YES then doxygen will not
|
||||
# include the index chapters (such as File Index, Compound Index, etc.)
|
||||
# in the output.
|
||||
|
||||
LATEX_HIDE_INDICES = NO
|
||||
|
||||
#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
|
||||
# configuration options related to the RTF output
|
||||
#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
|
||||
|
||||
# If the GENERATE_RTF tag is set to YES Doxygen will generate RTF output
|
||||
# The RTF output is optimized for Word 97 and may not look very pretty with
|
||||
# other RTF readers or editors.
|
||||
|
||||
GENERATE_RTF = NO
|
||||
|
||||
# The RTF_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the RTF docs will be put.
|
||||
# If a relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be
|
||||
# put in front of it. If left blank `rtf' will be used as the default path.
|
||||
|
||||
RTF_OUTPUT = rtf
|
||||
|
||||
# If the COMPACT_RTF tag is set to YES Doxygen generates more compact
|
||||
# RTF documents. This may be useful for small projects and may help to
|
||||
# save some trees in general.
|
||||
|
||||
COMPACT_RTF = NO
|
||||
|
||||
# If the RTF_HYPERLINKS tag is set to YES, the RTF that is generated
|
||||
# will contain hyperlink fields. The RTF file will
|
||||
# contain links (just like the HTML output) instead of page references.
|
||||
# This makes the output suitable for online browsing using WORD or other
|
||||
# programs which support those fields.
|
||||
# Note: wordpad (write) and others do not support links.
|
||||
|
||||
RTF_HYPERLINKS = NO
|
||||
|
||||
# Load stylesheet definitions from file. Syntax is similar to doxygen's
|
||||
# config file, i.e. a series of assignments. You only have to provide
|
||||
# replacements, missing definitions are set to their default value.
|
||||
|
||||
RTF_STYLESHEET_FILE =
|
||||
|
||||
# Set optional variables used in the generation of an rtf document.
|
||||
# Syntax is similar to doxygen's config file.
|
||||
|
||||
RTF_EXTENSIONS_FILE =
|
||||
|
||||
#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
|
||||
# configuration options related to the man page output
|
||||
#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
|
||||
|
||||
# If the GENERATE_MAN tag is set to YES (the default) Doxygen will
|
||||
# generate man pages
|
||||
|
||||
GENERATE_MAN = NO
|
||||
|
||||
# The MAN_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the man pages will be put.
|
||||
# If a relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be
|
||||
# put in front of it. If left blank `man' will be used as the default path.
|
||||
|
||||
MAN_OUTPUT = man
|
||||
|
||||
# The MAN_EXTENSION tag determines the extension that is added to
|
||||
# the generated man pages (default is the subroutine's section .3)
|
||||
|
||||
MAN_EXTENSION = .3
|
||||
|
||||
# If the MAN_LINKS tag is set to YES and Doxygen generates man output,
|
||||
# then it will generate one additional man file for each entity
|
||||
# documented in the real man page(s). These additional files
|
||||
# only source the real man page, but without them the man command
|
||||
# would be unable to find the correct page. The default is NO.
|
||||
|
||||
MAN_LINKS = NO
|
||||
|
||||
#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
|
||||
# configuration options related to the XML output
|
||||
#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
|
||||
|
||||
# If the GENERATE_XML tag is set to YES Doxygen will
|
||||
# generate an XML file that captures the structure of
|
||||
# the code including all documentation.
|
||||
|
||||
GENERATE_XML = NO
|
||||
|
||||
# The XML_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the XML pages will be put.
|
||||
# If a relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be
|
||||
# put in front of it. If left blank `xml' will be used as the default path.
|
||||
|
||||
XML_OUTPUT = xml
|
||||
|
||||
# The XML_SCHEMA tag can be used to specify an XML schema,
|
||||
# which can be used by a validating XML parser to check the
|
||||
# syntax of the XML files.
|
||||
|
||||
XML_SCHEMA =
|
||||
|
||||
# The XML_DTD tag can be used to specify an XML DTD,
|
||||
# which can be used by a validating XML parser to check the
|
||||
# syntax of the XML files.
|
||||
|
||||
XML_DTD =
|
||||
|
||||
# If the XML_PROGRAMLISTING tag is set to YES Doxygen will
|
||||
# dump the program listings (including syntax highlighting
|
||||
# and cross-referencing information) to the XML output. Note that
|
||||
# enabling this will significantly increase the size of the XML output.
|
||||
|
||||
XML_PROGRAMLISTING = YES
|
||||
|
||||
#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
|
||||
# configuration options for the AutoGen Definitions output
|
||||
#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
|
||||
|
||||
# If the GENERATE_AUTOGEN_DEF tag is set to YES Doxygen will
|
||||
# generate an AutoGen Definitions (see autogen.sf.net) file
|
||||
# that captures the structure of the code including all
|
||||
# documentation. Note that this feature is still experimental
|
||||
# and incomplete at the moment.
|
||||
|
||||
GENERATE_AUTOGEN_DEF = NO
|
||||
|
||||
#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
|
||||
# configuration options related to the Perl module output
|
||||
#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
|
||||
|
||||
# If the GENERATE_PERLMOD tag is set to YES Doxygen will
|
||||
# generate a Perl module file that captures the structure of
|
||||
# the code including all documentation. Note that this
|
||||
# feature is still experimental and incomplete at the
|
||||
# moment.
|
||||
|
||||
GENERATE_PERLMOD = NO
|
||||
|
||||
# If the PERLMOD_LATEX tag is set to YES Doxygen will generate
|
||||
# the necessary Makefile rules, Perl scripts and LaTeX code to be able
|
||||
# to generate PDF and DVI output from the Perl module output.
|
||||
|
||||
PERLMOD_LATEX = NO
|
||||
|
||||
# If the PERLMOD_PRETTY tag is set to YES the Perl module output will be
|
||||
# nicely formatted so it can be parsed by a human reader. This is useful
|
||||
# if you want to understand what is going on. On the other hand, if this
|
||||
# tag is set to NO the size of the Perl module output will be much smaller
|
||||
# and Perl will parse it just the same.
|
||||
|
||||
PERLMOD_PRETTY = YES
|
||||
|
||||
# The names of the make variables in the generated doxyrules.make file
|
||||
# are prefixed with the string contained in PERLMOD_MAKEVAR_PREFIX.
|
||||
# This is useful so different doxyrules.make files included by the same
|
||||
# Makefile don't overwrite each other's variables.
|
||||
|
||||
PERLMOD_MAKEVAR_PREFIX =
|
||||
|
||||
#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
|
||||
# Configuration options related to the preprocessor
|
||||
#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
|
||||
|
||||
# If the ENABLE_PREPROCESSING tag is set to YES (the default) Doxygen will
|
||||
# evaluate all C-preprocessor directives found in the sources and include
|
||||
# files.
|
||||
|
||||
ENABLE_PREPROCESSING = YES
|
||||
|
||||
# If the MACRO_EXPANSION tag is set to YES Doxygen will expand all macro
|
||||
# names in the source code. If set to NO (the default) only conditional
|
||||
# compilation will be performed. Macro expansion can be done in a controlled
|
||||
# way by setting EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF to YES.
|
||||
|
||||
MACRO_EXPANSION = YES
|
||||
|
||||
# If the EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF and MACRO_EXPANSION tags are both set to YES
|
||||
# then the macro expansion is limited to the macros specified with the
|
||||
# PREDEFINED and EXPAND_AS_DEFINED tags.
|
||||
|
||||
EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF = YES
|
||||
|
||||
# If the SEARCH_INCLUDES tag is set to YES (the default) the includes files
|
||||
# in the INCLUDE_PATH (see below) will be search if a #include is found.
|
||||
|
||||
SEARCH_INCLUDES = YES
|
||||
|
||||
# The INCLUDE_PATH tag can be used to specify one or more directories that
|
||||
# contain include files that are not input files but should be processed by
|
||||
# the preprocessor.
|
||||
|
||||
INCLUDE_PATH =
|
||||
|
||||
# You can use the INCLUDE_FILE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard
|
||||
# patterns (like *.h and *.hpp) to filter out the header-files in the
|
||||
# directories. If left blank, the patterns specified with FILE_PATTERNS will
|
||||
# be used.
|
||||
|
||||
INCLUDE_FILE_PATTERNS =
|
||||
|
||||
# The PREDEFINED tag can be used to specify one or more macro names that
|
||||
# are defined before the preprocessor is started (similar to the -D option of
|
||||
# gcc). The argument of the tag is a list of macros of the form: name
|
||||
# or name=definition (no spaces). If the definition and the = are
|
||||
# omitted =1 is assumed. To prevent a macro definition from being
|
||||
# undefined via #undef or recursively expanded use the := operator
|
||||
# instead of the = operator.
|
||||
|
||||
PREDEFINED = __DOXYGEN__
|
||||
|
||||
# If the MACRO_EXPANSION and EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF tags are set to YES then
|
||||
# this tag can be used to specify a list of macro names that should be expanded.
|
||||
# The macro definition that is found in the sources will be used.
|
||||
# Use the PREDEFINED tag if you want to use a different macro definition.
|
||||
|
||||
EXPAND_AS_DEFINED = BUTTLOADTAG
|
||||
|
||||
# If the SKIP_FUNCTION_MACROS tag is set to YES (the default) then
|
||||
# doxygen's preprocessor will remove all function-like macros that are alone
|
||||
# on a line, have an all uppercase name, and do not end with a semicolon. Such
|
||||
# function macros are typically used for boiler-plate code, and will confuse
|
||||
# the parser if not removed.
|
||||
|
||||
SKIP_FUNCTION_MACROS = YES
|
||||
|
||||
#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
|
||||
# Configuration::additions related to external references
|
||||
#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
|
||||
|
||||
# The TAGFILES option can be used to specify one or more tagfiles.
|
||||
# Optionally an initial location of the external documentation
|
||||
# can be added for each tagfile. The format of a tag file without
|
||||
# this location is as follows:
|
||||
# TAGFILES = file1 file2 ...
|
||||
# Adding location for the tag files is done as follows:
|
||||
# TAGFILES = file1=loc1 "file2 = loc2" ...
|
||||
# where "loc1" and "loc2" can be relative or absolute paths or
|
||||
# URLs. If a location is present for each tag, the installdox tool
|
||||
# does not have to be run to correct the links.
|
||||
# Note that each tag file must have a unique name
|
||||
# (where the name does NOT include the path)
|
||||
# If a tag file is not located in the directory in which doxygen
|
||||
# is run, you must also specify the path to the tagfile here.
|
||||
|
||||
TAGFILES =
|
||||
|
||||
# When a file name is specified after GENERATE_TAGFILE, doxygen will create
|
||||
# a tag file that is based on the input files it reads.
|
||||
|
||||
GENERATE_TAGFILE =
|
||||
|
||||
# If the ALLEXTERNALS tag is set to YES all external classes will be listed
|
||||
# in the class index. If set to NO only the inherited external classes
|
||||
# will be listed.
|
||||
|
||||
ALLEXTERNALS = NO
|
||||
|
||||
# If the EXTERNAL_GROUPS tag is set to YES all external groups will be listed
|
||||
# in the modules index. If set to NO, only the current project's groups will
|
||||
# be listed.
|
||||
|
||||
EXTERNAL_GROUPS = YES
|
||||
|
||||
# The PERL_PATH should be the absolute path and name of the perl script
|
||||
# interpreter (i.e. the result of `which perl').
|
||||
|
||||
PERL_PATH = /usr/bin/perl
|
||||
|
||||
#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
|
||||
# Configuration options related to the dot tool
|
||||
#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
|
||||
|
||||
# If the CLASS_DIAGRAMS tag is set to YES (the default) Doxygen will
|
||||
# generate a inheritance diagram (in HTML, RTF and LaTeX) for classes with base
|
||||
# or super classes. Setting the tag to NO turns the diagrams off. Note that
|
||||
# this option is superseded by the HAVE_DOT option below. This is only a
|
||||
# fallback. It is recommended to install and use dot, since it yields more
|
||||
# powerful graphs.
|
||||
|
||||
CLASS_DIAGRAMS = NO
|
||||
|
||||
# You can define message sequence charts within doxygen comments using the \msc
|
||||
# command. Doxygen will then run the mscgen tool (see
|
||||
# http://www.mcternan.me.uk/mscgen/) to produce the chart and insert it in the
|
||||
# documentation. The MSCGEN_PATH tag allows you to specify the directory where
|
||||
# the mscgen tool resides. If left empty the tool is assumed to be found in the
|
||||
# default search path.
|
||||
|
||||
MSCGEN_PATH =
|
||||
|
||||
# If set to YES, the inheritance and collaboration graphs will hide
|
||||
# inheritance and usage relations if the target is undocumented
|
||||
# or is not a class.
|
||||
|
||||
HIDE_UNDOC_RELATIONS = YES
|
||||
|
||||
# If you set the HAVE_DOT tag to YES then doxygen will assume the dot tool is
|
||||
# available from the path. This tool is part of Graphviz, a graph visualization
|
||||
# toolkit from AT&T and Lucent Bell Labs. The other options in this section
|
||||
# have no effect if this option is set to NO (the default)
|
||||
|
||||
HAVE_DOT = NO
|
||||
|
||||
# By default doxygen will write a font called FreeSans.ttf to the output
|
||||
# directory and reference it in all dot files that doxygen generates. This
|
||||
# font does not include all possible unicode characters however, so when you need
|
||||
# these (or just want a differently looking font) you can specify the font name
|
||||
# using DOT_FONTNAME. You need need to make sure dot is able to find the font,
|
||||
# which can be done by putting it in a standard location or by setting the
|
||||
# DOTFONTPATH environment variable or by setting DOT_FONTPATH to the directory
|
||||
# containing the font.
|
||||
|
||||
DOT_FONTNAME = FreeSans
|
||||
|
||||
# The DOT_FONTSIZE tag can be used to set the size of the font of dot graphs.
|
||||
# The default size is 10pt.
|
||||
|
||||
DOT_FONTSIZE = 10
|
||||
|
||||
# By default doxygen will tell dot to use the output directory to look for the
|
||||
# FreeSans.ttf font (which doxygen will put there itself). If you specify a
|
||||
# different font using DOT_FONTNAME you can set the path where dot
|
||||
# can find it using this tag.
|
||||
|
||||
DOT_FONTPATH =
|
||||
|
||||
# If the CLASS_GRAPH and HAVE_DOT tags are set to YES then doxygen
|
||||
# will generate a graph for each documented class showing the direct and
|
||||
# indirect inheritance relations. Setting this tag to YES will force the
|
||||
# the CLASS_DIAGRAMS tag to NO.
|
||||
|
||||
CLASS_GRAPH = NO
|
||||
|
||||
# If the COLLABORATION_GRAPH and HAVE_DOT tags are set to YES then doxygen
|
||||
# will generate a graph for each documented class showing the direct and
|
||||
# indirect implementation dependencies (inheritance, containment, and
|
||||
# class references variables) of the class with other documented classes.
|
||||
|
||||
COLLABORATION_GRAPH = NO
|
||||
|
||||
# If the GROUP_GRAPHS and HAVE_DOT tags are set to YES then doxygen
|
||||
# will generate a graph for groups, showing the direct groups dependencies
|
||||
|
||||
GROUP_GRAPHS = NO
|
||||
|
||||
# If the UML_LOOK tag is set to YES doxygen will generate inheritance and
|
||||
# collaboration diagrams in a style similar to the OMG's Unified Modeling
|
||||
# Language.
|
||||
|
||||
UML_LOOK = NO
|
||||
|
||||
# If set to YES, the inheritance and collaboration graphs will show the
|
||||
# relations between templates and their instances.
|
||||
|
||||
TEMPLATE_RELATIONS = NO
|
||||
|
||||
# If the ENABLE_PREPROCESSING, SEARCH_INCLUDES, INCLUDE_GRAPH, and HAVE_DOT
|
||||
# tags are set to YES then doxygen will generate a graph for each documented
|
||||
# file showing the direct and indirect include dependencies of the file with
|
||||
# other documented files.
|
||||
|
||||
INCLUDE_GRAPH = NO
|
||||
|
||||
# If the ENABLE_PREPROCESSING, SEARCH_INCLUDES, INCLUDED_BY_GRAPH, and
|
||||
# HAVE_DOT tags are set to YES then doxygen will generate a graph for each
|
||||
# documented header file showing the documented files that directly or
|
||||
# indirectly include this file.
|
||||
|
||||
INCLUDED_BY_GRAPH = NO
|
||||
|
||||
# If the CALL_GRAPH and HAVE_DOT options are set to YES then
|
||||
# doxygen will generate a call dependency graph for every global function
|
||||
# or class method. Note that enabling this option will significantly increase
|
||||
# the time of a run. So in most cases it will be better to enable call graphs
|
||||
# for selected functions only using the \callgraph command.
|
||||
|
||||
CALL_GRAPH = NO
|
||||
|
||||
# If the CALLER_GRAPH and HAVE_DOT tags are set to YES then
|
||||
# doxygen will generate a caller dependency graph for every global function
|
||||
# or class method. Note that enabling this option will significantly increase
|
||||
# the time of a run. So in most cases it will be better to enable caller
|
||||
# graphs for selected functions only using the \callergraph command.
|
||||
|
||||
CALLER_GRAPH = NO
|
||||
|
||||
# If the GRAPHICAL_HIERARCHY and HAVE_DOT tags are set to YES then doxygen
|
||||
# will graphical hierarchy of all classes instead of a textual one.
|
||||
|
||||
GRAPHICAL_HIERARCHY = NO
|
||||
|
||||
# If the DIRECTORY_GRAPH, SHOW_DIRECTORIES and HAVE_DOT tags are set to YES
|
||||
# then doxygen will show the dependencies a directory has on other directories
|
||||
# in a graphical way. The dependency relations are determined by the #include
|
||||
# relations between the files in the directories.
|
||||
|
||||
DIRECTORY_GRAPH = NO
|
||||
|
||||
# The DOT_IMAGE_FORMAT tag can be used to set the image format of the images
|
||||
# generated by dot. Possible values are png, jpg, or gif
|
||||
# If left blank png will be used.
|
||||
|
||||
DOT_IMAGE_FORMAT = png
|
||||
|
||||
# The tag DOT_PATH can be used to specify the path where the dot tool can be
|
||||
# found. If left blank, it is assumed the dot tool can be found in the path.
|
||||
|
||||
DOT_PATH = "C:/Program Files/Graphviz2.18/bin"
|
||||
|
||||
# The DOTFILE_DIRS tag can be used to specify one or more directories that
|
||||
# contain dot files that are included in the documentation (see the
|
||||
# \dotfile command).
|
||||
|
||||
DOTFILE_DIRS =
|
||||
|
||||
# The DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES tag can be used to set the maximum number of
|
||||
# nodes that will be shown in the graph. If the number of nodes in a graph
|
||||
# becomes larger than this value, doxygen will truncate the graph, which is
|
||||
# visualized by representing a node as a red box. Note that doxygen if the
|
||||
# number of direct children of the root node in a graph is already larger than
|
||||
# DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES then the graph will not be shown at all. Also note
|
||||
# that the size of a graph can be further restricted by MAX_DOT_GRAPH_DEPTH.
|
||||
|
||||
DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES = 15
|
||||
|
||||
# The MAX_DOT_GRAPH_DEPTH tag can be used to set the maximum depth of the
|
||||
# graphs generated by dot. A depth value of 3 means that only nodes reachable
|
||||
# from the root by following a path via at most 3 edges will be shown. Nodes
|
||||
# that lay further from the root node will be omitted. Note that setting this
|
||||
# option to 1 or 2 may greatly reduce the computation time needed for large
|
||||
# code bases. Also note that the size of a graph can be further restricted by
|
||||
# DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES. Using a depth of 0 means no depth restriction.
|
||||
|
||||
MAX_DOT_GRAPH_DEPTH = 2
|
||||
|
||||
# Set the DOT_TRANSPARENT tag to YES to generate images with a transparent
|
||||
# background. This is disabled by default, because dot on Windows does not
|
||||
# seem to support this out of the box. Warning: Depending on the platform used,
|
||||
# enabling this option may lead to badly anti-aliased labels on the edges of
|
||||
# a graph (i.e. they become hard to read).
|
||||
|
||||
DOT_TRANSPARENT = YES
|
||||
|
||||
# Set the DOT_MULTI_TARGETS tag to YES allow dot to generate multiple output
|
||||
# files in one run (i.e. multiple -o and -T options on the command line). This
|
||||
# makes dot run faster, but since only newer versions of dot (>1.8.10)
|
||||
# support this, this feature is disabled by default.
|
||||
|
||||
DOT_MULTI_TARGETS = NO
|
||||
|
||||
# If the GENERATE_LEGEND tag is set to YES (the default) Doxygen will
|
||||
# generate a legend page explaining the meaning of the various boxes and
|
||||
# arrows in the dot generated graphs.
|
||||
|
||||
GENERATE_LEGEND = YES
|
||||
|
||||
# If the DOT_CLEANUP tag is set to YES (the default) Doxygen will
|
||||
# remove the intermediate dot files that are used to generate
|
||||
# the various graphs.
|
||||
|
||||
DOT_CLEANUP = YES
|
||||
|
||||
#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
|
||||
# Configuration::additions related to the search engine
|
||||
#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
|
||||
|
||||
# The SEARCHENGINE tag specifies whether or not a search engine should be
|
||||
# used. If set to NO the values of all tags below this one will be ignored.
|
||||
|
||||
SEARCHENGINE = NO
|
@ -0,0 +1,714 @@
|
||||
# Hey Emacs, this is a -*- makefile -*-
|
||||
#----------------------------------------------------------------------------
|
||||
# WinAVR Makefile Template written by Eric B. Weddington, Jörg Wunsch, et al.
|
||||
# >> Modified for use with the LUFA project. <<
|
||||
#
|
||||
# Released to the Public Domain
|
||||
#
|
||||
# Additional material for this makefile was written by:
|
||||
# Peter Fleury
|
||||
# Tim Henigan
|
||||
# Colin O'Flynn
|
||||
# Reiner Patommel
|
||||
# Markus Pfaff
|
||||
# Sander Pool
|
||||
# Frederik Rouleau
|
||||
# Carlos Lamas
|
||||
# Dean Camera
|
||||
# Opendous Inc.
|
||||
# Denver Gingerich
|
||||
#
|
||||
#----------------------------------------------------------------------------
|
||||
# On command line:
|
||||
#
|
||||
# make all = Make software.
|
||||
#
|
||||
# make clean = Clean out built project files.
|
||||
#
|
||||
# make coff = Convert ELF to AVR COFF.
|
||||
#
|
||||
# make extcoff = Convert ELF to AVR Extended COFF.
|
||||
#
|
||||
# make program = Download the hex file to the device, using avrdude.
|
||||
# Please customize the avrdude settings below first!
|
||||
#
|
||||
# make dfu = Download the hex file to the device, using dfu-programmer (must
|
||||
# have dfu-programmer installed).
|
||||
#
|
||||
# make flip = Download the hex file to the device, using Atmel FLIP (must
|
||||
# have Atmel FLIP installed).
|
||||
#
|
||||
# make dfu-ee = Download the eeprom file to the device, using dfu-programmer
|
||||
# (must have dfu-programmer installed).
|
||||
#
|
||||
# make flip-ee = Download the eeprom file to the device, using Atmel FLIP
|
||||
# (must have Atmel FLIP installed).
|
||||
#
|
||||
# make doxygen = Generate DoxyGen documentation for the project (must have
|
||||
# DoxyGen installed)
|
||||
#
|
||||
# make debug = Start either simulavr or avarice as specified for debugging,
|
||||
# with avr-gdb or avr-insight as the front end for debugging.
|
||||
#
|
||||
# make filename.s = Just compile filename.c into the assembler code only.
|
||||
#
|
||||
# make filename.i = Create a preprocessed source file for use in submitting
|
||||
# bug reports to the GCC project.
|
||||
#
|
||||
# To rebuild project do "make clean" then "make all".
|
||||
#----------------------------------------------------------------------------
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
# MCU name
|
||||
MCU = at90usb1287
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
# Target board (see library BoardTypes.h documentation, USER or blank for projects not requiring
|
||||
# LUFA board drivers). If USER is selected, put custom board drivers in a directory called
|
||||
# "Board" inside the application directory.
|
||||
BOARD = USBKEY
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
# Processor frequency.
|
||||
# This will define a symbol, F_CPU, in all source code files equal to the
|
||||
# processor frequency. You can then use this symbol in your source code to
|
||||
# calculate timings. Do NOT tack on a 'UL' at the end, this will be done
|
||||
# automatically to create a 32-bit value in your source code.
|
||||
# Typical values are:
|
||||
# F_CPU = 1000000
|
||||
# F_CPU = 1843200
|
||||
# F_CPU = 2000000
|
||||
# F_CPU = 3686400
|
||||
# F_CPU = 4000000
|
||||
# F_CPU = 7372800
|
||||
# F_CPU = 8000000
|
||||
# F_CPU = 11059200
|
||||
# F_CPU = 14745600
|
||||
# F_CPU = 16000000
|
||||
# F_CPU = 18432000
|
||||
# F_CPU = 20000000
|
||||
F_CPU = 8000000
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
# Output format. (can be srec, ihex, binary)
|
||||
FORMAT = ihex
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
# Target file name (without extension).
|
||||
TARGET = BootloaderDFU
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
# Object files directory
|
||||
# To put object files in current directory, use a dot (.), do NOT make
|
||||
# this an empty or blank macro!
|
||||
OBJDIR = .
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
# List C source files here. (C dependencies are automatically generated.)
|
||||
SRC = $(TARGET).c \
|
||||
Descriptors.c \
|
||||
../../LUFA/Drivers/USB/LowLevel/LowLevel.c \
|
||||
../../LUFA/Drivers/USB/LowLevel/Endpoint.c \
|
||||
../../LUFA/Drivers/USB/LowLevel/DevChapter9.c \
|
||||
../../LUFA/Drivers/USB/HighLevel/USBTask.c \
|
||||
../../LUFA/Drivers/USB/HighLevel/USBInterrupt.c \
|
||||
../../LUFA/Drivers/USB/HighLevel/Events.c \
|
||||
../../LUFA/Drivers/USB/HighLevel/StdDescriptors.c \
|
||||
|
||||
# List C++ source files here. (C dependencies are automatically generated.)
|
||||
CPPSRC =
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
# List Assembler source files here.
|
||||
# Make them always end in a capital .S. Files ending in a lowercase .s
|
||||
# will not be considered source files but generated files (assembler
|
||||
# output from the compiler), and will be deleted upon "make clean"!
|
||||
# Even though the DOS/Win* filesystem matches both .s and .S the same,
|
||||
# it will preserve the spelling of the filenames, and gcc itself does
|
||||
# care about how the name is spelled on its command-line.
|
||||
ASRC =
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
# Optimization level, can be [0, 1, 2, 3, s].
|
||||
# 0 = turn off optimization. s = optimize for size.
|
||||
# (Note: 3 is not always the best optimization level. See avr-libc FAQ.)
|
||||
OPT = s
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
# Debugging format.
|
||||
# Native formats for AVR-GCC's -g are dwarf-2 [default] or stabs.
|
||||
# AVR Studio 4.10 requires dwarf-2.
|
||||
# AVR [Extended] COFF format requires stabs, plus an avr-objcopy run.
|
||||
DEBUG = dwarf-2
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
# List any extra directories to look for include files here.
|
||||
# Each directory must be seperated by a space.
|
||||
# Use forward slashes for directory separators.
|
||||
# For a directory that has spaces, enclose it in quotes.
|
||||
EXTRAINCDIRS = ../../
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
# Compiler flag to set the C Standard level.
|
||||
# c89 = "ANSI" C
|
||||
# gnu89 = c89 plus GCC extensions
|
||||
# c99 = ISO C99 standard (not yet fully implemented)
|
||||
# gnu99 = c99 plus GCC extensions
|
||||
CSTANDARD = -std=gnu99
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
# Starting byte address of the bootloader
|
||||
BOOT_START = 0x1E000
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
# Place -D or -U options here for C sources
|
||||
CDEFS = -DF_CPU=$(F_CPU)UL -DBOARD=BOARD_$(BOARD) -DUSE_NONSTANDARD_DESCRIPTOR_NAMES -DSTATIC_ENDPOINT_CONFIGURATION
|
||||
CDEFS += -DUSB_DEVICE_ONLY -DUSE_STATIC_OPTIONS="(USB_DEVICE_OPT_FULLSPEED | USB_OPT_REG_ENABLED | USB_OPT_AUTO_PLL)"
|
||||
CDEFS += -DUSE_RAM_DESCRIPTORS -DBOOT_START_ADDR=$(BOOT_START)UL -DFIXED_CONTROL_ENDPOINT_SIZE=32 -DUSE_SINGLE_DEVICE_CONFIGURATION
|
||||
CDEFS += -DNO_CLEARSET_FEATURE_REQUEST
|
||||
|
||||
# Place -D or -U options here for ASM sources
|
||||
ADEFS = -DF_CPU=$(F_CPU)
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
# Place -D or -U options here for C++ sources
|
||||
CPPDEFS = -DF_CPU=$(F_CPU)UL
|
||||
#CPPDEFS += -D__STDC_LIMIT_MACROS
|
||||
#CPPDEFS += -D__STDC_CONSTANT_MACROS
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
#---------------- Compiler Options C ----------------
|
||||
# -g*: generate debugging information
|
||||
# -O*: optimization level
|
||||
# -f...: tuning, see GCC manual and avr-libc documentation
|
||||
# -Wall...: warning level
|
||||
# -Wa,...: tell GCC to pass this to the assembler.
|
||||
# -adhlns...: create assembler listing
|
||||
CFLAGS = -g$(DEBUG)
|
||||
CFLAGS += $(CDEFS)
|
||||
CFLAGS += -O$(OPT)
|
||||
CFLAGS += -funsigned-char
|
||||
CFLAGS += -funsigned-bitfields
|
||||
CFLAGS += -ffunction-sections
|
||||
CFLAGS += -fdata-sections
|
||||
CFLAGS += -fpack-struct
|
||||
CFLAGS += -fshort-enums
|
||||
CFLAGS += -fno-inline-small-functions
|
||||
CFLAGS += -fno-reorder-blocks
|
||||
CFLAGS += -fno-reorder-blocks-and-partition
|
||||
CFLAGS += -fno-reorder-functions
|
||||
CFLAGS += -fno-toplevel-reorder
|
||||
CFLAGS += -Wall
|
||||
CFLAGS += -Wstrict-prototypes
|
||||
CFLAGS += -Wundef
|
||||
#CFLAGS += -fno-unit-at-a-time
|
||||
#CFLAGS += -Wunreachable-code
|
||||
#CFLAGS += -Wsign-compare
|
||||
CFLAGS += -Wa,-adhlns=$(<:%.c=$(OBJDIR)/%.lst)
|
||||
CFLAGS += $(patsubst %,-I%,$(EXTRAINCDIRS))
|
||||
CFLAGS += $(CSTANDARD)
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
#---------------- Compiler Options C++ ----------------
|
||||
# -g*: generate debugging information
|
||||
# -O*: optimization level
|
||||
# -f...: tuning, see GCC manual and avr-libc documentation
|
||||
# -Wall...: warning level
|
||||
# -Wa,...: tell GCC to pass this to the assembler.
|
||||
# -adhlns...: create assembler listing
|
||||
CPPFLAGS = -g$(DEBUG)
|
||||
CPPFLAGS += $(CPPDEFS)
|
||||
CPPFLAGS += -O$(OPT)
|
||||
CPPFLAGS += -funsigned-char
|
||||
CPPFLAGS += -funsigned-bitfields
|
||||
CPPFLAGS += -fpack-struct
|
||||
CPPFLAGS += -fshort-enums
|
||||
CPPFLAGS += -fno-exceptions
|
||||
CPPFLAGS += -Wall
|
||||
CFLAGS += -Wundef
|
||||
#CPPFLAGS += -mshort-calls
|
||||
#CPPFLAGS += -fno-unit-at-a-time
|
||||
#CPPFLAGS += -Wstrict-prototypes
|
||||
#CPPFLAGS += -Wunreachable-code
|
||||
#CPPFLAGS += -Wsign-compare
|
||||
CPPFLAGS += -Wa,-adhlns=$(<:%.cpp=$(OBJDIR)/%.lst)
|
||||
CPPFLAGS += $(patsubst %,-I%,$(EXTRAINCDIRS))
|
||||
#CPPFLAGS += $(CSTANDARD)
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
#---------------- Assembler Options ----------------
|
||||
# -Wa,...: tell GCC to pass this to the assembler.
|
||||
# -adhlns: create listing
|
||||
# -gstabs: have the assembler create line number information; note that
|
||||
# for use in COFF files, additional information about filenames
|
||||
# and function names needs to be present in the assembler source
|
||||
# files -- see avr-libc docs [FIXME: not yet described there]
|
||||
# -listing-cont-lines: Sets the maximum number of continuation lines of hex
|
||||
# dump that will be displayed for a given single line of source input.
|
||||
ASFLAGS = $(ADEFS) -Wa,-adhlns=$(<:%.S=$(OBJDIR)/%.lst),-gstabs,--listing-cont-lines=100
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
#---------------- Library Options ----------------
|
||||
# Minimalistic printf version
|
||||
PRINTF_LIB_MIN = -Wl,-u,vfprintf -lprintf_min
|
||||
|
||||
# Floating point printf version (requires MATH_LIB = -lm below)
|
||||
PRINTF_LIB_FLOAT = -Wl,-u,vfprintf -lprintf_flt
|
||||
|
||||
# If this is left blank, then it will use the Standard printf version.
|
||||
PRINTF_LIB =
|
||||
#PRINTF_LIB = $(PRINTF_LIB_MIN)
|
||||
#PRINTF_LIB = $(PRINTF_LIB_FLOAT)
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
# Minimalistic scanf version
|
||||
SCANF_LIB_MIN = -Wl,-u,vfscanf -lscanf_min
|
||||
|
||||
# Floating point + %[ scanf version (requires MATH_LIB = -lm below)
|
||||
SCANF_LIB_FLOAT = -Wl,-u,vfscanf -lscanf_flt
|
||||
|
||||
# If this is left blank, then it will use the Standard scanf version.
|
||||
SCANF_LIB =
|
||||
#SCANF_LIB = $(SCANF_LIB_MIN)
|
||||
#SCANF_LIB = $(SCANF_LIB_FLOAT)
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
MATH_LIB = -lm
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
# List any extra directories to look for libraries here.
|
||||
# Each directory must be seperated by a space.
|
||||
# Use forward slashes for directory separators.
|
||||
# For a directory that has spaces, enclose it in quotes.
|
||||
EXTRALIBDIRS =
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
#---------------- External Memory Options ----------------
|
||||
|
||||
# 64 KB of external RAM, starting after internal RAM (ATmega128!),
|
||||
# used for variables (.data/.bss) and heap (malloc()).
|
||||
#EXTMEMOPTS = -Wl,-Tdata=0x801100,--defsym=__heap_end=0x80ffff
|
||||
|
||||
# 64 KB of external RAM, starting after internal RAM (ATmega128!),
|
||||
# only used for heap (malloc()).
|
||||
#EXTMEMOPTS = -Wl,--section-start,.data=0x801100,--defsym=__heap_end=0x80ffff
|
||||
|
||||
EXTMEMOPTS =
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
#---------------- Linker Options ----------------
|
||||
# -Wl,...: tell GCC to pass this to linker.
|
||||
# -Map: create map file
|
||||
# --cref: add cross reference to map file
|
||||
LDFLAGS = -Wl,-Map=$(TARGET).map,--cref
|
||||
LDFLAGS += -Wl,--relax
|
||||
LDFLAGS += -Wl,--gc-sections
|
||||
LDFLAGS += -Wl,--section-start=.text=$(BOOT_START)
|
||||
LDFLAGS += $(EXTMEMOPTS)
|
||||
LDFLAGS += $(patsubst %,-L%,$(EXTRALIBDIRS))
|
||||
LDFLAGS += $(PRINTF_LIB) $(SCANF_LIB) $(MATH_LIB)
|
||||
#LDFLAGS += -T linker_script.x
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
#---------------- Programming Options (avrdude) ----------------
|
||||
|
||||
# Programming hardware: alf avr910 avrisp bascom bsd
|
||||
# dt006 pavr picoweb pony-stk200 sp12 stk200 stk500
|
||||
#
|
||||
# Type: avrdude -c ?
|
||||
# to get a full listing.
|
||||
#
|
||||
AVRDUDE_PROGRAMMER = jtagmkII
|
||||
|
||||
# com1 = serial port. Use lpt1 to connect to parallel port.
|
||||
AVRDUDE_PORT = usb
|
||||
|
||||
AVRDUDE_WRITE_FLASH = -U flash:w:$(TARGET).hex
|
||||
#AVRDUDE_WRITE_EEPROM = -U eeprom:w:$(TARGET).eep
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
# Uncomment the following if you want avrdude's erase cycle counter.
|
||||
# Note that this counter needs to be initialized first using -Yn,
|
||||
# see avrdude manual.
|
||||
#AVRDUDE_ERASE_COUNTER = -y
|
||||
|
||||
# Uncomment the following if you do /not/ wish a verification to be
|
||||
# performed after programming the device.
|
||||
AVRDUDE_NO_VERIFY = -V
|
||||
|
||||
# Increase verbosity level. Please use this when submitting bug
|
||||
# reports about avrdude. See <http://savannah.nongnu.org/projects/avrdude>
|
||||
# to submit bug reports.
|
||||
#AVRDUDE_VERBOSE = -v -v
|
||||
|
||||
AVRDUDE_FLAGS = -p $(MCU) -P $(AVRDUDE_PORT) -c $(AVRDUDE_PROGRAMMER)
|
||||
AVRDUDE_FLAGS += $(AVRDUDE_NO_VERIFY)
|
||||
AVRDUDE_FLAGS += $(AVRDUDE_VERBOSE)
|
||||
AVRDUDE_FLAGS += $(AVRDUDE_ERASE_COUNTER)
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
#---------------- Debugging Options ----------------
|
||||
|
||||
# For simulavr only - target MCU frequency.
|
||||
DEBUG_MFREQ = $(F_CPU)
|
||||
|
||||
# Set the DEBUG_UI to either gdb or insight.
|
||||
# DEBUG_UI = gdb
|
||||
DEBUG_UI = insight
|
||||
|
||||
# Set the debugging back-end to either avarice, simulavr.
|
||||
DEBUG_BACKEND = avarice
|
||||
#DEBUG_BACKEND = simulavr
|
||||
|
||||
# GDB Init Filename.
|
||||
GDBINIT_FILE = __avr_gdbinit
|
||||
|
||||
# When using avarice settings for the JTAG
|
||||
JTAG_DEV = /dev/com1
|
||||
|
||||
# Debugging port used to communicate between GDB / avarice / simulavr.
|
||||
DEBUG_PORT = 4242
|
||||
|
||||
# Debugging host used to communicate between GDB / avarice / simulavr, normally
|
||||
# just set to localhost unless doing some sort of crazy debugging when
|
||||
# avarice is running on a different computer.
|
||||
DEBUG_HOST = localhost
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
#============================================================================
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
# Define programs and commands.
|
||||
SHELL = sh
|
||||
CC = avr-gcc
|
||||
OBJCOPY = avr-objcopy
|
||||
OBJDUMP = avr-objdump
|
||||
SIZE = avr-size
|
||||
AR = avr-ar rcs
|
||||
NM = avr-nm
|
||||
AVRDUDE = avrdude
|
||||
REMOVE = rm -f
|
||||
REMOVEDIR = rm -rf
|
||||
COPY = cp
|
||||
WINSHELL = cmd
|
||||
|
||||
# Define Messages
|
||||
# English
|
||||
MSG_ERRORS_NONE = Errors: none
|
||||
MSG_BEGIN = -------- begin --------
|
||||
MSG_END = -------- end --------
|
||||
MSG_SIZE_BEFORE = Size before:
|
||||
MSG_SIZE_AFTER = Size after:
|
||||
MSG_COFF = Converting to AVR COFF:
|
||||
MSG_EXTENDED_COFF = Converting to AVR Extended COFF:
|
||||
MSG_FLASH = Creating load file for Flash:
|
||||
MSG_EEPROM = Creating load file for EEPROM:
|
||||
MSG_EXTENDED_LISTING = Creating Extended Listing:
|
||||
MSG_SYMBOL_TABLE = Creating Symbol Table:
|
||||
MSG_LINKING = Linking:
|
||||
MSG_COMPILING = Compiling C:
|
||||
MSG_COMPILING_CPP = Compiling C++:
|
||||
MSG_ASSEMBLING = Assembling:
|
||||
MSG_CLEANING = Cleaning project:
|
||||
MSG_CREATING_LIBRARY = Creating library:
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
# Define all object files.
|
||||
OBJ = $(SRC:%.c=$(OBJDIR)/%.o) $(CPPSRC:%.cpp=$(OBJDIR)/%.o) $(ASRC:%.S=$(OBJDIR)/%.o)
|
||||
|
||||
# Define all listing files.
|
||||
LST = $(SRC:%.c=$(OBJDIR)/%.lst) $(CPPSRC:%.cpp=$(OBJDIR)/%.lst) $(ASRC:%.S=$(OBJDIR)/%.lst)
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
# Compiler flags to generate dependency files.
|
||||
GENDEPFLAGS = -MMD -MP -MF .dep/$(@F).d
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
# Combine all necessary flags and optional flags.
|
||||
# Add target processor to flags.
|
||||
ALL_CFLAGS = -mmcu=$(MCU) -I. $(CFLAGS) $(GENDEPFLAGS)
|
||||
ALL_CPPFLAGS = -mmcu=$(MCU) -I. -x c++ $(CPPFLAGS) $(GENDEPFLAGS)
|
||||
ALL_ASFLAGS = -mmcu=$(MCU) -I. -x assembler-with-cpp $(ASFLAGS)
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
# Default target.
|
||||
all: begin gccversion sizebefore build checkhooks checklibmode sizeafter end
|
||||
|
||||
# Change the build target to build a HEX file or a library.
|
||||
build: elf hex eep lss sym
|
||||
#build: lib
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
elf: $(TARGET).elf
|
||||
hex: $(TARGET).hex
|
||||
eep: $(TARGET).eep
|
||||
lss: $(TARGET).lss
|
||||
sym: $(TARGET).sym
|
||||
LIBNAME=lib$(TARGET).a
|
||||
lib: $(LIBNAME)
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
# Eye candy.
|
||||
# AVR Studio 3.x does not check make's exit code but relies on
|
||||
# the following magic strings to be generated by the compile job.
|
||||
begin:
|
||||
@echo
|
||||
@echo $(MSG_BEGIN)
|
||||
|
||||
end:
|
||||
@echo $(MSG_END)
|
||||
@echo
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
# Display size of file.
|
||||
HEXSIZE = $(SIZE) --target=$(FORMAT) $(TARGET).hex
|
||||
ELFSIZE = $(SIZE) $(MCU_FLAG) $(FORMAT_FLAG) $(TARGET).elf
|
||||
MCU_FLAG = $(shell $(SIZE) --help | grep -- --mcu > /dev/null && echo --mcu=$(MCU) )
|
||||
FORMAT_FLAG = $(shell $(SIZE) --help | grep -- --format=.*avr > /dev/null && echo --format=avr )
|
||||
|
||||
sizebefore:
|
||||
@if test -f $(TARGET).elf; then echo; echo $(MSG_SIZE_BEFORE); $(ELFSIZE); \
|
||||
2>/dev/null; echo; fi
|
||||
|
||||
sizeafter:
|
||||
@if test -f $(TARGET).elf; then echo; echo $(MSG_SIZE_AFTER); $(ELFSIZE); \
|
||||
2>/dev/null; echo; fi
|
||||
|
||||
checkhooks: build
|
||||
@echo
|
||||
@echo ------- Unhooked LUFA Events -------
|
||||
@$(shell) (grep -s '^Event.*LUFA/.*\\.o' $(TARGET).map | \
|
||||
cut -d' ' -f1 | cut -d'_' -f2- | grep ".*") || \
|
||||
echo "(None)"
|
||||
@echo ----- End Unhooked LUFA Events -----
|
||||
|
||||
checklibmode:
|
||||
@echo
|
||||
@echo ----------- Library Mode -----------
|
||||
@$(shell) ($(CC) $(ALL_CFLAGS) -E -dM - < /dev/null \
|
||||
| grep 'USB_\(DEVICE\|HOST\)_ONLY' | cut -d' ' -f2 | grep ".*") \
|
||||
|| echo "No specific mode (both device and host mode allowable)."
|
||||
@echo ------------------------------------
|
||||
|
||||
# Display compiler version information.
|
||||
gccversion :
|
||||
@$(CC) --version
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
# Program the device.
|
||||
program: $(TARGET).hex $(TARGET).eep
|
||||
$(AVRDUDE) $(AVRDUDE_FLAGS) $(AVRDUDE_WRITE_FLASH) $(AVRDUDE_WRITE_EEPROM)
|
||||
|
||||
flip: $(TARGET).hex
|
||||
batchisp -hardware usb -device $(MCU) -operation erase f
|
||||
batchisp -hardware usb -device $(MCU) -operation loadbuffer $(TARGET).hex program
|
||||
batchisp -hardware usb -device $(MCU) -operation start reset 0
|
||||
|
||||
dfu: $(TARGET).hex
|
||||
dfu-programmer $(MCU) erase
|
||||
dfu-programmer $(MCU) flash --debug 1 $(TARGET).hex
|
||||
dfu-programmer $(MCU) reset
|
||||
|
||||
flip-ee: $(TARGET).hex $(TARGET).eep
|
||||
copy $(TARGET).eep $(TARGET)eep.hex
|
||||
batchisp -hardware usb -device $(MCU) -operation memory EEPROM erase
|
||||
batchisp -hardware usb -device $(MCU) -operation memory EEPROM loadbuffer $(TARGET)eep.hex program
|
||||
batchisp -hardware usb -device $(MCU) -operation start reset 0
|
||||
|
||||
dfu-ee: $(TARGET).hex $(TARGET).eep
|
||||
dfu-programmer $(MCU) erase
|
||||
dfu-programmer $(MCU) eeprom --debug 1 $(TARGET).eep
|
||||
dfu-programmer $(MCU) reset
|
||||
|
||||
# Generate avr-gdb config/init file which does the following:
|
||||
# define the reset signal, load the target file, connect to target, and set
|
||||
# a breakpoint at main().
|
||||
gdb-config:
|
||||
@$(REMOVE) $(GDBINIT_FILE)
|
||||
@echo define reset >> $(GDBINIT_FILE)
|
||||
@echo SIGNAL SIGHUP >> $(GDBINIT_FILE)
|
||||
@echo end >> $(GDBINIT_FILE)
|
||||
@echo file $(TARGET).elf >> $(GDBINIT_FILE)
|
||||
@echo target remote $(DEBUG_HOST):$(DEBUG_PORT) >> $(GDBINIT_FILE)
|
||||
ifeq ($(DEBUG_BACKEND),simulavr)
|
||||
@echo load >> $(GDBINIT_FILE)
|
||||
endif
|
||||
@echo break main >> $(GDBINIT_FILE)
|
||||
|
||||
debug: gdb-config $(TARGET).elf
|
||||
ifeq ($(DEBUG_BACKEND), avarice)
|
||||
@echo Starting AVaRICE - Press enter when "waiting to connect" message displays.
|
||||
@$(WINSHELL) /c start avarice --jtag $(JTAG_DEV) --erase --program --file \
|
||||
$(TARGET).elf $(DEBUG_HOST):$(DEBUG_PORT)
|
||||
@$(WINSHELL) /c pause
|
||||
|
||||
else
|
||||
@$(WINSHELL) /c start simulavr --gdbserver --device $(MCU) --clock-freq \
|
||||
$(DEBUG_MFREQ) --port $(DEBUG_PORT)
|
||||
endif
|
||||
@$(WINSHELL) /c start avr-$(DEBUG_UI) --command=$(GDBINIT_FILE)
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
# Convert ELF to COFF for use in debugging / simulating in AVR Studio or VMLAB.
|
||||
COFFCONVERT = $(OBJCOPY) --debugging
|
||||
COFFCONVERT += --change-section-address .data-0x800000
|
||||
COFFCONVERT += --change-section-address .bss-0x800000
|
||||
COFFCONVERT += --change-section-address .noinit-0x800000
|
||||
COFFCONVERT += --change-section-address .eeprom-0x810000
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
coff: $(TARGET).elf
|
||||
@echo
|
||||
@echo $(MSG_COFF) $(TARGET).cof
|
||||
$(COFFCONVERT) -O coff-avr $< $(TARGET).cof
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
extcoff: $(TARGET).elf
|
||||
@echo
|
||||
@echo $(MSG_EXTENDED_COFF) $(TARGET).cof
|
||||
$(COFFCONVERT) -O coff-ext-avr $< $(TARGET).cof
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
# Create final output files (.hex, .eep) from ELF output file.
|
||||
%.hex: %.elf
|
||||
@echo
|
||||
@echo $(MSG_FLASH) $@
|
||||
$(OBJCOPY) -O $(FORMAT) -R .eeprom $< $@
|
||||
|
||||
%.eep: %.elf
|
||||
@echo
|
||||
@echo $(MSG_EEPROM) $@
|
||||
-$(OBJCOPY) -j .eeprom --set-section-flags=.eeprom="alloc,load" \
|
||||
--change-section-lma .eeprom=0 --no-change-warnings -O $(FORMAT) $< $@ || exit 0
|
||||
|
||||
# Create extended listing file from ELF output file.
|
||||
%.lss: %.elf
|
||||
@echo
|
||||
@echo $(MSG_EXTENDED_LISTING) $@
|
||||
$(OBJDUMP) -h -z -S $< > $@
|
||||
|
||||
# Create a symbol table from ELF output file.
|
||||
%.sym: %.elf
|
||||
@echo
|
||||
@echo $(MSG_SYMBOL_TABLE) $@
|
||||
$(NM) -n $< > $@
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
# Create library from object files.
|
||||
.SECONDARY : $(TARGET).a
|
||||
.PRECIOUS : $(OBJ)
|
||||
%.a: $(OBJ)
|
||||
@echo
|
||||
@echo $(MSG_CREATING_LIBRARY) $@
|
||||
$(AR) $@ $(OBJ)
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
# Link: create ELF output file from object files.
|
||||
.SECONDARY : $(TARGET).elf
|
||||
.PRECIOUS : $(OBJ)
|
||||
%.elf: $(OBJ)
|
||||
@echo
|
||||
@echo $(MSG_LINKING) $@
|
||||
$(CC) $(ALL_CFLAGS) $^ --output $@ $(LDFLAGS)
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
# Compile: create object files from C source files.
|
||||
$(OBJDIR)/%.o : %.c
|
||||
@echo
|
||||
@echo $(MSG_COMPILING) $<
|
||||
$(CC) -c $(ALL_CFLAGS) $< -o $@
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
# Compile: create object files from C++ source files.
|
||||
$(OBJDIR)/%.o : %.cpp
|
||||
@echo
|
||||
@echo $(MSG_COMPILING_CPP) $<
|
||||
$(CC) -c $(ALL_CPPFLAGS) $< -o $@
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
# Compile: create assembler files from C source files.
|
||||
%.s : %.c
|
||||
$(CC) -S $(ALL_CFLAGS) $< -o $@
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
# Compile: create assembler files from C++ source files.
|
||||
%.s : %.cpp
|
||||
$(CC) -S $(ALL_CPPFLAGS) $< -o $@
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
# Assemble: create object files from assembler source files.
|
||||
$(OBJDIR)/%.o : %.S
|
||||
@echo
|
||||
@echo $(MSG_ASSEMBLING) $<
|
||||
$(CC) -c $(ALL_ASFLAGS) $< -o $@
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
# Create preprocessed source for use in sending a bug report.
|
||||
%.i : %.c
|
||||
$(CC) -E -mmcu=$(MCU) -I. $(CFLAGS) $< -o $@
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
# Target: clean project.
|
||||
clean: begin clean_list clean_binary end
|
||||
|
||||
clean_binary:
|
||||
$(REMOVE) $(TARGET).hex
|
||||
|
||||
clean_list:
|
||||
@echo $(MSG_CLEANING)
|
||||
$(REMOVE) $(TARGET).eep
|
||||
$(REMOVE) $(TARGET).cof
|
||||
$(REMOVE) $(TARGET).elf
|
||||
$(REMOVE) $(TARGET).map
|
||||
$(REMOVE) $(TARGET).sym
|
||||
$(REMOVE) $(TARGET).lss
|
||||
$(REMOVE) $(SRC:%.c=$(OBJDIR)/%.o)
|
||||
$(REMOVE) $(SRC:%.c=$(OBJDIR)/%.lst)
|
||||
$(REMOVE) $(ASRC:%.S=$(OBJDIR)/%.o)
|
||||
$(REMOVE) $(ASRC:%.S=$(OBJDIR)/%.lst)
|
||||
$(REMOVE) $(SRC:.c=.s)
|
||||
$(REMOVE) $(SRC:.c=.d)
|
||||
$(REMOVE) $(SRC:.c=.i)
|
||||
$(REMOVEDIR) .dep
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
doxygen:
|
||||
@echo Generating Project Documentation...
|
||||
@doxygen Doxygen.conf
|
||||
@echo Documentation Generation Complete.
|
||||
|
||||
clean_doxygen:
|
||||
rm -rf Documentation
|
||||
|
||||
# Create object files directory
|
||||
$(shell mkdir $(OBJDIR) 2>/dev/null)
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
# Include the dependency files.
|
||||
-include $(shell mkdir .dep 2>/dev/null) $(wildcard .dep/*)
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
# Listing of phony targets.
|
||||
.PHONY : all checkhooks checklibmode begin \
|
||||
finish end sizebefore sizeafter gccversion \
|
||||
build elf hex eep lss sym coff extcoff \
|
||||
clean clean_list clean_binary program debug \
|
||||
gdb-config doxygen clean_doxygen
|
@ -0,0 +1,218 @@
|
||||
/*
|
||||
LUFA Library
|
||||
Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2009.
|
||||
|
||||
dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com
|
||||
www.fourwalledcubicle.com
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
/*
|
||||
Copyright 2009 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com)
|
||||
|
||||
Permission to use, copy, modify, and distribute this software
|
||||
and its documentation for any purpose and without fee is hereby
|
||||
granted, provided that the above copyright notice appear in all
|
||||
copies and that both that the copyright notice and this
|
||||
permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting
|
||||
documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in
|
||||
advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the
|
||||
software without specific, written prior permission.
|
||||
|
||||
The author disclaim all warranties with regard to this
|
||||
software, including all implied warranties of merchantability
|
||||
and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any
|
||||
special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages
|
||||
whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether
|
||||
in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action,
|
||||
arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of
|
||||
this software.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
/** \file
|
||||
*
|
||||
* USB Device Descriptors, for library use when in USB device mode. Descriptors are special
|
||||
* computer-readable structures which the host requests upon device enumeration, to determine
|
||||
* the device's capabilities and functions.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
#include "Descriptors.h"
|
||||
|
||||
/** HID class report descriptor. This is a special descriptor constructed with values from the
|
||||
* USBIF HID class specification to describe the reports and capabilities of the HID device. This
|
||||
* descriptor is parsed by the host and its contents used to determine what data (and in what encoding)
|
||||
* the device will send, and what it may be sent back from the host. Refer to the HID specification for
|
||||
* more details on HID report descriptors.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
USB_Descriptor_HIDReport_Datatype_t HIDReport[] =
|
||||
{
|
||||
0x06, 0x9c, 0xff, /* Usage Page (Vendor Defined) */
|
||||
0x09, 0x19, /* Usage (Vendor Defined) */
|
||||
0xa1, 0x01, /* Collection (Vendor Defined) */
|
||||
0x0a, 0x19, 0x00, /* Usage (Vendor Defined) */
|
||||
0x75, 0x08, /* Report Size (8) */
|
||||
0x95, 0x82, /* Report Count (130) */
|
||||
0x15, 0x00, /* Logical Minimum (0) */
|
||||
0x25, 0xff, /* Logical Maximum (255) */
|
||||
0x91, 0x02, /* Output (Data, Variable, Absolute) */
|
||||
0xc0 /* End Collection */
|
||||
};
|
||||
|
||||
/** Device descriptor structure. This descriptor, located in FLASH memory, describes the overall
|
||||
* device characteristics, including the supported USB version, control endpoint size and the
|
||||
* number of device configurations. The descriptor is read out by the USB host when the enumeration
|
||||
* process begins.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
USB_Descriptor_Device_t DeviceDescriptor =
|
||||
{
|
||||
Header: {Size: sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Device_t), Type: DTYPE_Device},
|
||||
|
||||
USBSpecification: VERSION_BCD(01.10),
|
||||
Class: 0x00,
|
||||
SubClass: 0x00,
|
||||
Protocol: 0x00,
|
||||
|
||||
Endpoint0Size: 8,
|
||||
|
||||
VendorID: 0x16C0,
|
||||
ProductID: 0x0478,
|
||||
ReleaseNumber: 0x0010,
|
||||
|
||||
ManufacturerStrIndex: NO_DESCRIPTOR,
|
||||
ProductStrIndex: 0x01,
|
||||
SerialNumStrIndex: NO_DESCRIPTOR,
|
||||
|
||||
NumberOfConfigurations: 1
|
||||
};
|
||||
|
||||
/** Configuration descriptor structure. This descriptor, located in FLASH memory, describes the usage
|
||||
* of the device in one of its supported configurations, including information about any device interfaces
|
||||
* and endpoints. The descriptor is read out by the USB host during the enumeration process when selecting
|
||||
* a configuration so that the host may correctly communicate with the USB device.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
USB_Descriptor_Configuration_t ConfigurationDescriptor =
|
||||
{
|
||||
Config:
|
||||
{
|
||||
Header: {Size: sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Configuration_Header_t), Type: DTYPE_Configuration},
|
||||
|
||||
TotalConfigurationSize: sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Configuration_t),
|
||||
TotalInterfaces: 1,
|
||||
|
||||
ConfigurationNumber: 1,
|
||||
ConfigurationStrIndex: NO_DESCRIPTOR,
|
||||
|
||||
ConfigAttributes: (USB_CONFIG_ATTR_BUSPOWERED | USB_CONFIG_ATTR_SELFPOWERED),
|
||||
|
||||
MaxPowerConsumption: USB_CONFIG_POWER_MA(100)
|
||||
},
|
||||
|
||||
Interface:
|
||||
{
|
||||
Header: {Size: sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Interface_t), Type: DTYPE_Interface},
|
||||
|
||||
InterfaceNumber: 0x00,
|
||||
AlternateSetting: 0x00,
|
||||
|
||||
TotalEndpoints: 1,
|
||||
|
||||
Class: 0x03,
|
||||
SubClass: 0x00,
|
||||
Protocol: 0x00,
|
||||
|
||||
InterfaceStrIndex: NO_DESCRIPTOR
|
||||
},
|
||||
|
||||
HIDDescriptor:
|
||||
{
|
||||
Header: {Size: sizeof(USB_Descriptor_HID_t), Type: DTYPE_HID},
|
||||
|
||||
HIDSpec: VERSION_BCD(01.11),
|
||||
CountryCode: 0x00,
|
||||
TotalHIDReports: 0x01,
|
||||
HIDReportType: DTYPE_Report,
|
||||
HIDReportLength: sizeof(HIDReport)
|
||||
},
|
||||
|
||||
HIDEndpoint:
|
||||
{
|
||||
Header: {Size: sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t), Type: DTYPE_Endpoint},
|
||||
|
||||
EndpointAddress: (ENDPOINT_DESCRIPTOR_DIR_IN | HID_EPNUM),
|
||||
Attributes: EP_TYPE_INTERRUPT,
|
||||
EndpointSize: HID_EPSIZE,
|
||||
PollingIntervalMS: 0x40
|
||||
},
|
||||
};
|
||||
|
||||
/** Language descriptor structure. This descriptor, located in FLASH memory, is returned when the host requests
|
||||
* the string descriptor with index 0 (the first index). It is actually an array of 16-bit integers, which indicate
|
||||
* via the language ID table available at USB.org what languages the device supports for its string descriptors.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
USB_Descriptor_String_t LanguageString =
|
||||
{
|
||||
Header: {Size: USB_STRING_LEN(1), Type: DTYPE_String},
|
||||
|
||||
UnicodeString: {LANGUAGE_ID_ENG}
|
||||
};
|
||||
|
||||
/** Product descriptor string. This is a Unicode string containing the product's details in human readable form,
|
||||
* and is read out upon request by the host when the appropriate string ID is requested, listed in the Device
|
||||
* Descriptor.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
USB_Descriptor_String_t ProductString =
|
||||
{
|
||||
Header: {Size: USB_STRING_LEN(21), Type: DTYPE_String},
|
||||
|
||||
UnicodeString: L"AVR Teensy Bootloader"
|
||||
};
|
||||
|
||||
/** This function is called by the library when in device mode, and must be overridden (see StdDescriptors.h
|
||||
* documentation) by the application code so that the address and size of a requested descriptor can be given
|
||||
* to the USB library. When the device recieves a Get Descriptor request on the control endpoint, this function
|
||||
* is called so that the descriptor details can be passed back and the appropriate descriptor sent back to the
|
||||
* USB host.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
uint16_t USB_GetDescriptor(const uint16_t wValue, const uint8_t wIndex, void** const DescriptorAddress)
|
||||
{
|
||||
const uint8_t DescriptorType = (wValue >> 8);
|
||||
const uint8_t DescriptorNumber = (wValue & 0xFF);
|
||||
|
||||
void* Address = NULL;
|
||||
uint16_t Size = NO_DESCRIPTOR;
|
||||
|
||||
switch (DescriptorType)
|
||||
{
|
||||
case DTYPE_Device:
|
||||
Address = DESCRIPTOR_ADDRESS(DeviceDescriptor);
|
||||
Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Device_t);
|
||||
break;
|
||||
case DTYPE_Configuration:
|
||||
Address = DESCRIPTOR_ADDRESS(ConfigurationDescriptor);
|
||||
Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Configuration_t);
|
||||
break;
|
||||
case DTYPE_String:
|
||||
if (!(DescriptorNumber))
|
||||
{
|
||||
Address = DESCRIPTOR_ADDRESS(LanguageString);
|
||||
Size = LanguageString.Header.Size;
|
||||
}
|
||||
else
|
||||
{
|
||||
Address = DESCRIPTOR_ADDRESS(ProductString);
|
||||
Size = ProductString.Header.Size;
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
break;
|
||||
case DTYPE_HID:
|
||||
Address = DESCRIPTOR_ADDRESS(ConfigurationDescriptor.HIDDescriptor);
|
||||
Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_HID_t);
|
||||
break;
|
||||
case DTYPE_Report:
|
||||
Address = DESCRIPTOR_ADDRESS(HIDReport);
|
||||
Size = sizeof(HIDReport);
|
||||
break;
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
*DescriptorAddress = Address;
|
||||
return Size;
|
||||
}
|
@ -0,0 +1,91 @@
|
||||
/*
|
||||
LUFA Library
|
||||
Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2009.
|
||||
|
||||
dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com
|
||||
www.fourwalledcubicle.com
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
/*
|
||||
Copyright 2009 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com)
|
||||
|
||||
Permission to use, copy, modify, and distribute this software
|
||||
and its documentation for any purpose and without fee is hereby
|
||||
granted, provided that the above copyright notice appear in all
|
||||
copies and that both that the copyright notice and this
|
||||
permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting
|
||||
documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in
|
||||
advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the
|
||||
software without specific, written prior permission.
|
||||
|
||||
The author disclaim all warranties with regard to this
|
||||
software, including all implied warranties of merchantability
|
||||
and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any
|
||||
special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages
|
||||
whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether
|
||||
in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action,
|
||||
arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of
|
||||
this software.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
/** \file
|
||||
*
|
||||
* Header file for Descriptors.c.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
#ifndef _DESCRIPTORS_H_
|
||||
#define _DESCRIPTORS_H_
|
||||
|
||||
/* Includes: */
|
||||
#include <LUFA/Drivers/USB/USB.h>
|
||||
|
||||
/* Type Defines: */
|
||||
/** Type define for the HID class specific HID descriptor, to describe the HID device's specifications. Refer to the HID
|
||||
* specification for details on the structure elements.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
typedef struct
|
||||
{
|
||||
USB_Descriptor_Header_t Header;
|
||||
|
||||
uint16_t HIDSpec;
|
||||
uint8_t CountryCode;
|
||||
|
||||
uint8_t TotalHIDReports;
|
||||
|
||||
uint8_t HIDReportType;
|
||||
uint16_t HIDReportLength;
|
||||
} USB_Descriptor_HID_t;
|
||||
|
||||
/** Type define for the data type used to store HID report descriptor elements. */
|
||||
typedef uint8_t USB_Descriptor_HIDReport_Datatype_t;
|
||||
|
||||
/** Type define for the device configuration descriptor structure. This must be defined in the
|
||||
* application code, as the configuration descriptor contains several sub-descriptors which
|
||||
* vary between devices, and which describe the device's usage to the host.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
typedef struct
|
||||
{
|
||||
USB_Descriptor_Configuration_Header_t Config;
|
||||
USB_Descriptor_Interface_t Interface;
|
||||
USB_Descriptor_HID_t HIDDescriptor;
|
||||
USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t HIDEndpoint;
|
||||
} USB_Descriptor_Configuration_t;
|
||||
|
||||
/* Macros: */
|
||||
/** Endpoint number of the HID data IN endpoint. */
|
||||
#define HID_EPNUM 1
|
||||
|
||||
/** Size in bytes of the HID reporting IN endpoint. */
|
||||
#define HID_EPSIZE 64
|
||||
|
||||
/** Descriptor header type value, to indicate a HID class HID descriptor. */
|
||||
#define DTYPE_HID 0x21
|
||||
|
||||
/** Descriptor header type value, to indicate a HID class HID report descriptor. */
|
||||
#define DTYPE_Report 0x22
|
||||
|
||||
/* Function Prototypes: */
|
||||
uint16_t USB_GetDescriptor(const uint16_t wValue, const uint8_t wIndex, void** const DescriptorAddress)
|
||||
ATTR_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(3);
|
||||
|
||||
#endif
|
@ -0,0 +1,1485 @@
|
||||
# Doxyfile 1.5.7.1
|
||||
|
||||
# This file describes the settings to be used by the documentation system
|
||||
# doxygen (www.doxygen.org) for a project
|
||||
#
|
||||
# All text after a hash (#) is considered a comment and will be ignored
|
||||
# The format is:
|
||||
# TAG = value [value, ...]
|
||||
# For lists items can also be appended using:
|
||||
# TAG += value [value, ...]
|
||||
# Values that contain spaces should be placed between quotes (" ")
|
||||
|
||||
#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
|
||||
# Project related configuration options
|
||||
#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
|
||||
|
||||
# This tag specifies the encoding used for all characters in the config file
|
||||
# that follow. The default is UTF-8 which is also the encoding used for all
|
||||
# text before the first occurrence of this tag. Doxygen uses libiconv (or the
|
||||
# iconv built into libc) for the transcoding. See
|
||||
# http://www.gnu.org/software/libiconv for the list of possible encodings.
|
||||
|
||||
DOXYFILE_ENCODING = UTF-8
|
||||
|
||||
# The PROJECT_NAME tag is a single word (or a sequence of words surrounded
|
||||
# by quotes) that should identify the project.
|
||||
|
||||
PROJECT_NAME = "LUFA Library - Teensy HID Bootloader"
|
||||
|
||||
# The PROJECT_NUMBER tag can be used to enter a project or revision number.
|
||||
# This could be handy for archiving the generated documentation or
|
||||
# if some version control system is used.
|
||||
|
||||
PROJECT_NUMBER = 0.0.0
|
||||
|
||||
# The OUTPUT_DIRECTORY tag is used to specify the (relative or absolute)
|
||||
# base path where the generated documentation will be put.
|
||||
# If a relative path is entered, it will be relative to the location
|
||||
# where doxygen was started. If left blank the current directory will be used.
|
||||
|
||||
OUTPUT_DIRECTORY = ./Documentation/
|
||||
|
||||
# If the CREATE_SUBDIRS tag is set to YES, then doxygen will create
|
||||
# 4096 sub-directories (in 2 levels) under the output directory of each output
|
||||
# format and will distribute the generated files over these directories.
|
||||
# Enabling this option can be useful when feeding doxygen a huge amount of
|
||||
# source files, where putting all generated files in the same directory would
|
||||
# otherwise cause performance problems for the file system.
|
||||
|
||||
CREATE_SUBDIRS = YES
|
||||
|
||||
# The OUTPUT_LANGUAGE tag is used to specify the language in which all
|
||||
# documentation generated by doxygen is written. Doxygen will use this
|
||||
# information to generate all constant output in the proper language.
|
||||
# The default language is English, other supported languages are:
|
||||
# Afrikaans, Arabic, Brazilian, Catalan, Chinese, Chinese-Traditional,
|
||||
# Croatian, Czech, Danish, Dutch, Farsi, Finnish, French, German, Greek,
|
||||
# Hungarian, Italian, Japanese, Japanese-en (Japanese with English messages),
|
||||
# Korean, Korean-en, Lithuanian, Norwegian, Macedonian, Persian, Polish,
|
||||
# Portuguese, Romanian, Russian, Serbian, Serbian-Cyrilic, Slovak, Slovene,
|
||||
# Spanish, Swedish, and Ukrainian.
|
||||
|
||||
OUTPUT_LANGUAGE = English
|
||||
|
||||
# If the BRIEF_MEMBER_DESC tag is set to YES (the default) Doxygen will
|
||||
# include brief member descriptions after the members that are listed in
|
||||
# the file and class documentation (similar to JavaDoc).
|
||||
# Set to NO to disable this.
|
||||
|
||||
BRIEF_MEMBER_DESC = YES
|
||||
|
||||
# If the REPEAT_BRIEF tag is set to YES (the default) Doxygen will prepend
|
||||
# the brief description of a member or function before the detailed description.
|
||||
# Note: if both HIDE_UNDOC_MEMBERS and BRIEF_MEMBER_DESC are set to NO, the
|
||||
# brief descriptions will be completely suppressed.
|
||||
|
||||
REPEAT_BRIEF = YES
|
||||
|
||||
# This tag implements a quasi-intelligent brief description abbreviator
|
||||
# that is used to form the text in various listings. Each string
|
||||
# in this list, if found as the leading text of the brief description, will be
|
||||
# stripped from the text and the result after processing the whole list, is
|
||||
# used as the annotated text. Otherwise, the brief description is used as-is.
|
||||
# If left blank, the following values are used ("$name" is automatically
|
||||
# replaced with the name of the entity): "The $name class" "The $name widget"
|
||||
# "The $name file" "is" "provides" "specifies" "contains"
|
||||
# "represents" "a" "an" "the"
|
||||
|
||||
ABBREVIATE_BRIEF = "The $name class" \
|
||||
"The $name widget" \
|
||||
"The $name file" \
|
||||
is \
|
||||
provides \
|
||||
specifies \
|
||||
contains \
|
||||
represents \
|
||||
a \
|
||||
an \
|
||||
the
|
||||
|
||||
# If the ALWAYS_DETAILED_SEC and REPEAT_BRIEF tags are both set to YES then
|
||||
# Doxygen will generate a detailed section even if there is only a brief
|
||||
# description.
|
||||
|
||||
ALWAYS_DETAILED_SEC = NO
|
||||
|
||||
# If the INLINE_INHERITED_MEMB tag is set to YES, doxygen will show all
|
||||
# inherited members of a class in the documentation of that class as if those
|
||||
# members were ordinary class members. Constructors, destructors and assignment
|
||||
# operators of the base classes will not be shown.
|
||||
|
||||
INLINE_INHERITED_MEMB = NO
|
||||
|
||||
# If the FULL_PATH_NAMES tag is set to YES then Doxygen will prepend the full
|
||||
# path before files name in the file list and in the header files. If set
|
||||
# to NO the shortest path that makes the file name unique will be used.
|
||||
|
||||
FULL_PATH_NAMES = YES
|
||||
|
||||
# If the FULL_PATH_NAMES tag is set to YES then the STRIP_FROM_PATH tag
|
||||
# can be used to strip a user-defined part of the path. Stripping is
|
||||
# only done if one of the specified strings matches the left-hand part of
|
||||
# the path. The tag can be used to show relative paths in the file list.
|
||||
# If left blank the directory from which doxygen is run is used as the
|
||||
# path to strip.
|
||||
|
||||
STRIP_FROM_PATH =
|
||||
|
||||
# The STRIP_FROM_INC_PATH tag can be used to strip a user-defined part of
|
||||
# the path mentioned in the documentation of a class, which tells
|
||||
# the reader which header file to include in order to use a class.
|
||||
# If left blank only the name of the header file containing the class
|
||||
# definition is used. Otherwise one should specify the include paths that
|
||||
# are normally passed to the compiler using the -I flag.
|
||||
|
||||
STRIP_FROM_INC_PATH =
|
||||
|
||||
# If the SHORT_NAMES tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate much shorter
|
||||
# (but less readable) file names. This can be useful is your file systems
|
||||
# doesn't support long names like on DOS, Mac, or CD-ROM.
|
||||
|
||||
SHORT_NAMES = YES
|
||||
|
||||
# If the JAVADOC_AUTOBRIEF tag is set to YES then Doxygen
|
||||
# will interpret the first line (until the first dot) of a JavaDoc-style
|
||||
# comment as the brief description. If set to NO, the JavaDoc
|
||||
# comments will behave just like regular Qt-style comments
|
||||
# (thus requiring an explicit @brief command for a brief description.)
|
||||
|
||||
JAVADOC_AUTOBRIEF = NO
|
||||
|
||||
# If the QT_AUTOBRIEF tag is set to YES then Doxygen will
|
||||
# interpret the first line (until the first dot) of a Qt-style
|
||||
# comment as the brief description. If set to NO, the comments
|
||||
# will behave just like regular Qt-style comments (thus requiring
|
||||
# an explicit \brief command for a brief description.)
|
||||
|
||||
QT_AUTOBRIEF = NO
|
||||
|
||||
# The MULTILINE_CPP_IS_BRIEF tag can be set to YES to make Doxygen
|
||||
# treat a multi-line C++ special comment block (i.e. a block of //! or ///
|
||||
# comments) as a brief description. This used to be the default behaviour.
|
||||
# The new default is to treat a multi-line C++ comment block as a detailed
|
||||
# description. Set this tag to YES if you prefer the old behaviour instead.
|
||||
|
||||
MULTILINE_CPP_IS_BRIEF = NO
|
||||
|
||||
# If the INHERIT_DOCS tag is set to YES (the default) then an undocumented
|
||||
# member inherits the documentation from any documented member that it
|
||||
# re-implements.
|
||||
|
||||
INHERIT_DOCS = YES
|
||||
|
||||
# If the SEPARATE_MEMBER_PAGES tag is set to YES, then doxygen will produce
|
||||
# a new page for each member. If set to NO, the documentation of a member will
|
||||
# be part of the file/class/namespace that contains it.
|
||||
|
||||
SEPARATE_MEMBER_PAGES = NO
|
||||
|
||||
# The TAB_SIZE tag can be used to set the number of spaces in a tab.
|
||||
# Doxygen uses this value to replace tabs by spaces in code fragments.
|
||||
|
||||
TAB_SIZE = 4
|
||||
|
||||
# This tag can be used to specify a number of aliases that acts
|
||||
# as commands in the documentation. An alias has the form "name=value".
|
||||
# For example adding "sideeffect=\par Side Effects:\n" will allow you to
|
||||
# put the command \sideeffect (or @sideeffect) in the documentation, which
|
||||
# will result in a user-defined paragraph with heading "Side Effects:".
|
||||
# You can put \n's in the value part of an alias to insert newlines.
|
||||
|
||||
ALIASES =
|
||||
|
||||
# Set the OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_FOR_C tag to YES if your project consists of C
|
||||
# sources only. Doxygen will then generate output that is more tailored for C.
|
||||
# For instance, some of the names that are used will be different. The list
|
||||
# of all members will be omitted, etc.
|
||||
|
||||
OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_FOR_C = YES
|
||||
|
||||
# Set the OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_JAVA tag to YES if your project consists of Java
|
||||
# sources only. Doxygen will then generate output that is more tailored for
|
||||
# Java. For instance, namespaces will be presented as packages, qualified
|
||||
# scopes will look different, etc.
|
||||
|
||||
OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_JAVA = NO
|
||||
|
||||
# Set the OPTIMIZE_FOR_FORTRAN tag to YES if your project consists of Fortran
|
||||
# sources only. Doxygen will then generate output that is more tailored for
|
||||
# Fortran.
|
||||
|
||||
OPTIMIZE_FOR_FORTRAN = NO
|
||||
|
||||
# Set the OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_VHDL tag to YES if your project consists of VHDL
|
||||
# sources. Doxygen will then generate output that is tailored for
|
||||
# VHDL.
|
||||
|
||||
OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_VHDL = NO
|
||||
|
||||
# If you use STL classes (i.e. std::string, std::vector, etc.) but do not want
|
||||
# to include (a tag file for) the STL sources as input, then you should
|
||||
# set this tag to YES in order to let doxygen match functions declarations and
|
||||
# definitions whose arguments contain STL classes (e.g. func(std::string); v.s.
|
||||
# func(std::string) {}). This also make the inheritance and collaboration
|
||||
# diagrams that involve STL classes more complete and accurate.
|
||||
|
||||
BUILTIN_STL_SUPPORT = NO
|
||||
|
||||
# If you use Microsoft's C++/CLI language, you should set this option to YES to
|
||||
# enable parsing support.
|
||||
|
||||
CPP_CLI_SUPPORT = NO
|
||||
|
||||
# Set the SIP_SUPPORT tag to YES if your project consists of sip sources only.
|
||||
# Doxygen will parse them like normal C++ but will assume all classes use public
|
||||
# instead of private inheritance when no explicit protection keyword is present.
|
||||
|
||||
SIP_SUPPORT = NO
|
||||
|
||||
# For Microsoft's IDL there are propget and propput attributes to indicate getter
|
||||
# and setter methods for a property. Setting this option to YES (the default)
|
||||
# will make doxygen to replace the get and set methods by a property in the
|
||||
# documentation. This will only work if the methods are indeed getting or
|
||||
# setting a simple type. If this is not the case, or you want to show the
|
||||
# methods anyway, you should set this option to NO.
|
||||
|
||||
IDL_PROPERTY_SUPPORT = YES
|
||||
|
||||
# If member grouping is used in the documentation and the DISTRIBUTE_GROUP_DOC
|
||||
# tag is set to YES, then doxygen will reuse the documentation of the first
|
||||
# member in the group (if any) for the other members of the group. By default
|
||||
# all members of a group must be documented explicitly.
|
||||
|
||||
DISTRIBUTE_GROUP_DOC = NO
|
||||
|
||||
# Set the SUBGROUPING tag to YES (the default) to allow class member groups of
|
||||
# the same type (for instance a group of public functions) to be put as a
|
||||
# subgroup of that type (e.g. under the Public Functions section). Set it to
|
||||
# NO to prevent subgrouping. Alternatively, this can be done per class using
|
||||
# the \nosubgrouping command.
|
||||
|
||||
SUBGROUPING = YES
|
||||
|
||||
# When TYPEDEF_HIDES_STRUCT is enabled, a typedef of a struct, union, or enum
|
||||
# is documented as struct, union, or enum with the name of the typedef. So
|
||||
# typedef struct TypeS {} TypeT, will appear in the documentation as a struct
|
||||
# with name TypeT. When disabled the typedef will appear as a member of a file,
|
||||
# namespace, or class. And the struct will be named TypeS. This can typically
|
||||
# be useful for C code in case the coding convention dictates that all compound
|
||||
# types are typedef'ed and only the typedef is referenced, never the tag name.
|
||||
|
||||
TYPEDEF_HIDES_STRUCT = NO
|
||||
|
||||
# The SYMBOL_CACHE_SIZE determines the size of the internal cache use to
|
||||
# determine which symbols to keep in memory and which to flush to disk.
|
||||
# When the cache is full, less often used symbols will be written to disk.
|
||||
# For small to medium size projects (<1000 input files) the default value is
|
||||
# probably good enough. For larger projects a too small cache size can cause
|
||||
# doxygen to be busy swapping symbols to and from disk most of the time
|
||||
# causing a significant performance penality.
|
||||
# If the system has enough physical memory increasing the cache will improve the
|
||||
# performance by keeping more symbols in memory. Note that the value works on
|
||||
# a logarithmic scale so increasing the size by one will rougly double the
|
||||
# memory usage. The cache size is given by this formula:
|
||||
# 2^(16+SYMBOL_CACHE_SIZE). The valid range is 0..9, the default is 0,
|
||||
# corresponding to a cache size of 2^16 = 65536 symbols
|
||||
|
||||
SYMBOL_CACHE_SIZE = 0
|
||||
|
||||
#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
|
||||
# Build related configuration options
|
||||
#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
|
||||
|
||||
# If the EXTRACT_ALL tag is set to YES doxygen will assume all entities in
|
||||
# documentation are documented, even if no documentation was available.
|
||||
# Private class members and static file members will be hidden unless
|
||||
# the EXTRACT_PRIVATE and EXTRACT_STATIC tags are set to YES
|
||||
|
||||
EXTRACT_ALL = YES
|
||||
|
||||
# If the EXTRACT_PRIVATE tag is set to YES all private members of a class
|
||||
# will be included in the documentation.
|
||||
|
||||
EXTRACT_PRIVATE = YES
|
||||
|
||||
# If the EXTRACT_STATIC tag is set to YES all static members of a file
|
||||
# will be included in the documentation.
|
||||
|
||||
EXTRACT_STATIC = YES
|
||||
|
||||
# If the EXTRACT_LOCAL_CLASSES tag is set to YES classes (and structs)
|
||||
# defined locally in source files will be included in the documentation.
|
||||
# If set to NO only classes defined in header files are included.
|
||||
|
||||
EXTRACT_LOCAL_CLASSES = YES
|
||||
|
||||
# This flag is only useful for Objective-C code. When set to YES local
|
||||
# methods, which are defined in the implementation section but not in
|
||||
# the interface are included in the documentation.
|
||||
# If set to NO (the default) only methods in the interface are included.
|
||||
|
||||
EXTRACT_LOCAL_METHODS = NO
|
||||
|
||||
# If this flag is set to YES, the members of anonymous namespaces will be
|
||||
# extracted and appear in the documentation as a namespace called
|
||||
# 'anonymous_namespace{file}', where file will be replaced with the base
|
||||
# name of the file that contains the anonymous namespace. By default
|
||||
# anonymous namespace are hidden.
|
||||
|
||||
EXTRACT_ANON_NSPACES = NO
|
||||
|
||||
# If the HIDE_UNDOC_MEMBERS tag is set to YES, Doxygen will hide all
|
||||
# undocumented members of documented classes, files or namespaces.
|
||||
# If set to NO (the default) these members will be included in the
|
||||
# various overviews, but no documentation section is generated.
|
||||
# This option has no effect if EXTRACT_ALL is enabled.
|
||||
|
||||
HIDE_UNDOC_MEMBERS = NO
|
||||
|
||||
# If the HIDE_UNDOC_CLASSES tag is set to YES, Doxygen will hide all
|
||||
# undocumented classes that are normally visible in the class hierarchy.
|
||||
# If set to NO (the default) these classes will be included in the various
|
||||
# overviews. This option has no effect if EXTRACT_ALL is enabled.
|
||||
|
||||
HIDE_UNDOC_CLASSES = NO
|
||||
|
||||
# If the HIDE_FRIEND_COMPOUNDS tag is set to YES, Doxygen will hide all
|
||||
# friend (class|struct|union) declarations.
|
||||
# If set to NO (the default) these declarations will be included in the
|
||||
# documentation.
|
||||
|
||||
HIDE_FRIEND_COMPOUNDS = NO
|
||||
|
||||
# If the HIDE_IN_BODY_DOCS tag is set to YES, Doxygen will hide any
|
||||
# documentation blocks found inside the body of a function.
|
||||
# If set to NO (the default) these blocks will be appended to the
|
||||
# function's detailed documentation block.
|
||||
|
||||
HIDE_IN_BODY_DOCS = NO
|
||||
|
||||
# The INTERNAL_DOCS tag determines if documentation
|
||||
# that is typed after a \internal command is included. If the tag is set
|
||||
# to NO (the default) then the documentation will be excluded.
|
||||
# Set it to YES to include the internal documentation.
|
||||
|
||||
INTERNAL_DOCS = NO
|
||||
|
||||
# If the CASE_SENSE_NAMES tag is set to NO then Doxygen will only generate
|
||||
# file names in lower-case letters. If set to YES upper-case letters are also
|
||||
# allowed. This is useful if you have classes or files whose names only differ
|
||||
# in case and if your file system supports case sensitive file names. Windows
|
||||
# and Mac users are advised to set this option to NO.
|
||||
|
||||
CASE_SENSE_NAMES = NO
|
||||
|
||||
# If the HIDE_SCOPE_NAMES tag is set to NO (the default) then Doxygen
|
||||
# will show members with their full class and namespace scopes in the
|
||||
# documentation. If set to YES the scope will be hidden.
|
||||
|
||||
HIDE_SCOPE_NAMES = NO
|
||||
|
||||
# If the SHOW_INCLUDE_FILES tag is set to YES (the default) then Doxygen
|
||||
# will put a list of the files that are included by a file in the documentation
|
||||
# of that file.
|
||||
|
||||
SHOW_INCLUDE_FILES = YES
|
||||
|
||||
# If the INLINE_INFO tag is set to YES (the default) then a tag [inline]
|
||||
# is inserted in the documentation for inline members.
|
||||
|
||||
INLINE_INFO = YES
|
||||
|
||||
# If the SORT_MEMBER_DOCS tag is set to YES (the default) then doxygen
|
||||
# will sort the (detailed) documentation of file and class members
|
||||
# alphabetically by member name. If set to NO the members will appear in
|
||||
# declaration order.
|
||||
|
||||
SORT_MEMBER_DOCS = YES
|
||||
|
||||
# If the SORT_BRIEF_DOCS tag is set to YES then doxygen will sort the
|
||||
# brief documentation of file, namespace and class members alphabetically
|
||||
# by member name. If set to NO (the default) the members will appear in
|
||||
# declaration order.
|
||||
|
||||
SORT_BRIEF_DOCS = NO
|
||||
|
||||
# If the SORT_GROUP_NAMES tag is set to YES then doxygen will sort the
|
||||
# hierarchy of group names into alphabetical order. If set to NO (the default)
|
||||
# the group names will appear in their defined order.
|
||||
|
||||
SORT_GROUP_NAMES = NO
|
||||
|
||||
# If the SORT_BY_SCOPE_NAME tag is set to YES, the class list will be
|
||||
# sorted by fully-qualified names, including namespaces. If set to
|
||||
# NO (the default), the class list will be sorted only by class name,
|
||||
# not including the namespace part.
|
||||
# Note: This option is not very useful if HIDE_SCOPE_NAMES is set to YES.
|
||||
# Note: This option applies only to the class list, not to the
|
||||
# alphabetical list.
|
||||
|
||||
SORT_BY_SCOPE_NAME = NO
|
||||
|
||||
# The GENERATE_TODOLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or
|
||||
# disable (NO) the todo list. This list is created by putting \todo
|
||||
# commands in the documentation.
|
||||
|
||||
GENERATE_TODOLIST = NO
|
||||
|
||||
# The GENERATE_TESTLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or
|
||||
# disable (NO) the test list. This list is created by putting \test
|
||||
# commands in the documentation.
|
||||
|
||||
GENERATE_TESTLIST = NO
|
||||
|
||||
# The GENERATE_BUGLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or
|
||||
# disable (NO) the bug list. This list is created by putting \bug
|
||||
# commands in the documentation.
|
||||
|
||||
GENERATE_BUGLIST = NO
|
||||
|
||||
# The GENERATE_DEPRECATEDLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or
|
||||
# disable (NO) the deprecated list. This list is created by putting
|
||||
# \deprecated commands in the documentation.
|
||||
|
||||
GENERATE_DEPRECATEDLIST= YES
|
||||
|
||||
# The ENABLED_SECTIONS tag can be used to enable conditional
|
||||
# documentation sections, marked by \if sectionname ... \endif.
|
||||
|
||||
ENABLED_SECTIONS =
|
||||
|
||||
# The MAX_INITIALIZER_LINES tag determines the maximum number of lines
|
||||
# the initial value of a variable or define consists of for it to appear in
|
||||
# the documentation. If the initializer consists of more lines than specified
|
||||
# here it will be hidden. Use a value of 0 to hide initializers completely.
|
||||
# The appearance of the initializer of individual variables and defines in the
|
||||
# documentation can be controlled using \showinitializer or \hideinitializer
|
||||
# command in the documentation regardless of this setting.
|
||||
|
||||
MAX_INITIALIZER_LINES = 30
|
||||
|
||||
# Set the SHOW_USED_FILES tag to NO to disable the list of files generated
|
||||
# at the bottom of the documentation of classes and structs. If set to YES the
|
||||
# list will mention the files that were used to generate the documentation.
|
||||
|
||||
SHOW_USED_FILES = YES
|
||||
|
||||
# If the sources in your project are distributed over multiple directories
|
||||
# then setting the SHOW_DIRECTORIES tag to YES will show the directory hierarchy
|
||||
# in the documentation. The default is NO.
|
||||
|
||||
SHOW_DIRECTORIES = YES
|
||||
|
||||
# Set the SHOW_FILES tag to NO to disable the generation of the Files page.
|
||||
# This will remove the Files entry from the Quick Index and from the
|
||||
# Folder Tree View (if specified). The default is YES.
|
||||
|
||||
SHOW_FILES = YES
|
||||
|
||||
# Set the SHOW_NAMESPACES tag to NO to disable the generation of the
|
||||
# Namespaces page. This will remove the Namespaces entry from the Quick Index
|
||||
# and from the Folder Tree View (if specified). The default is YES.
|
||||
|
||||
SHOW_NAMESPACES = YES
|
||||
|
||||
# The FILE_VERSION_FILTER tag can be used to specify a program or script that
|
||||
# doxygen should invoke to get the current version for each file (typically from
|
||||
# the version control system). Doxygen will invoke the program by executing (via
|
||||
# popen()) the command <command> <input-file>, where <command> is the value of
|
||||
# the FILE_VERSION_FILTER tag, and <input-file> is the name of an input file
|
||||
# provided by doxygen. Whatever the program writes to standard output
|
||||
# is used as the file version. See the manual for examples.
|
||||
|
||||
FILE_VERSION_FILTER =
|
||||
|
||||
# The LAYOUT_FILE tag can be used to specify a layout file which will be parsed by
|
||||
# doxygen. The layout file controls the global structure of the generated output files
|
||||
# in an output format independent way. The create the layout file that represents
|
||||
# doxygen's defaults, run doxygen with the -l option. You can optionally specify a
|
||||
# file name after the option, if omitted DoxygenLayout.xml will be used as the name
|
||||
# of the layout file.
|
||||
|
||||
LAYOUT_FILE =
|
||||
|
||||
#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
|
||||
# configuration options related to warning and progress messages
|
||||
#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
|
||||
|
||||
# The QUIET tag can be used to turn on/off the messages that are generated
|
||||
# by doxygen. Possible values are YES and NO. If left blank NO is used.
|
||||
|
||||
QUIET = YES
|
||||
|
||||
# The WARNINGS tag can be used to turn on/off the warning messages that are
|
||||
# generated by doxygen. Possible values are YES and NO. If left blank
|
||||
# NO is used.
|
||||
|
||||
WARNINGS = YES
|
||||
|
||||
# If WARN_IF_UNDOCUMENTED is set to YES, then doxygen will generate warnings
|
||||
# for undocumented members. If EXTRACT_ALL is set to YES then this flag will
|
||||
# automatically be disabled.
|
||||
|
||||
WARN_IF_UNDOCUMENTED = YES
|
||||
|
||||
# If WARN_IF_DOC_ERROR is set to YES, doxygen will generate warnings for
|
||||
# potential errors in the documentation, such as not documenting some
|
||||
# parameters in a documented function, or documenting parameters that
|
||||
# don't exist or using markup commands wrongly.
|
||||
|
||||
WARN_IF_DOC_ERROR = YES
|
||||
|
||||
# This WARN_NO_PARAMDOC option can be abled to get warnings for
|
||||
# functions that are documented, but have no documentation for their parameters
|
||||
# or return value. If set to NO (the default) doxygen will only warn about
|
||||
# wrong or incomplete parameter documentation, but not about the absence of
|
||||
# documentation.
|
||||
|
||||
WARN_NO_PARAMDOC = YES
|
||||
|
||||
# The WARN_FORMAT tag determines the format of the warning messages that
|
||||
# doxygen can produce. The string should contain the $file, $line, and $text
|
||||
# tags, which will be replaced by the file and line number from which the
|
||||
# warning originated and the warning text. Optionally the format may contain
|
||||
# $version, which will be replaced by the version of the file (if it could
|
||||
# be obtained via FILE_VERSION_FILTER)
|
||||
|
||||
WARN_FORMAT = "$file:$line: $text"
|
||||
|
||||
# The WARN_LOGFILE tag can be used to specify a file to which warning
|
||||
# and error messages should be written. If left blank the output is written
|
||||
# to stderr.
|
||||
|
||||
WARN_LOGFILE =
|
||||
|
||||
#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
|
||||
# configuration options related to the input files
|
||||
#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
|
||||
|
||||
# The INPUT tag can be used to specify the files and/or directories that contain
|
||||
# documented source files. You may enter file names like "myfile.cpp" or
|
||||
# directories like "/usr/src/myproject". Separate the files or directories
|
||||
# with spaces.
|
||||
|
||||
INPUT = ./
|
||||
|
||||
# This tag can be used to specify the character encoding of the source files
|
||||
# that doxygen parses. Internally doxygen uses the UTF-8 encoding, which is
|
||||
# also the default input encoding. Doxygen uses libiconv (or the iconv built
|
||||
# into libc) for the transcoding. See http://www.gnu.org/software/libiconv for
|
||||
# the list of possible encodings.
|
||||
|
||||
INPUT_ENCODING = UTF-8
|
||||
|
||||
# If the value of the INPUT tag contains directories, you can use the
|
||||
# FILE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard pattern (like *.cpp
|
||||
# and *.h) to filter out the source-files in the directories. If left
|
||||
# blank the following patterns are tested:
|
||||
# *.c *.cc *.cxx *.cpp *.c++ *.java *.ii *.ixx *.ipp *.i++ *.inl *.h *.hh *.hxx
|
||||
# *.hpp *.h++ *.idl *.odl *.cs *.php *.php3 *.inc *.m *.mm *.py *.f90
|
||||
|
||||
FILE_PATTERNS = *.h \
|
||||
*.c \
|
||||
*.txt
|
||||
|
||||
# The RECURSIVE tag can be used to turn specify whether or not subdirectories
|
||||
# should be searched for input files as well. Possible values are YES and NO.
|
||||
# If left blank NO is used.
|
||||
|
||||
RECURSIVE = YES
|
||||
|
||||
# The EXCLUDE tag can be used to specify files and/or directories that should
|
||||
# excluded from the INPUT source files. This way you can easily exclude a
|
||||
# subdirectory from a directory tree whose root is specified with the INPUT tag.
|
||||
|
||||
EXCLUDE =
|
||||
|
||||
# The EXCLUDE_SYMLINKS tag can be used select whether or not files or
|
||||
# directories that are symbolic links (a Unix filesystem feature) are excluded
|
||||
# from the input.
|
||||
|
||||
EXCLUDE_SYMLINKS = NO
|
||||
|
||||
# If the value of the INPUT tag contains directories, you can use the
|
||||
# EXCLUDE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard patterns to exclude
|
||||
# certain files from those directories. Note that the wildcards are matched
|
||||
# against the file with absolute path, so to exclude all test directories
|
||||
# for example use the pattern */test/*
|
||||
|
||||
EXCLUDE_PATTERNS = */LowLevel/USBMode.h
|
||||
|
||||
# The EXCLUDE_SYMBOLS tag can be used to specify one or more symbol names
|
||||
# (namespaces, classes, functions, etc.) that should be excluded from the
|
||||
# output. The symbol name can be a fully qualified name, a word, or if the
|
||||
# wildcard * is used, a substring. Examples: ANamespace, AClass,
|
||||
# AClass::ANamespace, ANamespace::*Test
|
||||
|
||||
EXCLUDE_SYMBOLS = __*
|
||||
|
||||
# The EXAMPLE_PATH tag can be used to specify one or more files or
|
||||
# directories that contain example code fragments that are included (see
|
||||
# the \include command).
|
||||
|
||||
EXAMPLE_PATH =
|
||||
|
||||
# If the value of the EXAMPLE_PATH tag contains directories, you can use the
|
||||
# EXAMPLE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard pattern (like *.cpp
|
||||
# and *.h) to filter out the source-files in the directories. If left
|
||||
# blank all files are included.
|
||||
|
||||
EXAMPLE_PATTERNS = *
|
||||
|
||||
# If the EXAMPLE_RECURSIVE tag is set to YES then subdirectories will be
|
||||
# searched for input files to be used with the \include or \dontinclude
|
||||
# commands irrespective of the value of the RECURSIVE tag.
|
||||
# Possible values are YES and NO. If left blank NO is used.
|
||||
|
||||
EXAMPLE_RECURSIVE = NO
|
||||
|
||||
# The IMAGE_PATH tag can be used to specify one or more files or
|
||||
# directories that contain image that are included in the documentation (see
|
||||
# the \image command).
|
||||
|
||||
IMAGE_PATH =
|
||||
|
||||
# The INPUT_FILTER tag can be used to specify a program that doxygen should
|
||||
# invoke to filter for each input file. Doxygen will invoke the filter program
|
||||
# by executing (via popen()) the command <filter> <input-file>, where <filter>
|
||||
# is the value of the INPUT_FILTER tag, and <input-file> is the name of an
|
||||
# input file. Doxygen will then use the output that the filter program writes
|
||||
# to standard output. If FILTER_PATTERNS is specified, this tag will be
|
||||
# ignored.
|
||||
|
||||
INPUT_FILTER =
|
||||
|
||||
# The FILTER_PATTERNS tag can be used to specify filters on a per file pattern
|
||||
# basis. Doxygen will compare the file name with each pattern and apply the
|
||||
# filter if there is a match. The filters are a list of the form:
|
||||
# pattern=filter (like *.cpp=my_cpp_filter). See INPUT_FILTER for further
|
||||
# info on how filters are used. If FILTER_PATTERNS is empty, INPUT_FILTER
|
||||
# is applied to all files.
|
||||
|
||||
FILTER_PATTERNS =
|
||||
|
||||
# If the FILTER_SOURCE_FILES tag is set to YES, the input filter (if set using
|
||||
# INPUT_FILTER) will be used to filter the input files when producing source
|
||||
# files to browse (i.e. when SOURCE_BROWSER is set to YES).
|
||||
|
||||
FILTER_SOURCE_FILES = NO
|
||||
|
||||
#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
|
||||
# configuration options related to source browsing
|
||||
#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
|
||||
|
||||
# If the SOURCE_BROWSER tag is set to YES then a list of source files will
|
||||
# be generated. Documented entities will be cross-referenced with these sources.
|
||||
# Note: To get rid of all source code in the generated output, make sure also
|
||||
# VERBATIM_HEADERS is set to NO.
|
||||
|
||||
SOURCE_BROWSER = NO
|
||||
|
||||
# Setting the INLINE_SOURCES tag to YES will include the body
|
||||
# of functions and classes directly in the documentation.
|
||||
|
||||
INLINE_SOURCES = NO
|
||||
|
||||
# Setting the STRIP_CODE_COMMENTS tag to YES (the default) will instruct
|
||||
# doxygen to hide any special comment blocks from generated source code
|
||||
# fragments. Normal C and C++ comments will always remain visible.
|
||||
|
||||
STRIP_CODE_COMMENTS = YES
|
||||
|
||||
# If the REFERENCED_BY_RELATION tag is set to YES
|
||||
# then for each documented function all documented
|
||||
# functions referencing it will be listed.
|
||||
|
||||
REFERENCED_BY_RELATION = NO
|
||||
|
||||
# If the REFERENCES_RELATION tag is set to YES
|
||||
# then for each documented function all documented entities
|
||||
# called/used by that function will be listed.
|
||||
|
||||
REFERENCES_RELATION = NO
|
||||
|
||||
# If the REFERENCES_LINK_SOURCE tag is set to YES (the default)
|
||||
# and SOURCE_BROWSER tag is set to YES, then the hyperlinks from
|
||||
# functions in REFERENCES_RELATION and REFERENCED_BY_RELATION lists will
|
||||
# link to the source code. Otherwise they will link to the documentstion.
|
||||
|
||||
REFERENCES_LINK_SOURCE = NO
|
||||
|
||||
# If the USE_HTAGS tag is set to YES then the references to source code
|
||||
# will point to the HTML generated by the htags(1) tool instead of doxygen
|
||||
# built-in source browser. The htags tool is part of GNU's global source
|
||||
# tagging system (see http://www.gnu.org/software/global/global.html). You
|
||||
# will need version 4.8.6 or higher.
|
||||
|
||||
USE_HTAGS = NO
|
||||
|
||||
# If the VERBATIM_HEADERS tag is set to YES (the default) then Doxygen
|
||||
# will generate a verbatim copy of the header file for each class for
|
||||
# which an include is specified. Set to NO to disable this.
|
||||
|
||||
VERBATIM_HEADERS = NO
|
||||
|
||||
#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
|
||||
# configuration options related to the alphabetical class index
|
||||
#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
|
||||
|
||||
# If the ALPHABETICAL_INDEX tag is set to YES, an alphabetical index
|
||||
# of all compounds will be generated. Enable this if the project
|
||||
# contains a lot of classes, structs, unions or interfaces.
|
||||
|
||||
ALPHABETICAL_INDEX = YES
|
||||
|
||||
# If the alphabetical index is enabled (see ALPHABETICAL_INDEX) then
|
||||
# the COLS_IN_ALPHA_INDEX tag can be used to specify the number of columns
|
||||
# in which this list will be split (can be a number in the range [1..20])
|
||||
|
||||
COLS_IN_ALPHA_INDEX = 5
|
||||
|
||||
# In case all classes in a project start with a common prefix, all
|
||||
# classes will be put under the same header in the alphabetical index.
|
||||
# The IGNORE_PREFIX tag can be used to specify one or more prefixes that
|
||||
# should be ignored while generating the index headers.
|
||||
|
||||
IGNORE_PREFIX =
|
||||
|
||||
#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
|
||||
# configuration options related to the HTML output
|
||||
#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
|
||||
|
||||
# If the GENERATE_HTML tag is set to YES (the default) Doxygen will
|
||||
# generate HTML output.
|
||||
|
||||
GENERATE_HTML = YES
|
||||
|
||||
# The HTML_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the HTML docs will be put.
|
||||
# If a relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be
|
||||
# put in front of it. If left blank `html' will be used as the default path.
|
||||
|
||||
HTML_OUTPUT = html
|
||||
|
||||
# The HTML_FILE_EXTENSION tag can be used to specify the file extension for
|
||||
# each generated HTML page (for example: .htm,.php,.asp). If it is left blank
|
||||
# doxygen will generate files with .html extension.
|
||||
|
||||
HTML_FILE_EXTENSION = .html
|
||||
|
||||
# The HTML_HEADER tag can be used to specify a personal HTML header for
|
||||
# each generated HTML page. If it is left blank doxygen will generate a
|
||||
# standard header.
|
||||
|
||||
HTML_HEADER =
|
||||
|
||||
# The HTML_FOOTER tag can be used to specify a personal HTML footer for
|
||||
# each generated HTML page. If it is left blank doxygen will generate a
|
||||
# standard footer.
|
||||
|
||||
HTML_FOOTER =
|
||||
|
||||
# The HTML_STYLESHEET tag can be used to specify a user-defined cascading
|
||||
# style sheet that is used by each HTML page. It can be used to
|
||||
# fine-tune the look of the HTML output. If the tag is left blank doxygen
|
||||
# will generate a default style sheet. Note that doxygen will try to copy
|
||||
# the style sheet file to the HTML output directory, so don't put your own
|
||||
# stylesheet in the HTML output directory as well, or it will be erased!
|
||||
|
||||
HTML_STYLESHEET =
|
||||
|
||||
# If the HTML_ALIGN_MEMBERS tag is set to YES, the members of classes,
|
||||
# files or namespaces will be aligned in HTML using tables. If set to
|
||||
# NO a bullet list will be used.
|
||||
|
||||
HTML_ALIGN_MEMBERS = YES
|
||||
|
||||
# If the HTML_DYNAMIC_SECTIONS tag is set to YES then the generated HTML
|
||||
# documentation will contain sections that can be hidden and shown after the
|
||||
# page has loaded. For this to work a browser that supports
|
||||
# JavaScript and DHTML is required (for instance Mozilla 1.0+, Firefox
|
||||
# Netscape 6.0+, Internet explorer 5.0+, Konqueror, or Safari).
|
||||
|
||||
HTML_DYNAMIC_SECTIONS = YES
|
||||
|
||||
# If the GENERATE_DOCSET tag is set to YES, additional index files
|
||||
# will be generated that can be used as input for Apple's Xcode 3
|
||||
# integrated development environment, introduced with OSX 10.5 (Leopard).
|
||||
# To create a documentation set, doxygen will generate a Makefile in the
|
||||
# HTML output directory. Running make will produce the docset in that
|
||||
# directory and running "make install" will install the docset in
|
||||
# ~/Library/Developer/Shared/Documentation/DocSets so that Xcode will find
|
||||
# it at startup.
|
||||
# See http://developer.apple.com/tools/creatingdocsetswithdoxygen.html for more information.
|
||||
|
||||
GENERATE_DOCSET = NO
|
||||
|
||||
# When GENERATE_DOCSET tag is set to YES, this tag determines the name of the
|
||||
# feed. A documentation feed provides an umbrella under which multiple
|
||||
# documentation sets from a single provider (such as a company or product suite)
|
||||
# can be grouped.
|
||||
|
||||
DOCSET_FEEDNAME = "Doxygen generated docs"
|
||||
|
||||
# When GENERATE_DOCSET tag is set to YES, this tag specifies a string that
|
||||
# should uniquely identify the documentation set bundle. This should be a
|
||||
# reverse domain-name style string, e.g. com.mycompany.MyDocSet. Doxygen
|
||||
# will append .docset to the name.
|
||||
|
||||
DOCSET_BUNDLE_ID = org.doxygen.Project
|
||||
|
||||
# If the GENERATE_HTMLHELP tag is set to YES, additional index files
|
||||
# will be generated that can be used as input for tools like the
|
||||
# Microsoft HTML help workshop to generate a compiled HTML help file (.chm)
|
||||
# of the generated HTML documentation.
|
||||
|
||||
GENERATE_HTMLHELP = NO
|
||||
|
||||
# If the GENERATE_HTMLHELP tag is set to YES, the CHM_FILE tag can
|
||||
# be used to specify the file name of the resulting .chm file. You
|
||||
# can add a path in front of the file if the result should not be
|
||||
# written to the html output directory.
|
||||
|
||||
CHM_FILE =
|
||||
|
||||
# If the GENERATE_HTMLHELP tag is set to YES, the HHC_LOCATION tag can
|
||||
# be used to specify the location (absolute path including file name) of
|
||||
# the HTML help compiler (hhc.exe). If non-empty doxygen will try to run
|
||||
# the HTML help compiler on the generated index.hhp.
|
||||
|
||||
HHC_LOCATION =
|
||||
|
||||
# If the GENERATE_HTMLHELP tag is set to YES, the GENERATE_CHI flag
|
||||
# controls if a separate .chi index file is generated (YES) or that
|
||||
# it should be included in the master .chm file (NO).
|
||||
|
||||
GENERATE_CHI = NO
|
||||
|
||||
# If the GENERATE_HTMLHELP tag is set to YES, the CHM_INDEX_ENCODING
|
||||
# is used to encode HtmlHelp index (hhk), content (hhc) and project file
|
||||
# content.
|
||||
|
||||
CHM_INDEX_ENCODING =
|
||||
|
||||
# If the GENERATE_HTMLHELP tag is set to YES, the BINARY_TOC flag
|
||||
# controls whether a binary table of contents is generated (YES) or a
|
||||
# normal table of contents (NO) in the .chm file.
|
||||
|
||||
BINARY_TOC = NO
|
||||
|
||||
# The TOC_EXPAND flag can be set to YES to add extra items for group members
|
||||
# to the contents of the HTML help documentation and to the tree view.
|
||||
|
||||
TOC_EXPAND = YES
|
||||
|
||||
# If the GENERATE_QHP tag is set to YES and both QHP_NAMESPACE and QHP_VIRTUAL_FOLDER
|
||||
# are set, an additional index file will be generated that can be used as input for
|
||||
# Qt's qhelpgenerator to generate a Qt Compressed Help (.qch) of the generated
|
||||
# HTML documentation.
|
||||
|
||||
GENERATE_QHP = NO
|
||||
|
||||
# If the QHG_LOCATION tag is specified, the QCH_FILE tag can
|
||||
# be used to specify the file name of the resulting .qch file.
|
||||
# The path specified is relative to the HTML output folder.
|
||||
|
||||
QCH_FILE =
|
||||
|
||||
# The QHP_NAMESPACE tag specifies the namespace to use when generating
|
||||
# Qt Help Project output. For more information please see
|
||||
# <a href="http://doc.trolltech.com/qthelpproject.html#namespace">Qt Help Project / Namespace</a>.
|
||||
|
||||
QHP_NAMESPACE = org.doxygen.Project
|
||||
|
||||
# The QHP_VIRTUAL_FOLDER tag specifies the namespace to use when generating
|
||||
# Qt Help Project output. For more information please see
|
||||
# <a href="http://doc.trolltech.com/qthelpproject.html#virtual-folders">Qt Help Project / Virtual Folders</a>.
|
||||
|
||||
QHP_VIRTUAL_FOLDER = doc
|
||||
|
||||
# If the GENERATE_QHP tag is set to YES, the QHG_LOCATION tag can
|
||||
# be used to specify the location of Qt's qhelpgenerator.
|
||||
# If non-empty doxygen will try to run qhelpgenerator on the generated
|
||||
# .qhp file .
|
||||
|
||||
QHG_LOCATION =
|
||||
|
||||
# The DISABLE_INDEX tag can be used to turn on/off the condensed index at
|
||||
# top of each HTML page. The value NO (the default) enables the index and
|
||||
# the value YES disables it.
|
||||
|
||||
DISABLE_INDEX = NO
|
||||
|
||||
# This tag can be used to set the number of enum values (range [1..20])
|
||||
# that doxygen will group on one line in the generated HTML documentation.
|
||||
|
||||
ENUM_VALUES_PER_LINE = 1
|
||||
|
||||
# The GENERATE_TREEVIEW tag is used to specify whether a tree-like index
|
||||
# structure should be generated to display hierarchical information.
|
||||
# If the tag value is set to FRAME, a side panel will be generated
|
||||
# containing a tree-like index structure (just like the one that
|
||||
# is generated for HTML Help). For this to work a browser that supports
|
||||
# JavaScript, DHTML, CSS and frames is required (for instance Mozilla 1.0+,
|
||||
# Netscape 6.0+, Internet explorer 5.0+, or Konqueror). Windows users are
|
||||
# probably better off using the HTML help feature. Other possible values
|
||||
# for this tag are: HIERARCHIES, which will generate the Groups, Directories,
|
||||
# and Class Hierarchy pages using a tree view instead of an ordered list;
|
||||
# ALL, which combines the behavior of FRAME and HIERARCHIES; and NONE, which
|
||||
# disables this behavior completely. For backwards compatibility with previous
|
||||
# releases of Doxygen, the values YES and NO are equivalent to FRAME and NONE
|
||||
# respectively.
|
||||
|
||||
GENERATE_TREEVIEW = YES
|
||||
|
||||
# If the treeview is enabled (see GENERATE_TREEVIEW) then this tag can be
|
||||
# used to set the initial width (in pixels) of the frame in which the tree
|
||||
# is shown.
|
||||
|
||||
TREEVIEW_WIDTH = 250
|
||||
|
||||
# Use this tag to change the font size of Latex formulas included
|
||||
# as images in the HTML documentation. The default is 10. Note that
|
||||
# when you change the font size after a successful doxygen run you need
|
||||
# to manually remove any form_*.png images from the HTML output directory
|
||||
# to force them to be regenerated.
|
||||
|
||||
FORMULA_FONTSIZE = 10
|
||||
|
||||
#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
|
||||
# configuration options related to the LaTeX output
|
||||
#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
|
||||
|
||||
# If the GENERATE_LATEX tag is set to YES (the default) Doxygen will
|
||||
# generate Latex output.
|
||||
|
||||
GENERATE_LATEX = NO
|
||||
|
||||
# The LATEX_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the LaTeX docs will be put.
|
||||
# If a relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be
|
||||
# put in front of it. If left blank `latex' will be used as the default path.
|
||||
|
||||
LATEX_OUTPUT = latex
|
||||
|
||||
# The LATEX_CMD_NAME tag can be used to specify the LaTeX command name to be
|
||||
# invoked. If left blank `latex' will be used as the default command name.
|
||||
|
||||
LATEX_CMD_NAME = latex
|
||||
|
||||
# The MAKEINDEX_CMD_NAME tag can be used to specify the command name to
|
||||
# generate index for LaTeX. If left blank `makeindex' will be used as the
|
||||
# default command name.
|
||||
|
||||
MAKEINDEX_CMD_NAME = makeindex
|
||||
|
||||
# If the COMPACT_LATEX tag is set to YES Doxygen generates more compact
|
||||
# LaTeX documents. This may be useful for small projects and may help to
|
||||
# save some trees in general.
|
||||
|
||||
COMPACT_LATEX = NO
|
||||
|
||||
# The PAPER_TYPE tag can be used to set the paper type that is used
|
||||
# by the printer. Possible values are: a4, a4wide, letter, legal and
|
||||
# executive. If left blank a4wide will be used.
|
||||
|
||||
PAPER_TYPE = a4wide
|
||||
|
||||
# The EXTRA_PACKAGES tag can be to specify one or more names of LaTeX
|
||||
# packages that should be included in the LaTeX output.
|
||||
|
||||
EXTRA_PACKAGES =
|
||||
|
||||
# The LATEX_HEADER tag can be used to specify a personal LaTeX header for
|
||||
# the generated latex document. The header should contain everything until
|
||||
# the first chapter. If it is left blank doxygen will generate a
|
||||
# standard header. Notice: only use this tag if you know what you are doing!
|
||||
|
||||
LATEX_HEADER =
|
||||
|
||||
# If the PDF_HYPERLINKS tag is set to YES, the LaTeX that is generated
|
||||
# is prepared for conversion to pdf (using ps2pdf). The pdf file will
|
||||
# contain links (just like the HTML output) instead of page references
|
||||
# This makes the output suitable for online browsing using a pdf viewer.
|
||||
|
||||
PDF_HYPERLINKS = YES
|
||||
|
||||
# If the USE_PDFLATEX tag is set to YES, pdflatex will be used instead of
|
||||
# plain latex in the generated Makefile. Set this option to YES to get a
|
||||
# higher quality PDF documentation.
|
||||
|
||||
USE_PDFLATEX = YES
|
||||
|
||||
# If the LATEX_BATCHMODE tag is set to YES, doxygen will add the \\batchmode.
|
||||
# command to the generated LaTeX files. This will instruct LaTeX to keep
|
||||
# running if errors occur, instead of asking the user for help.
|
||||
# This option is also used when generating formulas in HTML.
|
||||
|
||||
LATEX_BATCHMODE = NO
|
||||
|
||||
# If LATEX_HIDE_INDICES is set to YES then doxygen will not
|
||||
# include the index chapters (such as File Index, Compound Index, etc.)
|
||||
# in the output.
|
||||
|
||||
LATEX_HIDE_INDICES = NO
|
||||
|
||||
#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
|
||||
# configuration options related to the RTF output
|
||||
#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
|
||||
|
||||
# If the GENERATE_RTF tag is set to YES Doxygen will generate RTF output
|
||||
# The RTF output is optimized for Word 97 and may not look very pretty with
|
||||
# other RTF readers or editors.
|
||||
|
||||
GENERATE_RTF = NO
|
||||
|
||||
# The RTF_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the RTF docs will be put.
|
||||
# If a relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be
|
||||
# put in front of it. If left blank `rtf' will be used as the default path.
|
||||
|
||||
RTF_OUTPUT = rtf
|
||||
|
||||
# If the COMPACT_RTF tag is set to YES Doxygen generates more compact
|
||||
# RTF documents. This may be useful for small projects and may help to
|
||||
# save some trees in general.
|
||||
|
||||
COMPACT_RTF = NO
|
||||
|
||||
# If the RTF_HYPERLINKS tag is set to YES, the RTF that is generated
|
||||
# will contain hyperlink fields. The RTF file will
|
||||
# contain links (just like the HTML output) instead of page references.
|
||||
# This makes the output suitable for online browsing using WORD or other
|
||||
# programs which support those fields.
|
||||
# Note: wordpad (write) and others do not support links.
|
||||
|
||||
RTF_HYPERLINKS = NO
|
||||
|
||||
# Load stylesheet definitions from file. Syntax is similar to doxygen's
|
||||
# config file, i.e. a series of assignments. You only have to provide
|
||||
# replacements, missing definitions are set to their default value.
|
||||
|
||||
RTF_STYLESHEET_FILE =
|
||||
|
||||
# Set optional variables used in the generation of an rtf document.
|
||||
# Syntax is similar to doxygen's config file.
|
||||
|
||||
RTF_EXTENSIONS_FILE =
|
||||
|
||||
#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
|
||||
# configuration options related to the man page output
|
||||
#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
|
||||
|
||||
# If the GENERATE_MAN tag is set to YES (the default) Doxygen will
|
||||
# generate man pages
|
||||
|
||||
GENERATE_MAN = NO
|
||||
|
||||
# The MAN_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the man pages will be put.
|
||||
# If a relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be
|
||||
# put in front of it. If left blank `man' will be used as the default path.
|
||||
|
||||
MAN_OUTPUT = man
|
||||
|
||||
# The MAN_EXTENSION tag determines the extension that is added to
|
||||
# the generated man pages (default is the subroutine's section .3)
|
||||
|
||||
MAN_EXTENSION = .3
|
||||
|
||||
# If the MAN_LINKS tag is set to YES and Doxygen generates man output,
|
||||
# then it will generate one additional man file for each entity
|
||||
# documented in the real man page(s). These additional files
|
||||
# only source the real man page, but without them the man command
|
||||
# would be unable to find the correct page. The default is NO.
|
||||
|
||||
MAN_LINKS = NO
|
||||
|
||||
#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
|
||||
# configuration options related to the XML output
|
||||
#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
|
||||
|
||||
# If the GENERATE_XML tag is set to YES Doxygen will
|
||||
# generate an XML file that captures the structure of
|
||||
# the code including all documentation.
|
||||
|
||||
GENERATE_XML = NO
|
||||
|
||||
# The XML_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the XML pages will be put.
|
||||
# If a relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be
|
||||
# put in front of it. If left blank `xml' will be used as the default path.
|
||||
|
||||
XML_OUTPUT = xml
|
||||
|
||||
# The XML_SCHEMA tag can be used to specify an XML schema,
|
||||
# which can be used by a validating XML parser to check the
|
||||
# syntax of the XML files.
|
||||
|
||||
XML_SCHEMA =
|
||||
|
||||
# The XML_DTD tag can be used to specify an XML DTD,
|
||||
# which can be used by a validating XML parser to check the
|
||||
# syntax of the XML files.
|
||||
|
||||
XML_DTD =
|
||||
|
||||
# If the XML_PROGRAMLISTING tag is set to YES Doxygen will
|
||||
# dump the program listings (including syntax highlighting
|
||||
# and cross-referencing information) to the XML output. Note that
|
||||
# enabling this will significantly increase the size of the XML output.
|
||||
|
||||
XML_PROGRAMLISTING = YES
|
||||
|
||||
#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
|
||||
# configuration options for the AutoGen Definitions output
|
||||
#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
|
||||
|
||||
# If the GENERATE_AUTOGEN_DEF tag is set to YES Doxygen will
|
||||
# generate an AutoGen Definitions (see autogen.sf.net) file
|
||||
# that captures the structure of the code including all
|
||||
# documentation. Note that this feature is still experimental
|
||||
# and incomplete at the moment.
|
||||
|
||||
GENERATE_AUTOGEN_DEF = NO
|
||||
|
||||
#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
|
||||
# configuration options related to the Perl module output
|
||||
#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
|
||||
|
||||
# If the GENERATE_PERLMOD tag is set to YES Doxygen will
|
||||
# generate a Perl module file that captures the structure of
|
||||
# the code including all documentation. Note that this
|
||||
# feature is still experimental and incomplete at the
|
||||
# moment.
|
||||
|
||||
GENERATE_PERLMOD = NO
|
||||
|
||||
# If the PERLMOD_LATEX tag is set to YES Doxygen will generate
|
||||
# the necessary Makefile rules, Perl scripts and LaTeX code to be able
|
||||
# to generate PDF and DVI output from the Perl module output.
|
||||
|
||||
PERLMOD_LATEX = NO
|
||||
|
||||
# If the PERLMOD_PRETTY tag is set to YES the Perl module output will be
|
||||
# nicely formatted so it can be parsed by a human reader. This is useful
|
||||
# if you want to understand what is going on. On the other hand, if this
|
||||
# tag is set to NO the size of the Perl module output will be much smaller
|
||||
# and Perl will parse it just the same.
|
||||
|
||||
PERLMOD_PRETTY = YES
|
||||
|
||||
# The names of the make variables in the generated doxyrules.make file
|
||||
# are prefixed with the string contained in PERLMOD_MAKEVAR_PREFIX.
|
||||
# This is useful so different doxyrules.make files included by the same
|
||||
# Makefile don't overwrite each other's variables.
|
||||
|
||||
PERLMOD_MAKEVAR_PREFIX =
|
||||
|
||||
#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
|
||||
# Configuration options related to the preprocessor
|
||||
#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
|
||||
|
||||
# If the ENABLE_PREPROCESSING tag is set to YES (the default) Doxygen will
|
||||
# evaluate all C-preprocessor directives found in the sources and include
|
||||
# files.
|
||||
|
||||
ENABLE_PREPROCESSING = YES
|
||||
|
||||
# If the MACRO_EXPANSION tag is set to YES Doxygen will expand all macro
|
||||
# names in the source code. If set to NO (the default) only conditional
|
||||
# compilation will be performed. Macro expansion can be done in a controlled
|
||||
# way by setting EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF to YES.
|
||||
|
||||
MACRO_EXPANSION = YES
|
||||
|
||||
# If the EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF and MACRO_EXPANSION tags are both set to YES
|
||||
# then the macro expansion is limited to the macros specified with the
|
||||
# PREDEFINED and EXPAND_AS_DEFINED tags.
|
||||
|
||||
EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF = YES
|
||||
|
||||
# If the SEARCH_INCLUDES tag is set to YES (the default) the includes files
|
||||
# in the INCLUDE_PATH (see below) will be search if a #include is found.
|
||||
|
||||
SEARCH_INCLUDES = YES
|
||||
|
||||
# The INCLUDE_PATH tag can be used to specify one or more directories that
|
||||
# contain include files that are not input files but should be processed by
|
||||
# the preprocessor.
|
||||
|
||||
INCLUDE_PATH =
|
||||
|
||||
# You can use the INCLUDE_FILE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard
|
||||
# patterns (like *.h and *.hpp) to filter out the header-files in the
|
||||
# directories. If left blank, the patterns specified with FILE_PATTERNS will
|
||||
# be used.
|
||||
|
||||
INCLUDE_FILE_PATTERNS =
|
||||
|
||||
# The PREDEFINED tag can be used to specify one or more macro names that
|
||||
# are defined before the preprocessor is started (similar to the -D option of
|
||||
# gcc). The argument of the tag is a list of macros of the form: name
|
||||
# or name=definition (no spaces). If the definition and the = are
|
||||
# omitted =1 is assumed. To prevent a macro definition from being
|
||||
# undefined via #undef or recursively expanded use the := operator
|
||||
# instead of the = operator.
|
||||
|
||||
PREDEFINED = __DOXYGEN__
|
||||
|
||||
# If the MACRO_EXPANSION and EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF tags are set to YES then
|
||||
# this tag can be used to specify a list of macro names that should be expanded.
|
||||
# The macro definition that is found in the sources will be used.
|
||||
# Use the PREDEFINED tag if you want to use a different macro definition.
|
||||
|
||||
EXPAND_AS_DEFINED = BUTTLOADTAG
|
||||
|
||||
# If the SKIP_FUNCTION_MACROS tag is set to YES (the default) then
|
||||
# doxygen's preprocessor will remove all function-like macros that are alone
|
||||
# on a line, have an all uppercase name, and do not end with a semicolon. Such
|
||||
# function macros are typically used for boiler-plate code, and will confuse
|
||||
# the parser if not removed.
|
||||
|
||||
SKIP_FUNCTION_MACROS = YES
|
||||
|
||||
#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
|
||||
# Configuration::additions related to external references
|
||||
#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
|
||||
|
||||
# The TAGFILES option can be used to specify one or more tagfiles.
|
||||
# Optionally an initial location of the external documentation
|
||||
# can be added for each tagfile. The format of a tag file without
|
||||
# this location is as follows:
|
||||
# TAGFILES = file1 file2 ...
|
||||
# Adding location for the tag files is done as follows:
|
||||
# TAGFILES = file1=loc1 "file2 = loc2" ...
|
||||
# where "loc1" and "loc2" can be relative or absolute paths or
|
||||
# URLs. If a location is present for each tag, the installdox tool
|
||||
# does not have to be run to correct the links.
|
||||
# Note that each tag file must have a unique name
|
||||
# (where the name does NOT include the path)
|
||||
# If a tag file is not located in the directory in which doxygen
|
||||
# is run, you must also specify the path to the tagfile here.
|
||||
|
||||
TAGFILES =
|
||||
|
||||
# When a file name is specified after GENERATE_TAGFILE, doxygen will create
|
||||
# a tag file that is based on the input files it reads.
|
||||
|
||||
GENERATE_TAGFILE =
|
||||
|
||||
# If the ALLEXTERNALS tag is set to YES all external classes will be listed
|
||||
# in the class index. If set to NO only the inherited external classes
|
||||
# will be listed.
|
||||
|
||||
ALLEXTERNALS = NO
|
||||
|
||||
# If the EXTERNAL_GROUPS tag is set to YES all external groups will be listed
|
||||
# in the modules index. If set to NO, only the current project's groups will
|
||||
# be listed.
|
||||
|
||||
EXTERNAL_GROUPS = YES
|
||||
|
||||
# The PERL_PATH should be the absolute path and name of the perl script
|
||||
# interpreter (i.e. the result of `which perl').
|
||||
|
||||
PERL_PATH = /usr/bin/perl
|
||||
|
||||
#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
|
||||
# Configuration options related to the dot tool
|
||||
#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
|
||||
|
||||
# If the CLASS_DIAGRAMS tag is set to YES (the default) Doxygen will
|
||||
# generate a inheritance diagram (in HTML, RTF and LaTeX) for classes with base
|
||||
# or super classes. Setting the tag to NO turns the diagrams off. Note that
|
||||
# this option is superseded by the HAVE_DOT option below. This is only a
|
||||
# fallback. It is recommended to install and use dot, since it yields more
|
||||
# powerful graphs.
|
||||
|
||||
CLASS_DIAGRAMS = NO
|
||||
|
||||
# You can define message sequence charts within doxygen comments using the \msc
|
||||
# command. Doxygen will then run the mscgen tool (see
|
||||
# http://www.mcternan.me.uk/mscgen/) to produce the chart and insert it in the
|
||||
# documentation. The MSCGEN_PATH tag allows you to specify the directory where
|
||||
# the mscgen tool resides. If left empty the tool is assumed to be found in the
|
||||
# default search path.
|
||||
|
||||
MSCGEN_PATH =
|
||||
|
||||
# If set to YES, the inheritance and collaboration graphs will hide
|
||||
# inheritance and usage relations if the target is undocumented
|
||||
# or is not a class.
|
||||
|
||||
HIDE_UNDOC_RELATIONS = YES
|
||||
|
||||
# If you set the HAVE_DOT tag to YES then doxygen will assume the dot tool is
|
||||
# available from the path. This tool is part of Graphviz, a graph visualization
|
||||
# toolkit from AT&T and Lucent Bell Labs. The other options in this section
|
||||
# have no effect if this option is set to NO (the default)
|
||||
|
||||
HAVE_DOT = NO
|
||||
|
||||
# By default doxygen will write a font called FreeSans.ttf to the output
|
||||
# directory and reference it in all dot files that doxygen generates. This
|
||||
# font does not include all possible unicode characters however, so when you need
|
||||
# these (or just want a differently looking font) you can specify the font name
|
||||
# using DOT_FONTNAME. You need need to make sure dot is able to find the font,
|
||||
# which can be done by putting it in a standard location or by setting the
|
||||
# DOTFONTPATH environment variable or by setting DOT_FONTPATH to the directory
|
||||
# containing the font.
|
||||
|
||||
DOT_FONTNAME = FreeSans
|
||||
|
||||
# The DOT_FONTSIZE tag can be used to set the size of the font of dot graphs.
|
||||
# The default size is 10pt.
|
||||
|
||||
DOT_FONTSIZE = 10
|
||||
|
||||
# By default doxygen will tell dot to use the output directory to look for the
|
||||
# FreeSans.ttf font (which doxygen will put there itself). If you specify a
|
||||
# different font using DOT_FONTNAME you can set the path where dot
|
||||
# can find it using this tag.
|
||||
|
||||
DOT_FONTPATH =
|
||||
|
||||
# If the CLASS_GRAPH and HAVE_DOT tags are set to YES then doxygen
|
||||
# will generate a graph for each documented class showing the direct and
|
||||
# indirect inheritance relations. Setting this tag to YES will force the
|
||||
# the CLASS_DIAGRAMS tag to NO.
|
||||
|
||||
CLASS_GRAPH = NO
|
||||
|
||||
# If the COLLABORATION_GRAPH and HAVE_DOT tags are set to YES then doxygen
|
||||
# will generate a graph for each documented class showing the direct and
|
||||
# indirect implementation dependencies (inheritance, containment, and
|
||||
# class references variables) of the class with other documented classes.
|
||||
|
||||
COLLABORATION_GRAPH = NO
|
||||
|
||||
# If the GROUP_GRAPHS and HAVE_DOT tags are set to YES then doxygen
|
||||
# will generate a graph for groups, showing the direct groups dependencies
|
||||
|
||||
GROUP_GRAPHS = NO
|
||||
|
||||
# If the UML_LOOK tag is set to YES doxygen will generate inheritance and
|
||||
# collaboration diagrams in a style similar to the OMG's Unified Modeling
|
||||
# Language.
|
||||
|
||||
UML_LOOK = NO
|
||||
|
||||
# If set to YES, the inheritance and collaboration graphs will show the
|
||||
# relations between templates and their instances.
|
||||
|
||||
TEMPLATE_RELATIONS = NO
|
||||
|
||||
# If the ENABLE_PREPROCESSING, SEARCH_INCLUDES, INCLUDE_GRAPH, and HAVE_DOT
|
||||
# tags are set to YES then doxygen will generate a graph for each documented
|
||||
# file showing the direct and indirect include dependencies of the file with
|
||||
# other documented files.
|
||||
|
||||
INCLUDE_GRAPH = NO
|
||||
|
||||
# If the ENABLE_PREPROCESSING, SEARCH_INCLUDES, INCLUDED_BY_GRAPH, and
|
||||
# HAVE_DOT tags are set to YES then doxygen will generate a graph for each
|
||||
# documented header file showing the documented files that directly or
|
||||
# indirectly include this file.
|
||||
|
||||
INCLUDED_BY_GRAPH = NO
|
||||
|
||||
# If the CALL_GRAPH and HAVE_DOT options are set to YES then
|
||||
# doxygen will generate a call dependency graph for every global function
|
||||
# or class method. Note that enabling this option will significantly increase
|
||||
# the time of a run. So in most cases it will be better to enable call graphs
|
||||
# for selected functions only using the \callgraph command.
|
||||
|
||||
CALL_GRAPH = NO
|
||||
|
||||
# If the CALLER_GRAPH and HAVE_DOT tags are set to YES then
|
||||
# doxygen will generate a caller dependency graph for every global function
|
||||
# or class method. Note that enabling this option will significantly increase
|
||||
# the time of a run. So in most cases it will be better to enable caller
|
||||
# graphs for selected functions only using the \callergraph command.
|
||||
|
||||
CALLER_GRAPH = NO
|
||||
|
||||
# If the GRAPHICAL_HIERARCHY and HAVE_DOT tags are set to YES then doxygen
|
||||
# will graphical hierarchy of all classes instead of a textual one.
|
||||
|
||||
GRAPHICAL_HIERARCHY = NO
|
||||
|
||||
# If the DIRECTORY_GRAPH, SHOW_DIRECTORIES and HAVE_DOT tags are set to YES
|
||||
# then doxygen will show the dependencies a directory has on other directories
|
||||
# in a graphical way. The dependency relations are determined by the #include
|
||||
# relations between the files in the directories.
|
||||
|
||||
DIRECTORY_GRAPH = NO
|
||||
|
||||
# The DOT_IMAGE_FORMAT tag can be used to set the image format of the images
|
||||
# generated by dot. Possible values are png, jpg, or gif
|
||||
# If left blank png will be used.
|
||||
|
||||
DOT_IMAGE_FORMAT = png
|
||||
|
||||
# The tag DOT_PATH can be used to specify the path where the dot tool can be
|
||||
# found. If left blank, it is assumed the dot tool can be found in the path.
|
||||
|
||||
DOT_PATH = "C:/Program Files/Graphviz2.18/bin"
|
||||
|
||||
# The DOTFILE_DIRS tag can be used to specify one or more directories that
|
||||
# contain dot files that are included in the documentation (see the
|
||||
# \dotfile command).
|
||||
|
||||
DOTFILE_DIRS =
|
||||
|
||||
# The DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES tag can be used to set the maximum number of
|
||||
# nodes that will be shown in the graph. If the number of nodes in a graph
|
||||
# becomes larger than this value, doxygen will truncate the graph, which is
|
||||
# visualized by representing a node as a red box. Note that doxygen if the
|
||||
# number of direct children of the root node in a graph is already larger than
|
||||
# DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES then the graph will not be shown at all. Also note
|
||||
# that the size of a graph can be further restricted by MAX_DOT_GRAPH_DEPTH.
|
||||
|
||||
DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES = 15
|
||||
|
||||
# The MAX_DOT_GRAPH_DEPTH tag can be used to set the maximum depth of the
|
||||
# graphs generated by dot. A depth value of 3 means that only nodes reachable
|
||||
# from the root by following a path via at most 3 edges will be shown. Nodes
|
||||
# that lay further from the root node will be omitted. Note that setting this
|
||||
# option to 1 or 2 may greatly reduce the computation time needed for large
|
||||
# code bases. Also note that the size of a graph can be further restricted by
|
||||
# DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES. Using a depth of 0 means no depth restriction.
|
||||
|
||||
MAX_DOT_GRAPH_DEPTH = 2
|
||||
|
||||
# Set the DOT_TRANSPARENT tag to YES to generate images with a transparent
|
||||
# background. This is disabled by default, because dot on Windows does not
|
||||
# seem to support this out of the box. Warning: Depending on the platform used,
|
||||
# enabling this option may lead to badly anti-aliased labels on the edges of
|
||||
# a graph (i.e. they become hard to read).
|
||||
|
||||
DOT_TRANSPARENT = YES
|
||||
|
||||
# Set the DOT_MULTI_TARGETS tag to YES allow dot to generate multiple output
|
||||
# files in one run (i.e. multiple -o and -T options on the command line). This
|
||||
# makes dot run faster, but since only newer versions of dot (>1.8.10)
|
||||
# support this, this feature is disabled by default.
|
||||
|
||||
DOT_MULTI_TARGETS = NO
|
||||
|
||||
# If the GENERATE_LEGEND tag is set to YES (the default) Doxygen will
|
||||
# generate a legend page explaining the meaning of the various boxes and
|
||||
# arrows in the dot generated graphs.
|
||||
|
||||
GENERATE_LEGEND = YES
|
||||
|
||||
# If the DOT_CLEANUP tag is set to YES (the default) Doxygen will
|
||||
# remove the intermediate dot files that are used to generate
|
||||
# the various graphs.
|
||||
|
||||
DOT_CLEANUP = YES
|
||||
|
||||
#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
|
||||
# Configuration::additions related to the search engine
|
||||
#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
|
||||
|
||||
# The SEARCHENGINE tag specifies whether or not a search engine should be
|
||||
# used. If set to NO the values of all tags below this one will be ignored.
|
||||
|
||||
SEARCHENGINE = NO
|
@ -0,0 +1,156 @@
|
||||
/*
|
||||
LUFA Library
|
||||
Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2009.
|
||||
|
||||
dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com
|
||||
www.fourwalledcubicle.com
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
/*
|
||||
Copyright 2009 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com)
|
||||
|
||||
Permission to use, copy, modify, and distribute this software
|
||||
and its documentation for any purpose and without fee is hereby
|
||||
granted, provided that the above copyright notice appear in all
|
||||
copies and that both that the copyright notice and this
|
||||
permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting
|
||||
documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in
|
||||
advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the
|
||||
software without specific, written prior permission.
|
||||
|
||||
The author disclaim all warranties with regard to this
|
||||
software, including all implied warranties of merchantability
|
||||
and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any
|
||||
special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages
|
||||
whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether
|
||||
in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action,
|
||||
arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of
|
||||
this software.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
/** \file
|
||||
*
|
||||
* Main source file for the TeensyHID bootloader. This file contains the complete bootloader logic.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
#define INCLUDE_FROM_TEENSYHID_C
|
||||
#include "TeensyHID.h"
|
||||
|
||||
/* Global Variables: */
|
||||
/** Flag to indicate if the bootloader should be running, or should exit and allow the application code to run
|
||||
* via a soft reset. When cleared, the bootloader will abort, the USB interface will shut down and the application
|
||||
* started via a forced watchdog reset.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
bool RunBootloader = true;
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/** Main program entry point. This routine configures the hardware required by the bootloader, then continuously
|
||||
* runs the bootloader processing routine until instructed to soft-exit.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
int main(void)
|
||||
{
|
||||
/* Disable watchdog if enabled by bootloader/fuses */
|
||||
MCUSR &= ~(1 << WDRF);
|
||||
wdt_disable();
|
||||
|
||||
/* Disable Clock Division */
|
||||
SetSystemClockPrescaler(0);
|
||||
|
||||
/* Relocate the interrupt vector table to the bootloader section */
|
||||
MCUCR = (1 << IVCE);
|
||||
MCUCR = (1 << IVSEL);
|
||||
|
||||
/* Initialize USB subsystem */
|
||||
USB_Init();
|
||||
|
||||
while (RunBootloader)
|
||||
USB_USBTask();
|
||||
|
||||
/* Shut down the USB interface, so that the host will register the disconnection */
|
||||
USB_ShutDown();
|
||||
|
||||
/* Wait 100ms to give the host time to register the disconnection */
|
||||
_delay_ms(100);
|
||||
|
||||
/* Enable the watchdog and force a timeout to reset the AVR */
|
||||
wdt_enable(WDTO_250MS);
|
||||
|
||||
for (;;);
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
/** Event handler for the USB_ConfigurationChanged event. This configures the device's endpoints ready
|
||||
* to relay data to and from the attached USB host.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
EVENT_HANDLER(USB_ConfigurationChanged)
|
||||
{
|
||||
/* Setup HID Report Endpoint */
|
||||
Endpoint_ConfigureEndpoint(HID_EPNUM, EP_TYPE_INTERRUPT,
|
||||
ENDPOINT_DIR_IN, HID_EPSIZE,
|
||||
ENDPOINT_BANK_SINGLE);
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
/** Event handler for the USB_UnhandledControlPacket event. This is used to catch standard and class specific
|
||||
* control requests that are not handled internally by the USB library (including the HID commands, which are
|
||||
* all issued via the control endpoint), so that they can be handled appropriately for the application.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
EVENT_HANDLER(USB_UnhandledControlPacket)
|
||||
{
|
||||
/* Handle HID Class specific requests */
|
||||
switch (bRequest)
|
||||
{
|
||||
case REQ_SetReport:
|
||||
if (bmRequestType == (REQDIR_HOSTTODEVICE | REQTYPE_CLASS | REQREC_INTERFACE))
|
||||
{
|
||||
Endpoint_ClearSetupReceived();
|
||||
|
||||
/* Wait until the command (report) has been sent by the host */
|
||||
while (!(Endpoint_IsSetupOUTReceived()));
|
||||
|
||||
/* Read in the write destination address */
|
||||
uint16_t PageAddress = Endpoint_Read_Word_LE();
|
||||
|
||||
/* Check if the command is a program page command, or a start application command */
|
||||
if (PageAddress == TEENSY_STARTAPPLICATION)
|
||||
{
|
||||
RunBootloader = false;
|
||||
}
|
||||
else
|
||||
{
|
||||
/* Erase the given FLASH page, ready to be programmed */
|
||||
boot_page_erase(PageAddress);
|
||||
boot_spm_busy_wait();
|
||||
|
||||
/* Write each of the FLASH page's bytes in sequence */
|
||||
for (uint8_t PageByte = 0; PageByte < 128; PageByte += 2)
|
||||
{
|
||||
/* Check if endpoint is empty - if so clear it and wait until ready for next packet */
|
||||
if (!(Endpoint_BytesInEndpoint()))
|
||||
{
|
||||
Endpoint_ClearSetupOUT();
|
||||
while (!(Endpoint_IsSetupOUTReceived()));
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
/* Write the next data word to the FLASH page */
|
||||
boot_page_fill(PageAddress + PageByte, Endpoint_Read_Word_LE());
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
/* Write the filled FLASH page to memory */
|
||||
boot_page_write(PageAddress);
|
||||
boot_spm_busy_wait();
|
||||
|
||||
/* Re-enable RWW section */
|
||||
boot_rww_enable();
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
Endpoint_ClearSetupOUT();
|
||||
|
||||
/* Wait until the host is ready to receive the request confirmation */
|
||||
while (!(Endpoint_IsSetupINReady()));
|
||||
|
||||
/* Handshake the request by sending an empty IN packet */
|
||||
Endpoint_ClearSetupIN();
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
break;
|
||||
}
|
||||
}
|
@ -0,0 +1,73 @@
|
||||
/*
|
||||
LUFA Library
|
||||
Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2009.
|
||||
|
||||
dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com
|
||||
www.fourwalledcubicle.com
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
/*
|
||||
Copyright 2009 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com)
|
||||
|
||||
Permission to use, copy, modify, and distribute this software
|
||||
and its documentation for any purpose and without fee is hereby
|
||||
granted, provided that the above copyright notice appear in all
|
||||
copies and that both that the copyright notice and this
|
||||
permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting
|
||||
documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in
|
||||
advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the
|
||||
software without specific, written prior permission.
|
||||
|
||||
The author disclaim all warranties with regard to this
|
||||
software, including all implied warranties of merchantability
|
||||
and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any
|
||||
special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages
|
||||
whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether
|
||||
in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action,
|
||||
arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of
|
||||
this software.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
/** \file
|
||||
*
|
||||
* Header file for TeensyHID.c.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
#ifndef _TEENSYHID_H_
|
||||
#define _TEENSYHID_H_
|
||||
|
||||
/* Includes: */
|
||||
#include <avr/io.h>
|
||||
#include <avr/wdt.h>
|
||||
#include <avr/boot.h>
|
||||
#include <avr/wdt.h>
|
||||
#include <util/delay.h>
|
||||
#include <stdbool.h>
|
||||
|
||||
#include "Descriptors.h"
|
||||
|
||||
#include <LUFA/Version.h> // Library Version Information
|
||||
#include <LUFA/Drivers/USB/USB.h> // USB Functionality
|
||||
|
||||
/* Preprocessor Checks: */
|
||||
#if !defined(__AVR_AT90USB162__)
|
||||
#error This bootloader is not compatible with the selected AVR model.
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
/* Macros: */
|
||||
/** HID Class specific request to send the next HID report to the device. */
|
||||
#define REQ_SetReport 0x09
|
||||
|
||||
#define TEENSY_STARTAPPLICATION 0xFFFF
|
||||
|
||||
/* Event Handlers: */
|
||||
/** Indicates that this module will catch the USB_Disconnect event when thrown by the library. */
|
||||
HANDLES_EVENT(USB_Disconnect);
|
||||
|
||||
/** Indicates that this module will catch the USB_ConfigurationChanged event when thrown by the library. */
|
||||
HANDLES_EVENT(USB_ConfigurationChanged);
|
||||
|
||||
/** Indicates that this module will catch the USB_UnhandledControlPacket event when thrown by the library. */
|
||||
HANDLES_EVENT(USB_UnhandledControlPacket);
|
||||
|
||||
#endif
|
@ -0,0 +1,41 @@
|
||||
/** \file
|
||||
*
|
||||
* This file contains special DoxyGen information for the generation of the main page and other special
|
||||
* documentation pages. It is not a project source file.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
/** \mainpage Teensy HID Class USB AVR Bootloader
|
||||
*
|
||||
* This bootloader enumerates to the host as a HID Class device, allowing for Teensy compatible programming
|
||||
* software to load firmware onto the AVR, such as the official software at http://www.pjrc.com/teensy/.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* Out of the box this bootloader builds for the USB162, and will fit into 2KB of bootloader space.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* This spoofs (with permission) the offical Teensy bootloader's VID and PID, so that the software remains
|
||||
* compatible with no changes.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* <table>
|
||||
* <tr>
|
||||
* <td><b>USB Mode:</b></td>
|
||||
* <td>Device</td>
|
||||
* </tr>
|
||||
* <tr>
|
||||
* <td><b>USB Class:</b></td>
|
||||
* <td>Human Interface Device Class (HID)</td>
|
||||
* </tr>
|
||||
* <tr>
|
||||
* <td><b>USB Subclass:</b></td>
|
||||
* <td>N/A</td>
|
||||
* </tr>
|
||||
* <tr>
|
||||
* <td><b>Relevant Standards:</b></td>
|
||||
* <td>USBIF HID Class Standard</td>
|
||||
* <td>Teensy Programming Protocol Details</td>
|
||||
* </tr>
|
||||
* <tr>
|
||||
* <td><b>Usable Speeds:</b></td>
|
||||
* <td>Low Speed Mode</td>
|
||||
* <td>Full Speed Mode</td>
|
||||
* </tr>
|
||||
* </table>
|
||||
*/
|
@ -0,0 +1,711 @@
|
||||
# Hey Emacs, this is a -*- makefile -*-
|
||||
#----------------------------------------------------------------------------
|
||||
# WinAVR Makefile Template written by Eric B. Weddington, Jörg Wunsch, et al.
|
||||
# >> Modified for use with the LUFA project. <<
|
||||
#
|
||||
# Released to the Public Domain
|
||||
#
|
||||
# Additional material for this makefile was written by:
|
||||
# Peter Fleury
|
||||
# Tim Henigan
|
||||
# Colin O'Flynn
|
||||
# Reiner Patommel
|
||||
# Markus Pfaff
|
||||
# Sander Pool
|
||||
# Frederik Rouleau
|
||||
# Carlos Lamas
|
||||
# Dean Camera
|
||||
# Opendous Inc.
|
||||
# Denver Gingerich
|
||||
#
|
||||
#----------------------------------------------------------------------------
|
||||
# On command line:
|
||||
#
|
||||
# make all = Make software.
|
||||
#
|
||||
# make clean = Clean out built project files.
|
||||
#
|
||||
# make coff = Convert ELF to AVR COFF.
|
||||
#
|
||||
# make extcoff = Convert ELF to AVR Extended COFF.
|
||||
#
|
||||
# make program = Download the hex file to the device, using avrdude.
|
||||
# Please customize the avrdude settings below first!
|
||||
#
|
||||
# make dfu = Download the hex file to the device, using dfu-programmer (must
|
||||
# have dfu-programmer installed).
|
||||
#
|
||||
# make flip = Download the hex file to the device, using Atmel FLIP (must
|
||||
# have Atmel FLIP installed).
|
||||
#
|
||||
# make dfu-ee = Download the eeprom file to the device, using dfu-programmer
|
||||
# (must have dfu-programmer installed).
|
||||
#
|
||||
# make flip-ee = Download the eeprom file to the device, using Atmel FLIP
|
||||
# (must have Atmel FLIP installed).
|
||||
#
|
||||
# make doxygen = Generate DoxyGen documentation for the project (must have
|
||||
# DoxyGen installed)
|
||||
#
|
||||
# make debug = Start either simulavr or avarice as specified for debugging,
|
||||
# with avr-gdb or avr-insight as the front end for debugging.
|
||||
#
|
||||
# make filename.s = Just compile filename.c into the assembler code only.
|
||||
#
|
||||
# make filename.i = Create a preprocessed source file for use in submitting
|
||||
# bug reports to the GCC project.
|
||||
#
|
||||
# To rebuild project do "make clean" then "make all".
|
||||
#----------------------------------------------------------------------------
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
# MCU name
|
||||
MCU = at90usb162
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
# Target board (see library BoardTypes.h documentation, USER or blank for projects not requiring
|
||||
# LUFA board drivers). If USER is selected, put custom board drivers in a directory called
|
||||
# "Board" inside the application directory.
|
||||
BOARD = USBKEY
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
# Processor frequency.
|
||||
# This will define a symbol, F_CPU, in all source code files equal to the
|
||||
# processor frequency. You can then use this symbol in your source code to
|
||||
# calculate timings. Do NOT tack on a 'UL' at the end, this will be done
|
||||
# automatically to create a 32-bit value in your source code.
|
||||
# Typical values are:
|
||||
# F_CPU = 1000000
|
||||
# F_CPU = 1843200
|
||||
# F_CPU = 2000000
|
||||
# F_CPU = 3686400
|
||||
# F_CPU = 4000000
|
||||
# F_CPU = 7372800
|
||||
# F_CPU = 8000000
|
||||
# F_CPU = 11059200
|
||||
# F_CPU = 14745600
|
||||
# F_CPU = 16000000
|
||||
# F_CPU = 18432000
|
||||
# F_CPU = 20000000
|
||||
F_CPU = 8000000
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
# Output format. (can be srec, ihex, binary)
|
||||
FORMAT = ihex
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
# Target file name (without extension).
|
||||
TARGET = TeensyHID
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
# Object files directory
|
||||
# To put object files in current directory, use a dot (.), do NOT make
|
||||
# this an empty or blank macro!
|
||||
OBJDIR = .
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
# List C source files here. (C dependencies are automatically generated.)
|
||||
SRC = $(TARGET).c \
|
||||
Descriptors.c \
|
||||
../../LUFA/Drivers/USB/LowLevel/LowLevel.c \
|
||||
../../LUFA/Drivers/USB/LowLevel/Endpoint.c \
|
||||
../../LUFA/Drivers/USB/LowLevel/DevChapter9.c \
|
||||
../../LUFA/Drivers/USB/HighLevel/USBTask.c \
|
||||
../../LUFA/Drivers/USB/HighLevel/USBInterrupt.c \
|
||||
../../LUFA/Drivers/USB/HighLevel/Events.c \
|
||||
../../LUFA/Drivers/USB/HighLevel/StdDescriptors.c \
|
||||
|
||||
# List C++ source files here. (C dependencies are automatically generated.)
|
||||
CPPSRC =
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
# List Assembler source files here.
|
||||
# Make them always end in a capital .S. Files ending in a lowercase .s
|
||||
# will not be considered source files but generated files (assembler
|
||||
# output from the compiler), and will be deleted upon "make clean"!
|
||||
# Even though the DOS/Win* filesystem matches both .s and .S the same,
|
||||
# it will preserve the spelling of the filenames, and gcc itself does
|
||||
# care about how the name is spelled on its command-line.
|
||||
ASRC =
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
# Optimization level, can be [0, 1, 2, 3, s].
|
||||
# 0 = turn off optimization. s = optimize for size.
|
||||
# (Note: 3 is not always the best optimization level. See avr-libc FAQ.)
|
||||
OPT = s
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
# Debugging format.
|
||||
# Native formats for AVR-GCC's -g are dwarf-2 [default] or stabs.
|
||||
# AVR Studio 4.10 requires dwarf-2.
|
||||
# AVR [Extended] COFF format requires stabs, plus an avr-objcopy run.
|
||||
DEBUG = dwarf-2
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
# List any extra directories to look for include files here.
|
||||
# Each directory must be seperated by a space.
|
||||
# Use forward slashes for directory separators.
|
||||
# For a directory that has spaces, enclose it in quotes.
|
||||
EXTRAINCDIRS = ../../
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
# Compiler flag to set the C Standard level.
|
||||
# c89 = "ANSI" C
|
||||
# gnu89 = c89 plus GCC extensions
|
||||
# c99 = ISO C99 standard (not yet fully implemented)
|
||||
# gnu99 = c99 plus GCC extensions
|
||||
CSTANDARD = -std=gnu99
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
# Starting byte address of the bootloader
|
||||
BOOT_START = 0xC000
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
# Place -D or -U options here for C sources
|
||||
CDEFS = -DF_CPU=$(F_CPU)UL -DBOARD=BOARD_$(BOARD) -DUSE_NONSTANDARD_DESCRIPTOR_NAMES -DSTATIC_ENDPOINT_CONFIGURATION
|
||||
CDEFS += -DUSB_DEVICE_ONLY -DUSE_STATIC_OPTIONS="(USB_DEVICE_OPT_FULLSPEED | USB_OPT_REG_ENABLED | USB_OPT_AUTO_PLL)"
|
||||
CDEFS += -DUSE_RAM_DESCRIPTORS -DBOOT_START_ADDR=$(BOOT_START)UL -DFIXED_CONTROL_ENDPOINT_SIZE=8 -DUSE_SINGLE_DEVICE_CONFIGURATION
|
||||
CDEFS += -DNO_CLEARSET_FEATURE_REQUEST
|
||||
|
||||
# Place -D or -U options here for ASM sources
|
||||
ADEFS = -DF_CPU=$(F_CPU)
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
# Place -D or -U options here for C++ sources
|
||||
CPPDEFS = -DF_CPU=$(F_CPU)UL
|
||||
#CPPDEFS += -D__STDC_LIMIT_MACROS
|
||||
#CPPDEFS += -D__STDC_CONSTANT_MACROS
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
#---------------- Compiler Options C ----------------
|
||||
# -g*: generate debugging information
|
||||
# -O*: optimization level
|
||||
# -f...: tuning, see GCC manual and avr-libc documentation
|
||||
# -Wall...: warning level
|
||||
# -Wa,...: tell GCC to pass this to the assembler.
|
||||
# -adhlns...: create assembler listing
|
||||
CFLAGS = -g$(DEBUG)
|
||||
CFLAGS += $(CDEFS)
|
||||
CFLAGS += -O$(OPT)
|
||||
CFLAGS += -funsigned-char
|
||||
CFLAGS += -funsigned-bitfields
|
||||
CFLAGS += -ffunction-sections
|
||||
CFLAGS += -fpack-struct
|
||||
CFLAGS += -fshort-enums
|
||||
CFLAGS += -fno-inline-small-functions
|
||||
CFLAGS += -fno-reorder-blocks
|
||||
CFLAGS += -fno-reorder-blocks-and-partition
|
||||
CFLAGS += -fno-reorder-functions
|
||||
CFLAGS += -fno-toplevel-reorder
|
||||
CFLAGS += -Wall
|
||||
CFLAGS += -Wstrict-prototypes
|
||||
CFLAGS += -Wundef
|
||||
#CFLAGS += -fno-unit-at-a-time
|
||||
#CFLAGS += -Wunreachable-code
|
||||
#CFLAGS += -Wsign-compare
|
||||
CFLAGS += -Wa,-adhlns=$(<:%.c=$(OBJDIR)/%.lst)
|
||||
CFLAGS += $(patsubst %,-I%,$(EXTRAINCDIRS))
|
||||
CFLAGS += $(CSTANDARD)
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
#---------------- Compiler Options C++ ----------------
|
||||
# -g*: generate debugging information
|
||||
# -O*: optimization level
|
||||
# -f...: tuning, see GCC manual and avr-libc documentation
|
||||
# -Wall...: warning level
|
||||
# -Wa,...: tell GCC to pass this to the assembler.
|
||||
# -adhlns...: create assembler listing
|
||||
CPPFLAGS = -g$(DEBUG)
|
||||
CPPFLAGS += $(CPPDEFS)
|
||||
CPPFLAGS += -O$(OPT)
|
||||
CPPFLAGS += -funsigned-char
|
||||
CPPFLAGS += -funsigned-bitfields
|
||||
CPPFLAGS += -fpack-struct
|
||||
CPPFLAGS += -fshort-enums
|
||||
CPPFLAGS += -fno-exceptions
|
||||
CPPFLAGS += -Wall
|
||||
CFLAGS += -Wundef
|
||||
#CPPFLAGS += -mshort-calls
|
||||
#CPPFLAGS += -fno-unit-at-a-time
|
||||
#CPPFLAGS += -Wstrict-prototypes
|
||||
#CPPFLAGS += -Wunreachable-code
|
||||
#CPPFLAGS += -Wsign-compare
|
||||
CPPFLAGS += -Wa,-adhlns=$(<:%.cpp=$(OBJDIR)/%.lst)
|
||||
CPPFLAGS += $(patsubst %,-I%,$(EXTRAINCDIRS))
|
||||
#CPPFLAGS += $(CSTANDARD)
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
#---------------- Assembler Options ----------------
|
||||
# -Wa,...: tell GCC to pass this to the assembler.
|
||||
# -adhlns: create listing
|
||||
# -gstabs: have the assembler create line number information; note that
|
||||
# for use in COFF files, additional information about filenames
|
||||
# and function names needs to be present in the assembler source
|
||||
# files -- see avr-libc docs [FIXME: not yet described there]
|
||||
# -listing-cont-lines: Sets the maximum number of continuation lines of hex
|
||||
# dump that will be displayed for a given single line of source input.
|
||||
ASFLAGS = $(ADEFS) -Wa,-adhlns=$(<:%.S=$(OBJDIR)/%.lst),-gstabs,--listing-cont-lines=100
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
#---------------- Library Options ----------------
|
||||
# Minimalistic printf version
|
||||
PRINTF_LIB_MIN = -Wl,-u,vfprintf -lprintf_min
|
||||
|
||||
# Floating point printf version (requires MATH_LIB = -lm below)
|
||||
PRINTF_LIB_FLOAT = -Wl,-u,vfprintf -lprintf_flt
|
||||
|
||||
# If this is left blank, then it will use the Standard printf version.
|
||||
PRINTF_LIB =
|
||||
#PRINTF_LIB = $(PRINTF_LIB_MIN)
|
||||
#PRINTF_LIB = $(PRINTF_LIB_FLOAT)
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
# Minimalistic scanf version
|
||||
SCANF_LIB_MIN = -Wl,-u,vfscanf -lscanf_min
|
||||
|
||||
# Floating point + %[ scanf version (requires MATH_LIB = -lm below)
|
||||
SCANF_LIB_FLOAT = -Wl,-u,vfscanf -lscanf_flt
|
||||
|
||||
# If this is left blank, then it will use the Standard scanf version.
|
||||
SCANF_LIB =
|
||||
#SCANF_LIB = $(SCANF_LIB_MIN)
|
||||
#SCANF_LIB = $(SCANF_LIB_FLOAT)
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
MATH_LIB = -lm
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
# List any extra directories to look for libraries here.
|
||||
# Each directory must be seperated by a space.
|
||||
# Use forward slashes for directory separators.
|
||||
# For a directory that has spaces, enclose it in quotes.
|
||||
EXTRALIBDIRS =
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
#---------------- External Memory Options ----------------
|
||||
|
||||
# 64 KB of external RAM, starting after internal RAM (ATmega128!),
|
||||
# used for variables (.data/.bss) and heap (malloc()).
|
||||
#EXTMEMOPTS = -Wl,-Tdata=0x801100,--defsym=__heap_end=0x80ffff
|
||||
|
||||
# 64 KB of external RAM, starting after internal RAM (ATmega128!),
|
||||
# only used for heap (malloc()).
|
||||
#EXTMEMOPTS = -Wl,--section-start,.data=0x801100,--defsym=__heap_end=0x80ffff
|
||||
|
||||
EXTMEMOPTS =
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
#---------------- Linker Options ----------------
|
||||
# -Wl,...: tell GCC to pass this to linker.
|
||||
# -Map: create map file
|
||||
# --cref: add cross reference to map file
|
||||
LDFLAGS = -Wl,-Map=$(TARGET).map,--cref
|
||||
LDFLAGS += -Wl,--relax
|
||||
LDFLAGS += -Wl,--gc-sections
|
||||
LDFLAGS += -Wl,--section-start=.text=$(BOOT_START)
|
||||
LDFLAGS += $(EXTMEMOPTS)
|
||||
LDFLAGS += $(patsubst %,-L%,$(EXTRALIBDIRS))
|
||||
LDFLAGS += $(PRINTF_LIB) $(SCANF_LIB) $(MATH_LIB)
|
||||
#LDFLAGS += -T linker_script.x
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
#---------------- Programming Options (avrdude) ----------------
|
||||
|
||||
# Programming hardware: alf avr910 avrisp bascom bsd
|
||||
# dt006 pavr picoweb pony-stk200 sp12 stk200 stk500
|
||||
#
|
||||
# Type: avrdude -c ?
|
||||
# to get a full listing.
|
||||
#
|
||||
AVRDUDE_PROGRAMMER = jtagmkII
|
||||
|
||||
# com1 = serial port. Use lpt1 to connect to parallel port.
|
||||
AVRDUDE_PORT = usb
|
||||
|
||||
AVRDUDE_WRITE_FLASH = -U flash:w:$(TARGET).hex
|
||||
#AVRDUDE_WRITE_EEPROM = -U eeprom:w:$(TARGET).eep
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
# Uncomment the following if you want avrdude's erase cycle counter.
|
||||
# Note that this counter needs to be initialized first using -Yn,
|
||||
# see avrdude manual.
|
||||
#AVRDUDE_ERASE_COUNTER = -y
|
||||
|
||||
# Uncomment the following if you do /not/ wish a verification to be
|
||||
# performed after programming the device.
|
||||
#AVRDUDE_NO_VERIFY = -V
|
||||
|
||||
# Increase verbosity level. Please use this when submitting bug
|
||||
# reports about avrdude. See <http://savannah.nongnu.org/projects/avrdude>
|
||||
# to submit bug reports.
|
||||
#AVRDUDE_VERBOSE = -v -v
|
||||
|
||||
AVRDUDE_FLAGS = -p $(MCU) -P $(AVRDUDE_PORT) -c $(AVRDUDE_PROGRAMMER)
|
||||
AVRDUDE_FLAGS += $(AVRDUDE_NO_VERIFY)
|
||||
AVRDUDE_FLAGS += $(AVRDUDE_VERBOSE)
|
||||
AVRDUDE_FLAGS += $(AVRDUDE_ERASE_COUNTER)
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
#---------------- Debugging Options ----------------
|
||||
|
||||
# For simulavr only - target MCU frequency.
|
||||
DEBUG_MFREQ = $(F_CPU)
|
||||
|
||||
# Set the DEBUG_UI to either gdb or insight.
|
||||
# DEBUG_UI = gdb
|
||||
DEBUG_UI = insight
|
||||
|
||||
# Set the debugging back-end to either avarice, simulavr.
|
||||
DEBUG_BACKEND = avarice
|
||||
#DEBUG_BACKEND = simulavr
|
||||
|
||||
# GDB Init Filename.
|
||||
GDBINIT_FILE = __avr_gdbinit
|
||||
|
||||
# When using avarice settings for the JTAG
|
||||
JTAG_DEV = /dev/com1
|
||||
|
||||
# Debugging port used to communicate between GDB / avarice / simulavr.
|
||||
DEBUG_PORT = 4242
|
||||
|
||||
# Debugging host used to communicate between GDB / avarice / simulavr, normally
|
||||
# just set to localhost unless doing some sort of crazy debugging when
|
||||
# avarice is running on a different computer.
|
||||
DEBUG_HOST = localhost
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
#============================================================================
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
# Define programs and commands.
|
||||
SHELL = sh
|
||||
CC = avr-gcc
|
||||
OBJCOPY = avr-objcopy
|
||||
OBJDUMP = avr-objdump
|
||||
SIZE = avr-size
|
||||
AR = avr-ar rcs
|
||||
NM = avr-nm
|
||||
AVRDUDE = avrdude
|
||||
REMOVE = rm -f
|
||||
REMOVEDIR = rm -rf
|
||||
COPY = cp
|
||||
WINSHELL = cmd
|
||||
|
||||
# Define Messages
|
||||
# English
|
||||
MSG_ERRORS_NONE = Errors: none
|
||||
MSG_BEGIN = -------- begin --------
|
||||
MSG_END = -------- end --------
|
||||
MSG_SIZE_BEFORE = Size before:
|
||||
MSG_SIZE_AFTER = Size after:
|
||||
MSG_COFF = Converting to AVR COFF:
|
||||
MSG_EXTENDED_COFF = Converting to AVR Extended COFF:
|
||||
MSG_FLASH = Creating load file for Flash:
|
||||
MSG_EEPROM = Creating load file for EEPROM:
|
||||
MSG_EXTENDED_LISTING = Creating Extended Listing:
|
||||
MSG_SYMBOL_TABLE = Creating Symbol Table:
|
||||
MSG_LINKING = Linking:
|
||||
MSG_COMPILING = Compiling C:
|
||||
MSG_COMPILING_CPP = Compiling C++:
|
||||
MSG_ASSEMBLING = Assembling:
|
||||
MSG_CLEANING = Cleaning project:
|
||||
MSG_CREATING_LIBRARY = Creating library:
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
# Define all object files.
|
||||
OBJ = $(SRC:%.c=$(OBJDIR)/%.o) $(CPPSRC:%.cpp=$(OBJDIR)/%.o) $(ASRC:%.S=$(OBJDIR)/%.o)
|
||||
|
||||
# Define all listing files.
|
||||
LST = $(SRC:%.c=$(OBJDIR)/%.lst) $(CPPSRC:%.cpp=$(OBJDIR)/%.lst) $(ASRC:%.S=$(OBJDIR)/%.lst)
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
# Compiler flags to generate dependency files.
|
||||
GENDEPFLAGS = -MMD -MP -MF .dep/$(@F).d
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
# Combine all necessary flags and optional flags.
|
||||
# Add target processor to flags.
|
||||
ALL_CFLAGS = -mmcu=$(MCU) -I. $(CFLAGS) $(GENDEPFLAGS)
|
||||
ALL_CPPFLAGS = -mmcu=$(MCU) -I. -x c++ $(CPPFLAGS) $(GENDEPFLAGS)
|
||||
ALL_ASFLAGS = -mmcu=$(MCU) -I. -x assembler-with-cpp $(ASFLAGS)
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
# Default target.
|
||||
all: begin gccversion sizebefore build checkhooks checklibmode sizeafter end
|
||||
|
||||
# Change the build target to build a HEX file or a library.
|
||||
build: elf hex eep lss sym
|
||||
#build: lib
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
elf: $(TARGET).elf
|
||||
hex: $(TARGET).hex
|
||||
eep: $(TARGET).eep
|
||||
lss: $(TARGET).lss
|
||||
sym: $(TARGET).sym
|
||||
LIBNAME=lib$(TARGET).a
|
||||
lib: $(LIBNAME)
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
# Eye candy.
|
||||
# AVR Studio 3.x does not check make's exit code but relies on
|
||||
# the following magic strings to be generated by the compile job.
|
||||
begin:
|
||||
@echo
|
||||
@echo $(MSG_BEGIN)
|
||||
|
||||
end:
|
||||
@echo $(MSG_END)
|
||||
@echo
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
# Display size of file.
|
||||
HEXSIZE = $(SIZE) --target=$(FORMAT) $(TARGET).hex
|
||||
ELFSIZE = $(SIZE) $(MCU_FLAG) $(FORMAT_FLAG) $(TARGET).elf
|
||||
MCU_FLAG = $(shell $(SIZE) --help | grep -- --mcu > /dev/null && echo --mcu=$(MCU) )
|
||||
FORMAT_FLAG = $(shell $(SIZE) --help | grep -- --format=.*avr > /dev/null && echo --format=avr )
|
||||
|
||||
sizebefore:
|
||||
@if test -f $(TARGET).elf; then echo; echo $(MSG_SIZE_BEFORE); $(ELFSIZE); \
|
||||
2>/dev/null; echo; fi
|
||||
|
||||
sizeafter:
|
||||
@if test -f $(TARGET).elf; then echo; echo $(MSG_SIZE_AFTER); $(ELFSIZE); \
|
||||
2>/dev/null; echo; fi
|
||||
|
||||
checkhooks: build
|
||||
@echo
|
||||
@echo ------- Unhooked LUFA Events -------
|
||||
@$(shell) (grep -s '^Event.*LUFA/.*\\.o' $(TARGET).map | \
|
||||
cut -d' ' -f1 | cut -d'_' -f2- | grep ".*") || \
|
||||
echo "(None)"
|
||||
@echo ----- End Unhooked LUFA Events -----
|
||||
|
||||
checklibmode:
|
||||
@echo
|
||||
@echo ----------- Library Mode -----------
|
||||
@$(shell) ($(CC) $(ALL_CFLAGS) -E -dM - < /dev/null \
|
||||
| grep 'USB_\(DEVICE\|HOST\)_ONLY' | cut -d' ' -f2 | grep ".*") \
|
||||
|| echo "No specific mode (both device and host mode allowable)."
|
||||
@echo ------------------------------------
|
||||
|
||||
# Display compiler version information.
|
||||
gccversion :
|
||||
@$(CC) --version
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
# Program the device.
|
||||
program: $(TARGET).hex $(TARGET).eep
|
||||
$(AVRDUDE) $(AVRDUDE_FLAGS) $(AVRDUDE_WRITE_FLASH) $(AVRDUDE_WRITE_EEPROM)
|
||||
|
||||
flip: $(TARGET).hex
|
||||
batchisp -hardware usb -device $(MCU) -operation erase f
|
||||
batchisp -hardware usb -device $(MCU) -operation loadbuffer $(TARGET).hex program
|
||||
batchisp -hardware usb -device $(MCU) -operation start reset 0
|
||||
|
||||
dfu: $(TARGET).hex
|
||||
dfu-programmer $(MCU) erase
|
||||
dfu-programmer $(MCU) flash --debug 1 $(TARGET).hex
|
||||
dfu-programmer $(MCU) reset
|
||||
|
||||
flip-ee: $(TARGET).hex $(TARGET).eep
|
||||
copy $(TARGET).eep $(TARGET)eep.hex
|
||||
batchisp -hardware usb -device $(MCU) -operation memory EEPROM erase
|
||||
batchisp -hardware usb -device $(MCU) -operation memory EEPROM loadbuffer $(TARGET)eep.hex program
|
||||
batchisp -hardware usb -device $(MCU) -operation start reset 0
|
||||
|
||||
dfu-ee: $(TARGET).hex $(TARGET).eep
|
||||
dfu-programmer $(MCU) erase
|
||||
dfu-programmer $(MCU) eeprom --debug 1 $(TARGET).eep
|
||||
dfu-programmer $(MCU) reset
|
||||
|
||||
# Generate avr-gdb config/init file which does the following:
|
||||
# define the reset signal, load the target file, connect to target, and set
|
||||
# a breakpoint at main().
|
||||
gdb-config:
|
||||
@$(REMOVE) $(GDBINIT_FILE)
|
||||
@echo define reset >> $(GDBINIT_FILE)
|
||||
@echo SIGNAL SIGHUP >> $(GDBINIT_FILE)
|
||||
@echo end >> $(GDBINIT_FILE)
|
||||
@echo file $(TARGET).elf >> $(GDBINIT_FILE)
|
||||
@echo target remote $(DEBUG_HOST):$(DEBUG_PORT) >> $(GDBINIT_FILE)
|
||||
ifeq ($(DEBUG_BACKEND),simulavr)
|
||||
@echo load >> $(GDBINIT_FILE)
|
||||
endif
|
||||
@echo break main >> $(GDBINIT_FILE)
|
||||
|
||||
debug: gdb-config $(TARGET).elf
|
||||
ifeq ($(DEBUG_BACKEND), avarice)
|
||||
@echo Starting AVaRICE - Press enter when "waiting to connect" message displays.
|
||||
@$(WINSHELL) /c start avarice --jtag $(JTAG_DEV) --erase --program --file \
|
||||
$(TARGET).elf $(DEBUG_HOST):$(DEBUG_PORT)
|
||||
@$(WINSHELL) /c pause
|
||||
|
||||
else
|
||||
@$(WINSHELL) /c start simulavr --gdbserver --device $(MCU) --clock-freq \
|
||||
$(DEBUG_MFREQ) --port $(DEBUG_PORT)
|
||||
endif
|
||||
@$(WINSHELL) /c start avr-$(DEBUG_UI) --command=$(GDBINIT_FILE)
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
# Convert ELF to COFF for use in debugging / simulating in AVR Studio or VMLAB.
|
||||
COFFCONVERT = $(OBJCOPY) --debugging
|
||||
COFFCONVERT += --change-section-address .data-0x800000
|
||||
COFFCONVERT += --change-section-address .bss-0x800000
|
||||
COFFCONVERT += --change-section-address .noinit-0x800000
|
||||
COFFCONVERT += --change-section-address .eeprom-0x810000
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
coff: $(TARGET).elf
|
||||
@echo
|
||||
@echo $(MSG_COFF) $(TARGET).cof
|
||||
$(COFFCONVERT) -O coff-avr $< $(TARGET).cof
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
extcoff: $(TARGET).elf
|
||||
@echo
|
||||
@echo $(MSG_EXTENDED_COFF) $(TARGET).cof
|
||||
$(COFFCONVERT) -O coff-ext-avr $< $(TARGET).cof
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
# Create final output files (.hex, .eep) from ELF output file.
|
||||
%.hex: %.elf
|
||||
@echo
|
||||
@echo $(MSG_FLASH) $@
|
||||
$(OBJCOPY) -O $(FORMAT) -R .eeprom $< $@
|
||||
|
||||
%.eep: %.elf
|
||||
@echo
|
||||
@echo $(MSG_EEPROM) $@
|
||||
-$(OBJCOPY) -j .eeprom --set-section-flags=.eeprom="alloc,load" \
|
||||
--change-section-lma .eeprom=0 --no-change-warnings -O $(FORMAT) $< $@ || exit 0
|
||||
|
||||
# Create extended listing file from ELF output file.
|
||||
%.lss: %.elf
|
||||
@echo
|
||||
@echo $(MSG_EXTENDED_LISTING) $@
|
||||
$(OBJDUMP) -h -z -S $< > $@
|
||||
|
||||
# Create a symbol table from ELF output file.
|
||||
%.sym: %.elf
|
||||
@echo
|
||||
@echo $(MSG_SYMBOL_TABLE) $@
|
||||
$(NM) -n $< > $@
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
# Create library from object files.
|
||||
.SECONDARY : $(TARGET).a
|
||||
.PRECIOUS : $(OBJ)
|
||||
%.a: $(OBJ)
|
||||
@echo
|
||||
@echo $(MSG_CREATING_LIBRARY) $@
|
||||
$(AR) $@ $(OBJ)
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
# Link: create ELF output file from object files.
|
||||
.SECONDARY : $(TARGET).elf
|
||||
.PRECIOUS : $(OBJ)
|
||||
%.elf: $(OBJ)
|
||||
@echo
|
||||
@echo $(MSG_LINKING) $@
|
||||
$(CC) $(ALL_CFLAGS) $^ --output $@ $(LDFLAGS)
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
# Compile: create object files from C source files.
|
||||
$(OBJDIR)/%.o : %.c
|
||||
@echo
|
||||
@echo $(MSG_COMPILING) $<
|
||||
$(CC) -c $(ALL_CFLAGS) $< -o $@
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
# Compile: create object files from C++ source files.
|
||||
$(OBJDIR)/%.o : %.cpp
|
||||
@echo
|
||||
@echo $(MSG_COMPILING_CPP) $<
|
||||
$(CC) -c $(ALL_CPPFLAGS) $< -o $@
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
# Compile: create assembler files from C source files.
|
||||
%.s : %.c
|
||||
$(CC) -S $(ALL_CFLAGS) $< -o $@
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
# Compile: create assembler files from C++ source files.
|
||||
%.s : %.cpp
|
||||
$(CC) -S $(ALL_CPPFLAGS) $< -o $@
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
# Assemble: create object files from assembler source files.
|
||||
$(OBJDIR)/%.o : %.S
|
||||
@echo
|
||||
@echo $(MSG_ASSEMBLING) $<
|
||||
$(CC) -c $(ALL_ASFLAGS) $< -o $@
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
# Create preprocessed source for use in sending a bug report.
|
||||
%.i : %.c
|
||||
$(CC) -E -mmcu=$(MCU) -I. $(CFLAGS) $< -o $@
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
# Target: clean project.
|
||||
clean: begin clean_list clean_binary end
|
||||
|
||||
clean_binary:
|
||||
$(REMOVE) $(TARGET).hex
|
||||
|
||||
clean_list:
|
||||
@echo $(MSG_CLEANING)
|
||||
$(REMOVE) $(TARGET).eep
|
||||
$(REMOVE) $(TARGET).cof
|
||||
$(REMOVE) $(TARGET).elf
|
||||
$(REMOVE) $(TARGET).map
|
||||
$(REMOVE) $(TARGET).sym
|
||||
$(REMOVE) $(TARGET).lss
|
||||
$(REMOVE) $(SRC:%.c=$(OBJDIR)/%.o)
|
||||
$(REMOVE) $(SRC:%.c=$(OBJDIR)/%.lst)
|
||||
$(REMOVE) $(SRC:.c=.s)
|
||||
$(REMOVE) $(SRC:.c=.d)
|
||||
$(REMOVE) $(SRC:.c=.i)
|
||||
$(REMOVEDIR) .dep
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
doxygen:
|
||||
@echo Generating Project Documentation...
|
||||
@doxygen Doxygen.conf
|
||||
@echo Documentation Generation Complete.
|
||||
|
||||
clean_doxygen:
|
||||
rm -rf Documentation
|
||||
|
||||
# Create object files directory
|
||||
$(shell mkdir $(OBJDIR) 2>/dev/null)
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
# Include the dependency files.
|
||||
-include $(shell mkdir .dep 2>/dev/null) $(wildcard .dep/*)
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
# Listing of phony targets.
|
||||
.PHONY : all checkhooks checklibmode begin \
|
||||
finish end sizebefore sizeafter gccversion \
|
||||
build elf hex eep lss sym coff extcoff \
|
||||
clean clean_list clean_binary program debug \
|
||||
gdb-config doxygen
|
@ -0,0 +1,29 @@
|
||||
#
|
||||
# LUFA Library
|
||||
# Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2009.
|
||||
#
|
||||
# dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com
|
||||
# www.fourwalledcubicle.com
|
||||
#
|
||||
|
||||
# Makefile to build all the LUFA USB Bootloaders. Call with "make all" to
|
||||
# rebuild all bootloaders.
|
||||
|
||||
# Bootloaders are pre-cleaned before each one is built, to ensure any
|
||||
# custom LUFA library build options are reflected in the compiled
|
||||
# code.
|
||||
|
||||
all:
|
||||
make -C 'DFU/' clean
|
||||
make -C 'DFU/' all
|
||||
|
||||
make -C 'CDC/' clean
|
||||
make -C 'CDC/' all
|
||||
|
||||
make -C 'TeensyHID/' clean
|
||||
make -C 'TeensyHID/' all
|
||||
|
||||
%:
|
||||
make -C 'DFU/' $@
|
||||
make -C 'CDC/' $@
|
||||
make -C 'TeensyHID/' $@
|
Loading…
Reference in new issue